US20100075375A1 - Methods for the purification of polypeptide conjugates - Google Patents
Methods for the purification of polypeptide conjugates Download PDFInfo
- Publication number
- US20100075375A1 US20100075375A1 US12/444,380 US44438007A US2010075375A1 US 20100075375 A1 US20100075375 A1 US 20100075375A1 US 44438007 A US44438007 A US 44438007A US 2010075375 A1 US2010075375 A1 US 2010075375A1
- Authority
- US
- United States
- Prior art keywords
- polypeptide
- epo
- peg
- kda
- buffer
- Prior art date
- Legal status (The legal status is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the status listed.)
- Abandoned
Links
- 0 [8*]CCCc(C)[y] Chemical compound [8*]CCCc(C)[y] 0.000 description 12
- AXOFNEAOQRYKCN-UHFFFAOYSA-N CCCCCC(C)C(=O)NC(CCCCC)C(=O)[La]C(C)C.CCCCCC(C)C(=O)NC(CCCCC)C(=O)[La]C(C)C.CCCCCC(N)C(=O)NC(CCCCC)C(=O)[La]C(C)C.CCCCCC(N)C(=O)NC(CCCCC)C(=O)[La]C(C)C Chemical compound CCCCCC(C)C(=O)NC(CCCCC)C(=O)[La]C(C)C.CCCCCC(C)C(=O)NC(CCCCC)C(=O)[La]C(C)C.CCCCCC(N)C(=O)NC(CCCCC)C(=O)[La]C(C)C.CCCCCC(N)C(=O)NC(CCCCC)C(=O)[La]C(C)C AXOFNEAOQRYKCN-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- DBDIKGOOBCGSRB-UHFFFAOYSA-N [H]C(C)(CC)CC(=O)NCC(=O)NC(C)C.[H]C(C)(CC)COC(=O)NCC(=O)NC(C)C Chemical compound [H]C(C)(CC)CC(=O)NCC(=O)NC(C)C.[H]C(C)(CC)COC(=O)NCC(=O)NC(C)C DBDIKGOOBCGSRB-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- LYHHKFVXZMNAEN-UHFFFAOYSA-N CC(=O)NCCCCC(NC(C)=O)C(C)=O.CCOCCC(C)=O.CNC.CNC(=O)COCC(C)=O.COC(C)=O.COCC(C)=O.COCCCC(C)=O.CSC Chemical compound CC(=O)NCCCCC(NC(C)=O)C(C)=O.CCOCCC(C)=O.CNC.CNC(=O)COCC(C)=O.COC(C)=O.COCC(C)=O.COCCCC(C)=O.CSC LYHHKFVXZMNAEN-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- KBPCCVWUMVGXGF-UHFFFAOYSA-N CC(C)CCCC(C)C Chemical compound CC(C)CCCC(C)C KBPCCVWUMVGXGF-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- VNFOUUWWLFMGPR-UHFFFAOYSA-N CCCC(C)(C)CC[La]C(C)C Chemical compound CCCC(C)(C)CC[La]C(C)C VNFOUUWWLFMGPR-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- KMSHYAYGUFOHCN-UHFFFAOYSA-N CCCCCC(C)C(=O)NC(CCCCC)C(=O)NC(CCCCC)C(=O)[La]C(C)C.CCCCCC(C)C(=O)NC(CCCCC)C(=O)NC(CCCCC)C(=O)[La]C(C)C Chemical compound CCCCCC(C)C(=O)NC(CCCCC)C(=O)NC(CCCCC)C(=O)[La]C(C)C.CCCCCC(C)C(=O)NC(CCCCC)C(=O)NC(CCCCC)C(=O)[La]C(C)C KMSHYAYGUFOHCN-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- CWMZZZXDAFUTCF-UHFFFAOYSA-N CCCCCC(N)C(=O)CC(CCCCC)C(=O)C(C)C.CCCCCC(N)C(=O)CC(CCCCC)C(=O)C(C)C.COC(=O)NC(CSC)C(=O)C(C)C.COCC(C)C(=O)C(C)C.COCC(C)C(=O)C(C)C.COCCC(=O)NC(COC)C(=O)C(C)C.CSCC(C)C(=O)C(C)C.CSCC(C)C(=O)C(C)C Chemical compound CCCCCC(N)C(=O)CC(CCCCC)C(=O)C(C)C.CCCCCC(N)C(=O)CC(CCCCC)C(=O)C(C)C.COC(=O)NC(CSC)C(=O)C(C)C.COCC(C)C(=O)C(C)C.COCC(C)C(=O)C(C)C.COCCC(=O)NC(COC)C(=O)C(C)C.CSCC(C)C(=O)C(C)C.CSCC(C)C(=O)C(C)C CWMZZZXDAFUTCF-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- COVNZRFYJONKHE-UHFFFAOYSA-N CCCCCC(N)C(=O)NC(CCCCC)C(=O)NC(CCCCC)C(=O)O.CCCCCC(N)C(=O)NC(CCCCC)C(=O)NC(CCCCC)C(=O)O Chemical compound CCCCCC(N)C(=O)NC(CCCCC)C(=O)NC(CCCCC)C(=O)O.CCCCCC(N)C(=O)NC(CCCCC)C(=O)NC(CCCCC)C(=O)O COVNZRFYJONKHE-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- ILYSFKTYOXKFKE-UHFFFAOYSA-N CCOCC(C)C(=O)[La]C(C)C.CCOCC(C)C(=O)[La]C(C)C.CCSCC(C)C(=O)[La]C(C)C.CCSCC(C)C(=O)[La]C(C)C Chemical compound CCOCC(C)C(=O)[La]C(C)C.CCOCC(C)C(=O)[La]C(C)C.CCSCC(C)C(=O)[La]C(C)C.CCSCC(C)C(=O)[La]C(C)C ILYSFKTYOXKFKE-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- IDWJAOCBEMHZOA-UHFFFAOYSA-N COCCOCCOC(=O)C(C)C.COCCOCCOC(=O)NC(COCCOC)C(=O)NCC(=O)C(C)C.COCCOCCOC(=O)NC(CSCCOC)C(=O)NCC(=O)C(C)C.COCCOCCOC(=O)NCC(=O)C(C)C.COCCOCCOC(=O)NCCCCC(NC(=O)OCCOCCOC)C(=O)NCC(=O)C(C)C Chemical compound COCCOCCOC(=O)C(C)C.COCCOCCOC(=O)NC(COCCOC)C(=O)NCC(=O)C(C)C.COCCOCCOC(=O)NC(CSCCOC)C(=O)NCC(=O)C(C)C.COCCOCCOC(=O)NCC(=O)C(C)C.COCCOCCOC(=O)NCCCCC(NC(=O)OCCOCCOC)C(=O)NCC(=O)C(C)C IDWJAOCBEMHZOA-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- KSOKWFWZZOQFAY-UHFFFAOYSA-N COCCOCCOC(=O)NCC(=O)NC1C(O)CC(OCCCC(C)CC(C)C(C)C)(C(=O)O)OC1C(O)C(O)CO Chemical compound COCCOCCOC(=O)NCC(=O)NC1C(O)CC(OCCCC(C)CC(C)C(C)C)(C(=O)O)OC1C(O)C(O)CO KSOKWFWZZOQFAY-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- ZEFIHPBUNBNKAP-QYKNYGDISA-N [2H]CC(O)C(O)C1OC(OC(C)C(C)C)(C(=O)O)CC(O)C1C Chemical compound [2H]CC(O)C(O)C1OC(OC(C)C(C)C)(C(=O)O)CC(O)C1C ZEFIHPBUNBNKAP-QYKNYGDISA-N 0.000 description 1
- VOSFZOMGVDRKNN-WFVSFCRTSA-N [2H]CC(O)C(O)C1OC(OC(C)C)(C(=O)O)CC(O)C1NC Chemical compound [2H]CC(O)C(O)C1OC(OC(C)C)(C(=O)O)CC(O)C1NC VOSFZOMGVDRKNN-WFVSFCRTSA-N 0.000 description 1
- FFVJTTCGFBIHBS-UICOGKGYSA-N [2H]CC(O)C(O)C1OC(OCC(C)C(C)C)(C(=O)O)CC(O)C1C Chemical compound [2H]CC(O)C(O)C1OC(OCC(C)C(C)C)(C(=O)O)CC(O)C1C FFVJTTCGFBIHBS-UICOGKGYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- ZYSUQFPTQKLPFS-WFVSFCRTSA-N [2H]CC(O)C(O)C1OC(OCC(C)C)(C(=O)O)CC(O)C1NC Chemical compound [2H]CC(O)C(O)C1OC(OCC(C)C)(C(=O)O)CC(O)C1NC ZYSUQFPTQKLPFS-WFVSFCRTSA-N 0.000 description 1
- VFWDJIRUXCKYLH-QYKNYGDISA-N [2H]CC(O)C(O)C1OC(OCCCC(C)C)(C(=O)O)CC(O)C1C Chemical compound [2H]CC(O)C(O)C1OC(OCCCC(C)C)(C(=O)O)CC(O)C1C VFWDJIRUXCKYLH-QYKNYGDISA-N 0.000 description 1
- AICQLDPHVFQAOI-UHFFFAOYSA-N [H]C([H])(C)C([H])(C)C([H])([H])[La]C(C)C Chemical compound [H]C([H])(C)C([H])(C)C([H])([H])[La]C(C)C AICQLDPHVFQAOI-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
Images
Classifications
-
- C—CHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
- C12—BIOCHEMISTRY; BEER; SPIRITS; WINE; VINEGAR; MICROBIOLOGY; ENZYMOLOGY; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING
- C12P—FERMENTATION OR ENZYME-USING PROCESSES TO SYNTHESISE A DESIRED CHEMICAL COMPOUND OR COMPOSITION OR TO SEPARATE OPTICAL ISOMERS FROM A RACEMIC MIXTURE
- C12P21/00—Preparation of peptides or proteins
- C12P21/005—Glycopeptides, glycoproteins
-
- A—HUMAN NECESSITIES
- A61—MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
- A61K—PREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
- A61K47/00—Medicinal preparations characterised by the non-active ingredients used, e.g. carriers or inert additives; Targeting or modifying agents chemically bound to the active ingredient
- A61K47/50—Medicinal preparations characterised by the non-active ingredients used, e.g. carriers or inert additives; Targeting or modifying agents chemically bound to the active ingredient the non-active ingredient being chemically bound to the active ingredient, e.g. polymer-drug conjugates
- A61K47/51—Medicinal preparations characterised by the non-active ingredients used, e.g. carriers or inert additives; Targeting or modifying agents chemically bound to the active ingredient the non-active ingredient being chemically bound to the active ingredient, e.g. polymer-drug conjugates the non-active ingredient being a modifying agent
- A61K47/56—Medicinal preparations characterised by the non-active ingredients used, e.g. carriers or inert additives; Targeting or modifying agents chemically bound to the active ingredient the non-active ingredient being chemically bound to the active ingredient, e.g. polymer-drug conjugates the non-active ingredient being a modifying agent the modifying agent being an organic macromolecular compound, e.g. an oligomeric, polymeric or dendrimeric molecule
- A61K47/59—Medicinal preparations characterised by the non-active ingredients used, e.g. carriers or inert additives; Targeting or modifying agents chemically bound to the active ingredient the non-active ingredient being chemically bound to the active ingredient, e.g. polymer-drug conjugates the non-active ingredient being a modifying agent the modifying agent being an organic macromolecular compound, e.g. an oligomeric, polymeric or dendrimeric molecule obtained otherwise than by reactions only involving carbon-to-carbon unsaturated bonds, e.g. polyureas or polyurethanes
- A61K47/60—Medicinal preparations characterised by the non-active ingredients used, e.g. carriers or inert additives; Targeting or modifying agents chemically bound to the active ingredient the non-active ingredient being chemically bound to the active ingredient, e.g. polymer-drug conjugates the non-active ingredient being a modifying agent the modifying agent being an organic macromolecular compound, e.g. an oligomeric, polymeric or dendrimeric molecule obtained otherwise than by reactions only involving carbon-to-carbon unsaturated bonds, e.g. polyureas or polyurethanes the organic macromolecular compound being a polyoxyalkylene oligomer, polymer or dendrimer, e.g. PEG, PPG, PEO or polyglycerol
-
- A—HUMAN NECESSITIES
- A61—MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
- A61P—SPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
- A61P7/00—Drugs for disorders of the blood or the extracellular fluid
-
- A—HUMAN NECESSITIES
- A61—MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
- A61P—SPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
- A61P7/00—Drugs for disorders of the blood or the extracellular fluid
- A61P7/06—Antianaemics
-
- C—CHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
- C07—ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
- C07K—PEPTIDES
- C07K1/00—General methods for the preparation of peptides, i.e. processes for the organic chemical preparation of peptides or proteins of any length
- C07K1/13—Labelling of peptides
-
- C—CHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
- C07—ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
- C07K—PEPTIDES
- C07K1/00—General methods for the preparation of peptides, i.e. processes for the organic chemical preparation of peptides or proteins of any length
- C07K1/14—Extraction; Separation; Purification
- C07K1/16—Extraction; Separation; Purification by chromatography
- C07K1/20—Partition-, reverse-phase or hydrophobic interaction chromatography
-
- C—CHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
- C07—ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
- C07K—PEPTIDES
- C07K14/00—Peptides having more than 20 amino acids; Gastrins; Somatostatins; Melanotropins; Derivatives thereof
-
- C—CHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
- C07—ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
- C07K—PEPTIDES
- C07K14/00—Peptides having more than 20 amino acids; Gastrins; Somatostatins; Melanotropins; Derivatives thereof
- C07K14/435—Peptides having more than 20 amino acids; Gastrins; Somatostatins; Melanotropins; Derivatives thereof from animals; from humans
- C07K14/475—Growth factors; Growth regulators
- C07K14/505—Erythropoietin [EPO]
-
- C—CHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
- C07—ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
- C07K—PEPTIDES
- C07K1/00—General methods for the preparation of peptides, i.e. processes for the organic chemical preparation of peptides or proteins of any length
- C07K1/14—Extraction; Separation; Purification
- C07K1/16—Extraction; Separation; Purification by chromatography
- C07K1/18—Ion-exchange chromatography
-
- Y—GENERAL TAGGING OF NEW TECHNOLOGICAL DEVELOPMENTS; GENERAL TAGGING OF CROSS-SECTIONAL TECHNOLOGIES SPANNING OVER SEVERAL SECTIONS OF THE IPC; TECHNICAL SUBJECTS COVERED BY FORMER USPC CROSS-REFERENCE ART COLLECTIONS [XRACs] AND DIGESTS
- Y10—TECHNICAL SUBJECTS COVERED BY FORMER USPC
- Y10S—TECHNICAL SUBJECTS COVERED BY FORMER USPC CROSS-REFERENCE ART COLLECTIONS [XRACs] AND DIGESTS
- Y10S930/00—Peptide or protein sequence
- Y10S930/01—Peptide or protein sequence
- Y10S930/09—Erythropoietin; related peptides
Definitions
- the invention pertains to the field of polypeptide manufacturing.
- the invention relates to processes for the purification of polypeptide conjugates, especially those conjugates including poly(alkylene oxide)-based modification groups.
- a glycosylated or non-glycosylated polypeptide When a glycosylated or non-glycosylated polypeptide is subjected to a chemical modification reaction, side-products may be formed in addition to the desired modified polypeptide.
- the process In order to isolate a desired product from a reaction mixture, the process must not only be suitable to remove chemical reagents, but must also be capable of removing unwanted side-products. This is especially important when the polypeptide is to be used as a therapeutic agent.
- Polypeptide modification technologies which rely on the specificity of enzymes, may result in a reaction product that is characterized by improved homogeneity when compared to other chemical methods.
- a recombinant polypeptide in a cell typically results in a polypeptide population that, at leas to some extend, is characterized by a variety of glycan structures. Subsequent modification of the polypeptide, e.g., via those glycans, results in a heterogenous product. Although remodeling glycan structures prior to chemical or enzymatic modification of the polypeptide can significantly improve the quality of the product, a certain degree of heterogeneity remains.
- the present invention addresses these and other needs.
- the present invention provides processes for the isolation (e.g., large-scale purification) of polypeptide conjugates.
- the polypeptide conjugates of the present invention include a polypeptide that is modified with a modifying group, such as a polymer.
- Exemplary polymers include water-soluble polymers.
- the methods of the invention are particularly useful for the isolation of polypeptide conjugates that include poly(alkylene oxide)-based polymers, such as poly(ethylene glycol) and poly(propylene glycol). While reverse-phase (RP) chromatography can be used to purify polypeptides that are derivatized with such highly polar, water-soluble polymers, the technique is not desirable because it requires the use of water-soluble organic solvents, such as acetonitrile.
- RP reverse-phase
- the current invention provides methods that allow for the isolation of polypeptide conjugates essentially without the use of organic solvents.
- An exemplary method of the invention involves at least one chromatographic procedure that is effective in separating polypeptide conjugates having at least one poly(alkylene oxide) moiety from other components of a mixture.
- the methods of the invention can be used to isolate such polypeptide conjugate from any mixture.
- the mixture is a reaction mixture (e.g., the product of a chemical PEGylation reaction or an ezymatically catalyzed PEGylation reaction, e.g., glycoPEGylation reaction) and may optionally include other polypeptide conjugates.
- Preferred methods of the invention utilize hydrophobic interaction chromatography (HIC) media.
- HIC is used in conjunction with at least one additional chromatography step selected from anion exchange chromatography, mixed-mode chromatography, cation exchange chromatography and hydroxyapatite or fluoroapatite chromatography.
- HIC is used in conjunction with at least one of anion exchange chromatography, mixed-mode chromatography and cation exchange chromatography.
- HIC in conjunction with cation chromatography represents an efficient method for the resolution of polypeptide conjugates that include at least one poly(alkylene oxide moiety).
- HIC, followed by cation exchange can resolve EPO-PEG 3 species from EPO-PEG 2 species.
- HIC in conjunction with cation exchange provided a composition of purified EPO-[PEG(10 kDa)] 3 having a very low residual concentration of EPO-[PEG(10 kDa)] 2 .
- FIG. 1 An exemplary method of the invention that includes anion exchange and cation exchange chromatography in addition to HIC is outlined in FIG. 1 .
- the methods of the invention are useful for the separation of different glycoforms of a polypeptide conjugate, especially those glycoforms distinguished by the number of poly(alkylene oxide) moieties that are linked to the polypeptide. Unwanted glycoforms may be formed as by-products under the reaction conditions used to form the desired polypeptide conjugate.
- the invention provides a method of making a composition that includes a first polypeptide conjugate, the first polypeptide conjugate having a first number of poly(alkylene oxide) moieties covalently linked to the first polypeptide.
- the method includes: (a) contacting a mixture containing the first polypeptide conjugate with a hydrophobic interaction chromatography (HIC) medium; and (b) eluting the first polypeptide conjugate from the HIC medium.
- the mixture includes a second polypeptide conjugate, wherein the second polypeptide conjugate has a second number of poly(alkylene oxide) moieties covalently linked to the second polypeptide, wherein the first number and the second number are different.
- the first polypeptide conjugate includes 3 poly(alkylene oxide) moieties, while the second polypeptide conjugate includes either 0, 1, 2 or 4 poly(alkylene oxide) moieties.
- the poly(alkylene oxide) is poly(ethylene glycol) (PEG).
- the invention provides a method of isolating a first polypeptide conjugate including a first number of poly(alkylene oxide) moieties covalently linked to a first polypeptide, from a second polypeptide conjugate that includes a second number of poly(alkylene oxide) moieties covalently linked to a second polypeptide, wherein the first number is selected from 1 to 20 and the second number is selected from 0-20, the first number and the second number being different.
- the method includes: (a) contacting a mixture containing the first polypeptide conjugate and the second polypeptide conjugate with a hydrophobic interaction chromatography (HIC) medium; and (b) eluting the first polypeptide conjugate from said hydrophobic interaction chromatography medium.
- the first polypeptide conjugate includes 3 poly(alkylene oxide) moieties
- the second polypeptide conjugate includes 0, 1, 2, 4, 5, 6 or 7 poly(alkylene oxide) moieties.
- first polypeptide and the second polypeptide have the same amino acid sequence. In another example according to any of the above embodiments, both the first and the second polypeptide are EPO.
- the invention provides a method of forming a composition that contains a first erythropoietin (EPO) conjugate, wherein the first EPO conjugate includes a first number of poly(alkylene oxide) moieties covalently linked to an EPO polypeptide.
- the method includes: (a) contacting a mixture containing the first EPO conjugate with an anion exchange medium; (b) eluting the first EPO conjugate from the anion exchange medium, forming a first eluate including the first EPO conjugate; (c) contacting the first eluate with a hydrophobic interaction chromatography (HIC) medium; and (d) eluting the first EPO conjugate from the hydrophobic interaction chromatography medium.
- the method may further include (e.g., after step d): (e) eluting the first EPO conjugate from a cation exchange chromatography medium.
- the method further includes forming the polypeptide conjugate either chemically or through enzymatically catalyzed glycomodification (e.g., glycoPEGylation using a glycosyltransferase and an appropriate glycosyl donor molecule, such as a modified sugar nucleotide).
- glycoPEGylation methods are art-recognized; see for example, WO 03/031464 to DeFrees et al. or WO 04/99231, the disclosures of which are incorporated herein by reference in their entirety.
- the invention further provides compositions, which are made by the methods of the invention as well as pharmaceutical formulations including the composition of the invention.
- the invention provides methods of treatment utilizing the compositions of the invention.
- FIG. 1 is an overall view of an exemplary polypeptide conjugate purification process according to a method of the invention.
- the diafiltration/ultrafiltration step following hydrophobic interaction chromatography (HIC) is optional.
- FIG. 2A is an exemplary chromatogram showing the resolution of tri-PEGylated EPO from mono-, di-, tri- and tetra-PEGylated EPO glycoforms using hydrophobic interaction chromatography with Phenyl 650S as the separation medium.
- FIG. 2B is an expanded view of the EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa) 2 , EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa) 3 and EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa) 4 elution peaks of the chromatogram in FIG. 2A .
- the letters (E), (F) and (G) indicate fractions that were pooled, wherein (F) indicates the elution of EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa) 3 .
- FIG. 3A is a scheme of an exemplary EPO polypeptide conjugate of the invention having an insect-specific glycosylation pattern that includes three N-linked, monoantennary glycan residues covalently linked to amino acid residues N24, N38 and N83. Each glycan residue is covalently linked to a 10 kDa PEG moiety via a terminal galactose (Gal) moiety.
- FIG. 3A also includes an exemplary reaction scheme, which can be used to synthesize the EPO conjugate.
- the substrate for the enzymatically catalyzed conversions is an EPO polypeptide, which includes at least one glycan residue having a trimannosyl moiety.
- a first step an N-acetyl glucosamine transferase (GnT-1) is used, which adds a GlcNAc moiety to only one of the terminal mannose moieties.
- a Gal moiety is linked to the newly added GlcNAc moiety using a galactosyl transferase (GalT-1) forming a terminal -GlcNAc-Gal moiety.
- the first and the second step maybe performed in the same reaction vessel.
- a sialic acid moiety that is modified with a PEG moiety is linked to the terminal Gal moiety using a sialyl transferase (ST3Gal3).
- FIG. 3B is a representation of an exemplary composition of the invention that includes various glycoforms of an exemplary polypeptide conjugate (e.g., EPO conjugate).
- Each glycoform is distinguished from other glycoforms by the number of PEG moieties that are covalently linked to the polypeptide, or by the structure of the glycans through which the PEG moieties are linked to the polypeptide. Shown percentage values are exemplary.
- FIG. 4A is a reverse phase (RP) HPLC chromatogram of an exemplary glycoPEGylation reaction mixture containing EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa) 1-4 performed at a 25 mg scale.
- a Zorbax 300SB-C3 (150 ⁇ 2.1 mm, 5 micron) column was used in the analysis.
- the following eluants were used: 0.1% TFA in water (Buffer A) and 0.09% TFA in CAN (Buffer B).
- the gradient was 42-55% B in 14 min followed by 55-95% B in 2 min.
- the flow rate was 0.6 mL/min. Absorption was measured at 214 nm.
- FIG. 4B is a reverse phase (RP) HPLC chromatogram of an exemplary composition of the invention containing purified EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa) 3 as the major component, the composition obtained using a method of the invention.
- FIG. 5 is a schematic representation of exemplary glycopegylated EPO isoforms isolated from Chinese Hamster Ovary cells.
- A An exemplary 40 kilodaton O-linked pegylated glycoform.
- B One of several 30 kilodatton N-linked pegylated glycoforms.
- the modified sialic acid moiety comprising the PEG molecule may occur on any one or more of any of the branches of the N-linked glycosyl residue.
- any glycosylated EPO molecule may comprise any mixture of mono-, bi- tri-, or tetra-antennary N-linked glycosyl residues and any one or more of the branches may further comprise a modified sialic acid moiety.
- PEG poly(ethyleneglycol); PPG, poly(propyleneglycol); Ara, arabinosyl; Fru, fructosyl; Fuc, fucosyl; Gal, galactosyl; GalNAc, N-acetylgalactosaminyl; Glc, glucosyl; GlcNAc, N-acetylglucosaminyl; Man, mannosyl; ManAc, mannosaminyl acetate; Xyl, xylosyl; and NeuAc, sialyl (N-acetylneuraminyl); M6P, mannose-6-phosphate; BEVS, baculovirus expression vector system; CV, column volume; NTU, nominal turbidity units; vvm, volume/volume/min.
- oligosaccharides described herein are described with the name or abbreviation for the non-reducing saccharide (i.e., Gal), followed by the configuration of the glycosidic bond ( ⁇ or ⁇ ), the ring bond (1 or 2), the ring position of the reducing saccharide involved in the bond (2, 3, 4, 6 or 8), and then the name or abbreviation of the reducing saccharide (i.e., GlcNAc).
- Each saccharide is preferably a pyranose.
- Oligosaccharides are considered to have a reducing end and a non-reducing end, whether or not the saccharide at the reducing end is in fact a reducing sugar. In accordance with accepted nomenclature, oligosaccharides are depicted herein with the non-reducing end on the left and the reducing end on the right.
- substituent groups are specified by their conventional chemical formulae, written from left to right, they equally encompass the chemically identical substituents, which would result from writing the structure from right to left, e.g., —CH 2 O— is intended to also recite —OCH 2 —.
- alkyl by itself or as part of another substituent, means, unless otherwise stated, a straight or branched chain, or cyclic (i.e., cycloalkyl)hydrocarbon radical, or combination thereof, which may be fully saturated, mono- or polyunsaturated and can include di-(e.g., alkylene) and multivalent radicals, having the number of carbon atoms designated (i.e. C 1 -C 10 means one to ten carbons).
- saturated hydrocarbon radicals include, but are not limited to, groups such as methyl, ethyl, n-propyl, isopropyl, n-butyl, t-butyl, isobutyl, sec-butyl, cyclohexyl, (cyclohexyl)methyl, cyclopropylmethyl, homologs and isomers of, for example, n-pentyl, n-hexyl, n-heptyl, n-octyl, and the like.
- An unsaturated alkyl group is one having one or more double bonds or triple bonds.
- alkyl groups examples include, but are not limited to, vinyl, 2-propenyl, crotyl, 2-isopentenyl, 2-(butadienyl), 2,4-pentadienyl, 3-(1,4-pentadienyl), ethynyl, 1- and 3-propynyl, 3-butynyl, and the higher homologs and isomers.
- alkyl unless otherwise noted, is also meant to include those derivatives of alkyl defined in more detail below, such as “heteroalkyl.” Alkyl groups that are limited to hydrocarbon groups are termed “homoalkyl”.
- alkylene by itself or as part of another substituent means a divalent radical derived from an alkane, as exemplified, but not limited, by —CH 2 CH 2 CH 2 CH 2 —, and further includes those groups described below as “heteroalkylene.”
- an alkyl (or alkylene) group will have from 1 to 24 carbon atoms, with those groups having 10 or fewer carbon atoms being preferred in the present invention.
- a “lower alkyl” or “lower alkylene” is a shorter chain alkyl or alkylene group, generally having eight or fewer carbon atoms.
- alkoxy alkylamino and “alkylthio” (or thioalkoxy) are used in their conventional sense, and refer to those alkyl groups attached to the remainder of the molecule via an oxygen atom, an amino group, or a sulfur atom, respectively.
- heteroalkyl by itself or in combination with another term, means, unless otherwise stated, a stable straight or branched chain, or cyclic hydrocarbon radical, or combinations thereof, consisting of the stated number of carbon atoms and at least one heteroatom selected from the group consisting of O, N, Si and S, and wherein the nitrogen and sulfur atoms may optionally be oxidized and the nitrogen heteroatom may optionally be quaternized.
- the heteroatom(s) O, N and S and Si may be placed at any interior position of the heteroalkyl group or at the position at which the alkyl group is attached to the remainder of the molecule.
- Examples include, but are not limited to, —CH 2 —CH 2 —O—CH 3 , —CH 2 —CH 2 —NH—CH 3 , —CH 2 —CH 2 —N(CH 3 )—CH 3 , —CH 2 —S—CH 2 —CH 3 , —CH 2 —CH 2 , —S(O)—CH 3 , —CH 2 —CH 2 —S(O) 2 —CH 3 , —CH ⁇ CH—O—CH 3 , —Si(CH 3 ) 3 , —CH 2 —CH ⁇ N—OCH 3 , and CH ⁇ CH—N(CH 3 )—CH 3 .
- heteroalkylene by itself or as part of another substituent means a divalent radical derived from heteroalkyl, as exemplified, but not limited by, —CH 2 —CH 2 —S—CH 2 —CH 2 — and CH 2 —S—CH 2 —CH 2 —NH—CH 2 —.
- heteroatoms can also occupy either or both of the chain termini (e.g., alkyleneoxy, alkylenedioxy, alkyleneamino, alkylenediamino, and the like). Still further, for alkylene and heteroalkylene linking groups, no orientation of the linking group is implied by the direction in which the formula of the linking group is written. For example, the formula —CO 2 R′— represents both —C(O)OR′ and —OC(O)R′.
- cycloalkyl and “heterocycloalkyl”, by themselves or in combination with other terms, represent, unless otherwise stated, cyclic versions of “alkyl” and “heteroalkyl”, respectively. Additionally, for heterocycloalkyl, a heteroatom can occupy the position at which the heterocycle is attached to the remainder of the molecule. Examples of cycloalkyl include, but are not limited to, cyclopentyl, cyclohexyl, 1-cyclohexenyl, 3-cyclohexenyl, cycloheptyl, and the like.
- heterocycloalkyl examples include, but are not limited to, 1-(1,2,5,6-tetrahydropyridyl), 1-piperidinyl, 2-piperidinyl, 3-piperidinyl, 4-morpholinyl, 3-morpholinyl, tetrahydrofuran-2-yl, tetrahydrofuran-3-yl, tetrahydrothien-2-yl, tetrahydrothien-3-yl, 1-piperazinyl, 2-piperazinyl, and the like.
- halo or “halogen,” by themselves or as part of another substituent, mean, unless otherwise stated, a fluorine, chlorine, bromine, or iodine atom. Additionally, terms such as “haloalkyl,” are meant to include monohaloalkyl and polyhaloalkyl.
- halo(C 1 -C 4 )alkyl is mean to include, but not be limited to, trifluoromethyl, 2,2,2-trifluoroethyl, 4-chlorobutyl, 3-bromopropyl, and the like.
- aryl means, unless otherwise stated, a polyunsaturated, aromatic, substituent that can be a single ring or multiple rings (preferably from 1 to 3 rings), which are fused together or linked covalently.
- heteroaryl refers to aryl groups (or rings) that contain from one to four heteroatoms selected from N, O, S, Si and B, wherein the nitrogen and sulfur atoms are optionally oxidized, and the nitrogen atom(s) are optionally quaternized.
- a heteroaryl group can be attached to the remainder of the molecule through a heteroatom.
- Non-limiting examples of aryl and heteroaryl groups include phenyl, 1-naphthyl, 2-naphthyl, 4-biphenyl, 1-pyrrolyl, 2-pyrrolyl, 3-pyrrolyl, 3-pyrazolyl, 2-imidazolyl, 4-imidazolyl, pyrazinyl, 2-oxazolyl, 4-oxazolyl, 2-phenyl-4-oxazolyl, 5-oxazolyl, 3-isoxazolyl, 4-isoxazolyl, 5-isoxazolyl, 2-thiazolyl, 4-thiazolyl, 5-thiazolyl, 2-furyl, 3-furyl, 2-thienyl, 3-thienyl, 2-pyridyl, 3-pyridyl, 4-pyridyl, 2-pyrimidyl, 4-pyrimidyl, 5-benzothiazolyl, purinyl, 2-benzimidazolyl, 5-indolyl, 1-isoquinoly
- aryl when used in combination with other terms (e.g., aryloxy, arylthioxy, arylalkyl) includes both aryl and heteroaryl rings as defined above.
- arylalkyl is meant to include those radicals in which an aryl group is attached to an alkyl group (e.g., benzyl, phenethyl, pyridylmethyl and the like) including those alkyl groups in which a carbon atom (e.g., a methylene group) has been replaced by, for example, an oxygen atom (e.g., phenoxymethyl, 2-pyridyloxymethyl, 3-(1-naphthyloxy)propyl, and the like).
- alkyl group e.g., benzyl, phenethyl, pyridylmethyl and the like
- an oxygen atom e.g., phenoxymethyl, 2-pyridyloxymethyl, 3-(1-naph
- alkyl e.g., “alkyl,” “heteroalkyl,” “aryl” and “heteroaryl” are meant to include both substituted and unsubstituted forms of the indicated radical.
- Preferred substituents for each type of radical are provided below.
- alkyl and heteroalkyl radicals are generically referred to as “alkyl group substituents,” and they can be one or more of a variety of groups selected from, but not limited to: substituted or unsubstituted aryl, substituted or unsubstituted heteroaryl, substituted or unsubstituted heterocycloalkyl, —OR′, ⁇ O, ⁇ NR′, ⁇ N—OR′, —NR′R′′, —SR′, -halogen, —SiR′R′′R′′′, —OC(O)R′, —C(O)R′, —CO 2 R′, —CONR′R′′, —OC(O)NR′R
- R′, R′′, R′′′ and R′′′′ each preferably independently refer to hydrogen, substituted or unsubstituted heteroalkyl, substituted or unsubstituted aryl, e.g., aryl substituted with 1-3 halogens, substituted or unsubstituted alkyl, alkoxy or thioalkoxy groups, or arylalkyl groups.
- each of the R groups is independently selected as are each R′, R′′, R′′′ and R′′′′ groups when more than one of these groups is present.
- R′ and R′′ are attached to the same nitrogen atom, they can be combined with the nitrogen atom to form a 5-, 6-, or 7-membered ring.
- —NR′R′′ is meant to include, but not be limited to, 1-pyrrolidinyl and 4-morpholinyl.
- alkyl is meant to include groups including carbon atoms bound to groups other than hydrogen groups, such as haloalkyl (e.g., —CF 3 and —CH 2 CF 3 ) and acyl (e.g., —C(O)CH 3 , —C(O)CF 3 , —C(O)CH 2 OCH 3 , and the like).
- haloalkyl e.g., —CF 3 and —CH 2 CF 3
- acyl e.g., —C(O)CH 3 , —C(O)CF 3 , —C(O)CH 2 OCH 3 , and the like.
- substituents for the aryl and heteroaryl groups are generically referred to as “aryl group substituents.”
- the substituents are selected from, for example: substituted or unsubstituted alkyl, substituted or unsubstituted heteroalkyl, substituted or unsubstituted aryl, substituted or unsubstituted heteroaryl, substituted or unsubstituted heterocycloalkyl, —OR′, ⁇ O, ⁇ NR′, ⁇ N—OR′, —NR′R′′, —SR′, -halogen, —SiR′R′′R′′′, —OC(O)R′, —C(O)R′, —CO 2 R′, —CONR′R′′, —OC(O)NR′R′′, —NR′′C(O)R′, —NR′—C(O)NR′′R′′′, —NR′′C(O) 2 R′,
- Two of the substituents on adjacent atoms of the aryl or heteroaryl ring may optionally be replaced with a substituent of the formula -T-C(O)—(CRR′) q —U—, wherein T and U are independently —NR—, —O—, —CRR′— or a single bond, and q is an integer of from 0 to 3.
- two of the substituents on adjacent atoms of the aryl or heteroaryl ring may optionally be replaced with a substituent of the formula -A-(CH 2 ) r —B—, wherein A and B are independently —CRR′—, —O—, —NR—, —S—, —S(O)—, —S(O) 2 —, —S(O) 2 NR′— or a single bond, and r is an integer of from 1 to 4.
- One of the single bonds of the new ring so formed may optionally be replaced with a double bond.
- two of the substituents on adjacent atoms of the aryl or heteroaryl ring may optionally be replaced with a substituent of the formula —(CRR′) s —X—(CR′′R′′′) d —, where s and d are independently integers of from 0 to 3, and X is —O—, —NR′—, —S—, —S(O)—, —S(O) 2 —, or S(O) 2 NR′—.
- the substituents R, R′, R′′ and R′′′ are preferably independently selected from hydrogen or substituted or unsubstituted (C 1 -C 6 )alkyl.
- acyl describes a substituent containing a carbonyl residue, C(O)R.
- R exemplary species for R include H, halogen, alkoxy, substituted or unsubstituted alkyl, substituted or unsubstituted aryl, substituted or unsubstituted heteroaryl, and substituted or unsubstituted heterocycloalkyl.
- fused ring system means at least two rings, wherein each ring has at least 2 atoms in common with another ring. “Fused ring systems may include aromatic as well as non aromatic rings. Examples of “fused ring systems” are naphthalenes, indoles, quinolines, chromenes and the like.
- heteroatom includes oxygen (O), nitrogen (N), sulfur (S), silicon (Si) and boron (B).
- R is a general abbreviation that represents a substituent group.
- substituent groups include substituted or unsubstituted alkyl, substituted or unsubstituted heteroalkyl, substituted or unsubstituted aryl, substituted or unsubstituted heteroaryl, and substituted or unsubstituted heterocycloalkyl groups.
- salts includes salts of the active compounds which are prepared with relatively nontoxic acids or bases, depending on the particular substituents found on the compounds described herein.
- base addition salts can be obtained by contacting the neutral form of such compounds with a sufficient amount of the desired base, either neat or in a suitable inert solvent.
- pharmaceutically acceptable base addition salts include sodium, potassium, calcium, ammonium, organic amino, or magnesium salt, or a similar salt.
- acid addition salts can be obtained by contacting the neutral form of such compounds with a sufficient amount of the desired acid, either neat or in a suitable inert solvent.
- Examples of pharmaceutically acceptable acid addition salts include those derived from inorganic acids like hydrochloric, hydrobromic, nitric, carbonic, monohydrogencarbonic, phosphoric, monohydrogenphosphoric, dihydrogenphosphoric, sulfuric, monohydrogensulfuric, hydriodic, or phosphorous acids and the like, as well as the salts derived from relatively nontoxic organic acids like acetic, propionic, isobutyric, maleic, malonic, benzoic, succinic, suberic, fumaric, lactic, mandelic, phthalic, benzenesulfonic, p-tolylsulfonic, citric, tartaric, methanesulfonic, and the like.
- inorganic acids like hydrochloric, hydrobromic, nitric, carbonic, monohydrogencarbonic, phosphoric, monohydrogenphosphoric, dihydrogenphosphoric, sulfuric, monohydrogensulfuric, hydriodic, or phosphorous acids and
- salts of amino acids such as arginate and the like, and salts of organic acids like glucuronic or galactunoric acids and the like (see, for example, Berge et al., Journal of Pharmaceutical Science, 66: 1-19 (1977)).
- Certain specific compounds of the present invention contain both basic and acidic functionalities that allow the compounds to be converted into either base or acid addition salts.
- the neutral forms of the compounds are preferably regenerated by contacting the salt with a base or acid and isolating the parent compound in the conventional manner.
- the parent form of the compound differs from the various salt forms in certain physical properties, such as solubility in polar solvents, but otherwise the salts are equivalent to the parent form of the compound for the purposes of the present invention.
- the present invention provides compounds, which are in a prodrug form.
- Prodrugs of the compounds described herein are those compounds that readily undergo chemical changes under physiological conditions to provide the compounds of the present invention.
- prodrugs can be converted to the compounds of the present invention by chemical or biochemical methods in an ex vivo environment. For example, prodrugs can be slowly converted to the compounds of the present invention when placed in a transdermal patch reservoir with a suitable enzyme or chemical reagent.
- Certain compounds of the present invention can exist in unsolvated forms as well as solvated forms, including hydrated forms. In general, the solvated forms are equivalent to unsolvated forms and are encompassed within the scope of the present invention. Certain compounds of the present invention may exist in multiple crystalline or amorphous forms. In general, all physical forms are equivalent for the uses contemplated by the present invention and are intended to be within the scope of the present invention.
- Certain compounds of the present invention possess asymmetric carbon atoms (optical centers) or double bonds; the racemates, diastereomers, geometric isomers and individual isomers are encompassed within the scope of the present invention.
- the compounds of the invention may be prepared as a single isomer (e.g., enantiomer, cis-trans, positional, diastereomer) or as a mixture of isomers.
- the compounds are prepared as substantially a single isomer.
- Methods of preparing substantially isomerically pure compounds are known in the art. For example, enantiomerically enriched mixtures and pure enantiomeric compounds can be prepared by using synthetic intermediates that are enantiomerically pure in combination with reactions that either leave the stereochemistry at a chiral center unchanged or result in its complete inversion. Alternatively, the final product or intermediates along the synthetic route can be resolved into a single stereoisomer.
- enantiomeric excess and diastereomeric excess are used interchangeably herein.
- Compounds with a single stereocenter are referred to as being present in “enantiomeric excess,” those with at least two stereocenters are referred to as being present in “diastereomeric excess.”
- the compounds of the present invention may also contain unnatural proportions of atomic isotopes at one or more of the atoms that constitute such compounds.
- the compounds may be radiolabeled with radioactive isotopes, such as for example tritium ( 3 H), iodine-125 ( 125 I) or carbon-14 ( 14 C). All isotopic variations of the compounds of the present invention, whether radioactive or not, are intended to be encompassed within the scope of the present invention.
- Reactive functional group refers to groups including, but not limited to, olefins, acetylenes, alcohols, phenols, ethers, oxides, halides, aldehydes, ketones, carboxylic acids, esters, amides, cyanates, isocyanates, thiocyanates, isothiocyanates, amines, hydrazines, hydrazones, hydrazides, diazo, diazonium, nitro, nitriles, mercaptans, sulfides, disulfides, sulfoxides, sulfones, sulfonic acids, sulfinic acids, acetals, ketals, anhydrides, sulfates, sulfenic acids isonitriles, amidines, imides, imidates, nitrones, hydroxylamines, oximes, hydroxamic acids thiohydroxamic acids, allenes, ortho
- Reactive functional groups also include those used to prepare bioconjugates, e.g., N-hydroxysuccinimide esters, maleimides and the like. Methods to prepare each of these functional groups are well known in the art and their application or modification for a particular purpose is within the ability of one of skill in the art (see, for example, Sandler and Karo, eds. O RGANIC F UNCTIONAL G ROUP P REPARATIONS , Academic Press, San Diego, 1989).
- “pharmaceutically acceptable carrier” includes any material, which when combined with the conjugate retains the conjugates' activity and is non-reactive with the subject's immune systems.
- “Pharmaceutically acceptable carrier” includes solids and liquids, such as vehicles, diluents and solvents. Examples include, but are not limited to, any of the standard pharmaceutical carriers such as a phosphate buffered saline solution, water, emulsions such as oil/water emulsion, and various types of wetting agents. Other carriers may also include sterile solutions, tablets including coated tablets and capsules.
- Such carriers typically contain excipients such as starch, milk, sugar, certain types of clay, gelatin, stearic acid or salts thereof, magnesium or calcium stearate, talc, vegetable fats or oils, gums, glycols, or other known excipients.
- excipients such as starch, milk, sugar, certain types of clay, gelatin, stearic acid or salts thereof, magnesium or calcium stearate, talc, vegetable fats or oils, gums, glycols, or other known excipients.
- Such carriers may also include flavor and color additives or other ingredients.
- Compositions comprising such carriers are formulated by well known conventional methods.
- administering means oral administration, administration as a suppository, topical contact, intravenous, intraperitoneal, intramuscular, intralesional, or subcutaneous administration, administration by inhalation, or the implantation of a slow-release device, e.g., a mini-osmotic pump, to the subject.
- Adminsitration is by any route including parenteral and transmucosal (e.g., oral, nasal, vaginal, rectal, or transdermal), particularly by inhalation.
- Parenteral administration includes, e.g., intravenous, intramuscular, intra-arteriole, intradermal, subcutaneous, intraperitoneal, intraventricular, and intracranial.
- injection is to treat a tumor, e.g., induce apoptosis
- administration may be directly to the tumor and/or into tissues surrounding the tumor.
- Other modes of delivery include, but are not limited to, the use of liposomal formulations, intravenous infusion, transdermal patches, etc.
- Ameliorating refers to any indicia of success in the treatment of a pathology or condition, including any objective or subjective parameter such as abatement, remission or diminishing of symptoms or an improvement in a patient's physical or mental well-being. Amelioration of symptoms can be based on objective or subjective parameters; including the results of a physical examination and/or a psychiatric evaluation.
- therapy refers to “treating” or “treatment” of a disease or condition including preventing the disease or condition from occurring in a subject (e.g., human) that may be predisposed to the disease but does not yet experience or exhibit symptoms of the disease (prophylactic treatment), inhibiting the disease (slowing or arresting its development), providing relief from the symptoms or side-effects of the disease (including palliative treatment), and relieving the disease (causing regression of the disease).
- an amount effective to or a “therapeutically effective amount” or any gramatically equivalent term means the amount that, when administered to an animal or human for treating a disease, is sufficient to effect treatment for that disease.
- Insect cell culture refers to the in vitro growth and culturing of cell derived from organisms of the Class Insecta. “Insect cell culture” also refers to a cell culture comprising cells of the Class Insecta which have been grown and cultured in vitro.
- “Peptide” refers to a polymer in which the monomers are amino acids and are joined together through amide bonds, alternatively referred to as a polypeptide. Additionally, unnatural amino acids, for example, ⁇ -alanine, phenylglycine and homoarginine are also included. Amino acids that are not gene-encoded may also be used in the present invention. Furthermore, amino acids that have been modified to include reactive groups, glycosylation sites, polymers, therapeutic moieties, biomolecules and the like may also be used in the invention. All of the amino acids used in the present invention may be either the D - or L -isomer. The L -isomer is generally preferred. In addition, other peptidomimetics are also useful in the present invention.
- peptide refers to both glycosylated and unglycosylated peptides. Also included are petides that are incompletely glycosylated by a system that expresses the peptide. For a general review, see, Spatola, A. F., in C HEMISTRY AND B IOCHEMISTRY OF A MINO A CIDS , P EPTIDES AND P ROTEINS , B. Weinstein, eds., Marcel Dekker, New York, p. 267 (1983). The term peptide includes molecules that are commonly referred to as proteins or polypeptides.
- glycopeptide refers to a peptide having at least one carbohydrate moiety covalently linked thereto. It is understood that a glycopeptide may be a “therapeutic glycopeptide”.
- glycopeptide is used interchangeably herein with the terms “glycopolypeptide” and “glycoprotein.”
- peptide conjugate refers to species of the invention in which a peptide is conjugated with a modified sugar as set forth herein.
- modified sugar refers to a naturally- or non-naturally-occurring carbohydrate that is enzymatically added onto an amino acid or a glycosyl residue of a peptide in a process of the invention.
- the modified sugar is selected from a number of enzyme substrates including, but not limited to sugar nucleotides (mono-, di-, and tri-phosphates), activated sugars (e.g., glycosyl halides, glycosyl mesylates) and sugars that are neither activated nor nucleotides.
- the “modified sugar” is covalently functionalized with a “modifying group.”
- modifying groups include, but are not limited to, PEG moieties, therapeutic moieties, diagnostic moieties, biomolecules and the like.
- the modifying group is preferably not a naturally occurring, or an unmodified carbohydrate.
- the locus of functionalization with the modifying group is selected such that it does not prevent the “modified sugar” from being added enzymatically to a peptide.
- glycoconjugation refers to the enzymatically mediated conjugation of a modified sugar species to an amino acid or glycosyl residue of a polypeptide, e.g., an erythropoietin peptide prepared by the method of the present invention.
- a subgenus of “glycoconjugation” is “glyco-PEGylation,” in which the modifying group of the modified sugar is poly(ethylene glycol), an alkyl derivative (e.g., m-PEG) or reactive derivative (e.g., H 2 N-PEG, HOOC-PEG) thereof.
- large-scale and “industrial-scale” are used interchangeably and refer to a reaction cycle or process that produces at least about 250 mg, preferably at least about 500 mg, and more preferably at least about 1 gram of peptide at the completion of a single cycle.
- glycosyl linking group refers to a glycosyl residue to which a modifying group (e.g., PEG moiety, therapeutic moiety, biomolecule) is covalently attached; the glycosyl linking group joins the modifying group to the remainder of the conjugate.
- the “glycosyl linking group” becomes covalently attached to a glycosylated or unglycosylated polypeptide, thereby linking the modifying group to an amino acid and/or glycosyl residue of the polypeptide.
- glycosyl linking group is generally derived from a “modified sugar” by the enzymatic attachment of the “modified sugar” to an amino acid and/or glycosyl residue of the polypeptide.
- the glycosyl linking group can be a saccharide-derived structure that is degraded during formation of modifying group-modified sugar cassette (e.g., oxidation ⁇ Schiff base formation ⁇ reduction), or the glycosyl linking group may be intact.
- an “intact glycosyl linking group” refers to a linking group that is derived from a glycosyl moiety in which the saccharide monomer that links the modifying group and to the remainder of the conjugate is not degraded, e.g., oxidized, e.g., by sodium metaperiodate.
- “Intact glycosyl linking groups” of the invention may be derived from a naturally occurring oligosaccharide by addition of glycosyl unit(s) or removal of one or more glycosyl unit from a parent saccharide structure.
- a “glycosyl linking group” may include a glycosyl-mimetic moiety.
- the glycosyl transferase (e.g., sialyl transferase), which is used to add the modified sugar to a glycosylated polypeptide, exhibits tolerance for a glycosyl-mimetic substrate (e.g., a modified sugar in which the sugar moiety is a glycosyl-mimetic moiety—e.g., sialyl-mimetic moiety).
- a glycosyl-mimetic substrate e.g., a modified sugar in which the sugar moiety is a glycosyl-mimetic moiety—e.g., sialyl-mimetic moiety.
- the transfer of the modified glycosyl-mimetic sugar results in a conjugate having a glycosyl linking group that is a glycosyl-mimetic moiety.
- glycosyl-mimetic moiety refers to a moiety, which structurally resembles a glycosyl moiety (e.g., a hexose or a pentose).
- glycosyl moiety examples include those moieties, wherein the glycosidic oxygen or the ring oxygen of a glycosyl moiety, or both, has been replaced with a bond or another atom (e.g., sulfur), or another moiety, such as a carbon- (e.g., CH 2 ), or nitrogen-containing group (e.g., NH).
- Examples include substituted or unsubstituted cyclohexyl derivatives, cyclic thioethers, cyclic secondary amines, moieties including a thioglycosidic bond, and the like.
- the “glycosyl-mimetic moiety” is transferred in an enzymatically catalyzed reaction onto an amino acid residue of a polypeptide or a glycosyl moiety of a glycopeptide. This can, for instance, be accomplished by activating the “glycosyl-mimetic moiety” with a leaving group, such as a halogen.
- polypeptide glycoform or “glycoform” as used herein refers to two polypeptide conjugates having the same amino acid sequence, but having a different glycosylation pattern with respect to the glycan residues to which the modifying group(s), e.g., poly(alkylene oxide) moieties, are covalently linked.
- modifying group(s) e.g., poly(alkylene oxide) moieties
- FIG. 3B shows exemplary glycoforms of an EPO polypeptide conjugate.
- EPO-PEG conjugates discussed in the Examples, below, are alternatively referred to as EPO-PEG “species”, “forms” or “states”.
- isolated refers to a material that is essentially free from components, which are used to produce the material.
- isolated refers to a material that is essentially free from components which normally accompany the material in the mixture used to prepare the peptide conjugate.
- isolated and pure are used interchangeably.
- isolated peptide conjugates of the invention have a level of purity expressed as a range.
- the lower end of the range is about 50%, about 55%, about 60%, about 65%, about 70%, about 75% or about 80% and the upper end of the range is about 55%, about 60%, about 65%, about 70%, about 75%, about 80%, about 85%, about 90%, about 95% or more than about 95%.
- the peptide conjugates are more than about 90% pure, their purities are preferably expressed as a range.
- the lower end of the range being about 90%, about 92%, about 94%, about 96% or about 98% and the upper end of the range being about 92%, about 94%, about 96%, about 98% or about 100%.
- Purity of a polypeptide conjugate may be determined by any suitable, art-recognized method of analysis (e.g., band intensity on a silver stained gel, polyacrylamide gel electrophoresis, ELISA, HPLC and the like).
- An exemplary method is size-exclusion chromatography (SEC) HPLC, described herein below.
- Purity may be determined using relative “area under the curve” (AUC) values, which can typically be obtained for peaks in a chromatogram, such as an HPLC chromatogram.
- AUC area under the curve
- purities are determined by chromatographic or other means using a standard curve generated using a reference material of known purity. Purity may also be determined on a weight-by-weight basis.
- Methods that are useful for the determination of “purity” are also useful for the determination of the “concentration” of a particular component in a mixture (e.g., a composition of the invention) or relative concentration of one component with respect to one or more other components.
- SEC HPLC may be used to determine the ratio between different glycoforms or to determine the concentration of a specific glycoform in a composition of the invention.
- each member of the population speaks to the “homogeneity” of the sites on the peptide and to a population of peptide that share a common structure, e.g., a common glycosylation pattern glycosyl structure.
- “Homogeneity” refers to the structural consistency across a population of polypeptides. Thus, in a glycopeptide of the invention, in which each glycan residue has the same structure, the glycopeptide is said to be about 100% homogeneous. Similarly, when a in a population of glycopeptides, each glycopeptide has glycan residues of the same structure, such that each peptide of the population is essentially of the same molecular species, the population is said to be about 100% homogeneous. Homogeneity is typically expressed as a range. The lower end of the range of homogeneity for the peptide conjugates is about 60%, about 70% or about 80% and the upper end of the range of purity is about 70%, about 80%, about 90% or more than about 90%.
- the peptide conjugates are more than or equal to about 90% homogeneous, their homogeneity is also preferably expressed as a range.
- the lower end of the range of homogeneity is about 90%, about 92%, about 94%, about 96% or about 98%.
- the upper end of the range of purity is about 92%, about 94%, about 96%, about 98% or about 100%.
- the homogeneity of the peptide conjugates is typically determined by one or more methods known to those of skill in the art, e.g., gel electrophoresis, liquid chromatography-mass spectrometry (LC-MS), matrix assisted laser desorption mass time of flight spectrometry (MALDI-TOF), capillary electrophoresis, and the like.
- a polypeptide that includes multiple N-linked or O-linked glycosylation sites may have a glycosyl residue of the same structure present at all comparable glycosylation sites, at about 90% of all comparable sites, about 80% or about 75% of all comparable glycosylation sites. In these instances the polypeptide would be said to have a “substantially uniform glycosylation pattern”.
- the population may be said to have a “substantially uniform glycosylation pattern” when a majority of the peptides in the population represent essentially a single molecular species.
- peptides isolated from insect cells have a substantially uniform insect-specific glycosylation pattern. This refers to the fact that the majority of polypeptides, or substantially all of the polypeptides, in the preparation represent one distinct molecular species.
- substantially in the above definitions of “substantially uniform” generally means at least about 40%, at least about 45%, at least about 50%, at least about 55%, at least about 60%, at least about 65%, at least about 70%, 71%, 72%, 73%, 74%, 75%, 76%, 77%, 78%, 79%, at least about 80%, 81%, 82%, 83%, 84%, 85%, 86%, 87%, 88%, 89%, at least about 90%, 91%, 92%, 93%, 94%, 95%, 96%, 97%, 98%, 99%, or even 100% of the acceptor moieties are glycosylated with the expected insect cell specific glycosylation pattern.
- insect specific glycosylation pattern refers to the glycosylation pattern found on mature glycopeptides produced by insect cells.
- insect cells generate simple N-linked oligosaccharides terminating in mannose (for review, see e.g., Essentials of Glycobiology A. Varki et al. eds, CSHL Press (1999) pgs: 32-33).
- N-linked glycans produced by insect cell lines produce glycoproteins that (at maturity) include a Man 3 GlcNAc 2 structure. Fucose units may also be found on the GlcNAc residue that is directly linked to the peptide.
- a mature peptide emerging from a cell with an “insect specific glycosylation pattern” thus includes one or more glycans having a trimannosyl (Man 3 ) or Man 3 GlcNAc 2 structure.
- “Insect specific glycosylation pattern” also refers to polypeptide populations, in which essentially all of the polypeptides have glycan structures terminating with a common motive (e.g., the Man 3 or Man 3 GlcNAc 2 motive) and are not degraded, e.g., to expose one of the two GlcNAc residues directly bound to the polypeptide.
- loading buffer refers to the buffer, in which the polypeptide conjugate being purified is applied to a purification device, e.g. a chromatography column or a filter cartridge.
- the loading buffer is selected so that separation of the peptide conjugate of interest from unwanted impurities can be accomplished.
- a purification device e.g. a chromatography column or a filter cartridge.
- the pH of the loading buffer and the salt concentration in the loading buffer may be selected so that the polypeptide conjugate is initially retained on the column while certain impurities are found in the flow through.
- the loading buffer is selected to retain impurities while the desired polypeptide conjugate is found in the flow-through.
- the term “elution buffer” refers to the buffer, which is typically used to remove (elute) the polypeptide conjugate from the purification device (e.g. a chromatographic column or filter cartridge) to which it was applied earlier.
- the elution buffer is selected so that separation of the polypeptide conjugate of interest from unwanted impurities can be accomplished.
- concentration of a particular ingredient, such as a particular salt (e.g. NaCl) in the elution buffer is varied during the elution procedure (gradient). The gradient may be continuous or stepwise (interrupted by hold periods).
- controlled room temperature refers to a temperature of at least about 10° C., at least about 15° C., at least about 20° C. or at least about 25° C. Typically, controlled room temperature is between about 20° C. and about 25° C.
- the present invention provides processes for the isolation (e.g., large-scale isolation) of polypeptide conjugates from a mixture.
- the polypeptide conjugates isolated by the methods of the invention include at least one modifying group.
- Exemplary modifying groups include polymers, such as poly(alkylene oxide) moieties (e.g., poly(ethylene glycol) or poly(propylene glycol)). Exemplary modifying groups are described herein, below.
- the polypeptide conjugate is isolated from a reaction mixture.
- the reaction mixture is the product of a chemical reaction, such as a chemical PEGylation reaction.
- the reaction mixture may contain chemicals, such as unreacted polymeric reagents and/or hydrolysis products thereof.
- the reaction mixture is the product of an enzymatically catalyzed reaction, such as an enzymatically catalyzed glycoPEGylation reaction.
- the reaction mixture may include enzymes, and may further include reagents, such as unreacted enzyme substrates (e.g., nucleotide sugars and the like).
- the methods of the invention are suitable for the isolation of a polypeptide conjugate from the above listed reaction mixture components.
- the methods of the invention are useful to isolate a desired polypeptide conjugate from a mixture that includes other polypeptide conjugates, which are sought to be separated from the desired polypeptide conjugate.
- Such “unwanted” polypeptide conjugates or side-products may be generated during the same reaction that leads to the formation of the desired polypeptide conjugate.
- a recombinant polypeptide is subjected to a chemical PEGylation reaction.
- the reaction product includes different polypeptide conjugates, in which each type of polypeptide conjugate includes a different number of PEG moieties, e.g., the majority of the polypeptide conjugates includes three PEG moieties, while a small percentage of the polypeptide conjugates in the reaction mixture is covalently linked to only one or two PEG moieties.
- a recombinantly produced polypeptide is subjected to an enzymatically catalyzed glycoPEGylation reaction.
- the reaction mixture includes different polypeptide conjugates, in which each type of polypeptide conjugate has a different structure with respect to the number of PEG moieties covalently linked to the polypeptide and/or the structure of the glycan residues, to which each PEG moiety is attached to the polypeptide.
- the mixture may also contain unreacted polypeptide.
- HIC hydrophobic interaction chromatography
- HIC is efficient in separating an erythropoietin (EPO) conjugate that includes three poly(ethylene glycol) (PEG) moieties from other EPO conjugates that include 0, 1, 2, 4, 5, 6 or 7 PEG moieties.
- EPO erythropoietin
- PEG poly(ethylene glycol)
- HIC can be used to separate polypeptide conjugates that include the same number of poly(alkylene oxide) moieties, but wherein the polypeptide conjugates have a different glycosylation pattern.
- the methods of the invention may further employ additional chromatographic steps.
- the method includes anion exchange or mixed-mode chromatography in addition to HIC.
- the method includes cation exchange chromatography in addition to HIC.
- the method includes both, anion exchange or mixed-mode chromatography and cation exchange chromatography in addition to HIC.
- the method includes hydroxyapatite or fluoroapatite chromatography in addition to HIC.
- the chromatographic steps employed in the methods of the invention can be performed in any desired order.
- anion exchange or mixed-mode chromatography is performed prior to hydrophobic interaction chromatography.
- anion exchange or mixed-mode chromatography is performed after hydrophobic interaction chromatography.
- cation exchange chromatography is performed prior to hydrophobic interaction chromatography.
- cation exchange chromatography is performed after hydrophobic interaction chromatography.
- hydroxyapatite or fluoroapatite chromatography is performed prior to HIC.
- hydroxyapatite or fluoroapatite chromatography is performed after HIC.
- the invention provides a method of making a composition that includes a first polypeptide conjugate, wherein the first polypeptide conjugate includes a first number of poly(alkylene oxide) moieties covalently linked to a first polypeptide.
- the method includes: (a) contacting a mixture containing the first polypeptide conjugate with a hydrophobic interaction chromatography (HIC) medium; and (b) eluting the first polypeptide conjugate from the HIC medium.
- the method may further include: (c) eluting the first polypeptide conjugate from an anion exchange or mixed-mode chromatography medium.
- step (c) is performed prior to step (a).
- step (c) is performed after step (b).
- the method may further include: (d) eluting the first polypeptide conjugate from a cation exchange chromatography medium.
- step (d) is performed prior to step (a).
- step (d) is performed after step (b).
- the mixture includes additional polypeptide conjugates, from which the first polypeptide conjugate is isolated.
- the mixture includes a second polypeptide conjugate, wherein the second polypeptide conjugate has a second number of poly(alkylene oxide) moieties covalently linked to a second polypeptide.
- the first polypeptide and the second polypeptide have the same amino acid sequence.
- the first polypeptide and the second polypeptide have a different amino acid sequence.
- the first number and the second number are different, which means that the first polypeptide conjugate and the second polypeptide conjugate are distinguished by the number of poly(alkylene oxide) moieties that are linked to each polypeptide.
- the first polypeptide conjugate includes 3 poly(alkylene oxide) moieties, while the second polypeptide conjugate includes either 0, 1, 2 or 4 poly(alkylene oxide) moieties.
- the first polypeptide and the second polypeptide have the same amino acid sequence and the first polypeptide conjugate and the second polypeptide conjugate are distinguished by a different number of poly(alkylene oxide) moieties (first number and second number are different).
- the method of the invention is useful to provide a composition including a first polypeptide conjugate, wherein the concentration of the second polypeptide conjugate in this composition is less than about 30%, less than about 25%, less than about 20%, less than about 15% and preferably less than about 10%, less than about 9%, less than about 8%, less than about 7%, less than about 6%, less than about 5%, less than about 4%, less than about 3%, less than about 2% or less than about 1%.
- the mixture includes more than one glycoform of the first polypeptide conjugate and the method provides a composition, in which the combined concentration of all glycoforms having a structure distinct from the first polypeptide conjugate is less than about 30%, less than about 25%, less than about 20%, less than about 15% and preferably less than about 10%, less than about 9%, less than about 8%, less than about 7%, less than about 6%, less than about 5%, less than about 4%, less than about 3%, less than about 2% or less than about 1%.
- the first polypeptide is a glycopeptide and comprises a first glycosylation pattern that includes at least one glycan residue covalently linked to the first polypeptide.
- Each glycan residue can be linked to at least one polymeric modifying group, such as a poly(alkylene oxide) moiety.
- the first polypeptide includes a first number of poly(alkylene oxide) moieties, each of which is covalently linked to the first polypeptide via an N-linked or O-linked glycan.
- the method of the invention is useful to separate two polypeptide glycoforms that may include the same number of modifying groups, but that have different glycosylation patterns.
- the mixture from which the first polypeptide is isolated includes a third polypeptide conjugate that includes a third number of poly(alkylene oxide) moieties.
- the third polypeptide conjugate and the first polypeptide conjugate include the same number of poly(alkylene oxide) moieties, but the third polypeptide has a glycosylation pattern that differs from the glycosylation pattern of the first polypeptide conjugate by at least one glycosyl moiety.
- the third polypeptide conjugate includes a glycan residue that is not present in the first polypeptide conjugate.
- the third polypeptide includes an O-linked glycan, while the first polypeptide includes only N-linked glycans (see, e.g., FIG. 3B , tri-PEGylated EPO structures).
- the third polypeptide includes a truncated glycan residue, while the corresponding glycan residue of the first polypeptide conjugate is intact (i.e., includes a larger number of glycosyl moieties).
- the invention provides a method of isolating a first polypeptide conjugate including a first number of poly(alkylene oxide) moieties covalently linked to a first polypeptide, from a second polypeptide conjugate that includes a second number of poly(alkylene oxide) moieties covalently linked to a second polypeptide.
- the method includes: (a) contacting a mixture containing the first polypeptide conjugate and the second polypeptide conjugate with a hydrophobic interaction chromatography (HIC) medium; and (b) eluting the first polypeptide conjugate from said hydrophobic interaction chromatography medium.
- the method may further include: (c) eluting the first polypeptide conjugate from an anion exchange chromatography medium.
- step (c) is performed prior to step (a). In another embodiment, step (c) is performed after step (b).
- the method may further include: (d) eluting the first polypeptide conjugate from a cation exchange chromatography medium. In one embodiment, step (d) is performed prior to step (a). In another embodiment, step (d) is performed after step (b).
- the first number of poly(alkylene oxide) moieties that are linked to the first polypeptide is selected from 1 to about 40. In another example, the first number is selected from 1 to about 30. In yet another example, the first number is selected from 1 to about 20. In a further example, the first number is selected from 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9 and about 10. In another example, the first polypeptide conjugate includes exactly three poly(alkylene oxide) moieties.
- the second number of poly(alkylene oxide) moieties that are linked to the second polypeptide is selected from 0 to about 40. In another example, the second number is selected from 0 to about 30. In yet another example, the second number is selected from 0 to about 20. In a further example, the second number is selected from 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9 and about 10. In another example, the first number and the second number are different.
- the first polypeptide conjugate includes 3 poly(alkylene oxide) moieties, while the second polypeptide conjugate includes either 0, 1, 2 or 4 poly(alkylene oxide) moieties.
- the first polypeptide and the second polypeptide have the same amino acid sequence.
- the first polypeptide is a therapeutic polypeptide. Exemplary therapeutic polypeptides are described herein, below.
- the first polypeptide is EPO.
- both the first polypeptide and the second polypeptide are EPO.
- both the first polypeptide and the third polypeptide are EPO.
- the first polypeptide conjugate is formed by an enzymatically catalyzed glycomodification reaction, during which a modified glycosyl moiety [e.g., a glycosyl moiety modified with at least one poly(alkylene oxide) moiety] is covalently linked to the first polypeptide.
- a modified glycosyl moiety e.g., a glycosyl moiety modified with at least one poly(alkylene oxide) moiety
- the method of the invention may further include: contacting the first polypeptide and a modified glycosyl donor species (e.g., a modified sugar nucleotide) having a glycosyl moiety covalently linked to a polymer (e.g., a poly(alkylene oxide) moiety), in the presence of an enzyme (e.g., a glycosyltransferase), for which the modified glycosyl donor species is a substrate, under conditions sufficient for the enzyme to catalyze the formation of a covalent bond between the glycosyl moiety that is linked to the polymer and the first polypeptide.
- a modified glycosyl donor species e.g., a modified sugar nucleotide
- an enzyme e.g., a glycosyltransferase
- the modified glycosyl moiety is a sialic acid (SA) moiety.
- the enzyme is a sialyltransferase.
- the polymer is PEG (e.g., m-PEG). GlycoPEGylation methods are art-recognized; see for example, WO 03/031464 to DeFrees et al. or WO 04/99231, the disclosures of which are incorporated herein by reference in their entirety.
- the method of the invention may further include: recombinantly expressing the first polypeptide in a host cell, such as an insect cell, a mammalian cell (e.g., a CHO cell) or a fungal cell (e.g., yeast cell).
- a host cell such as an insect cell, a mammalian cell (e.g., a CHO cell) or a fungal cell (e.g., yeast cell).
- the first polypeptide is expressed in an insect cell line (e.g., a Spodoptera frugiperda cell, e.g., Sf9).
- the first polypeptide may be further modified (e.g., through glycan remodeling) to include a substantially uniform (e.g., insect-specific) glycosylation pattern.
- the glycosylation pattern of the peptides can be elaborated, trimmed back or otherwise modified by methods utilizing enzymes.
- the methods of remodeling peptides using enzymes that transfer a sugar donor to an acceptor are discussed in detail in WO 03/031464 to De Frees et al. (published Apr. 17, 2003); U.S. Patent Application 20040137557 (filed Nov. 5, 2002); U.S. Patent Application 20050143292 (filed Nov. 24, 2004) and WO 05/051327 (filed Nov. 24, 2004), each of which is incorporated herein by reference in its entirety.
- the method of the invention may further include: contacting the first polypeptide and a glycosyl donor molecule (e.g., a nucleotide sugar) in the presence of an enzyme for which the glycosyl donor molecule is a substrate, under conditions sufficient for the enzyme to form a covalent bond between a glycosyl moiety of the glycosyl donor molecule and the first polypeptide.
- a glycosyl donor molecule e.g., a nucleotide sugar
- the polypeptide used as a substrate in this reaction may be glycosylated or non-glycosylated.
- the enzyme may be a glycosyltransferase, such as a GlcNAc-transferase, a GalNAc-transferase, a Gal-transferase or a sialyltransferase.
- a glycosyltransferase such as a GlcNAc-transferase, a GalNAc-transferase, a Gal-transferase or a sialyltransferase.
- the method of the invention includes: contacting a glycosylated or non-glycosylated first polypeptide and a nucleotide-N-acetylglucosamine (GlcNAc) or a nucleotide-N-acetylgalactosamine (GalNAc) molecule in the presence of a N-acetylglucosamine transferase (e.g., GnT1 or GnT2) or a N-acetylgalactosamine transferase, respectively.
- the reaction mixture may further include a nucleotide galactose (Gal) molecule, and a galactosyl transferase (e.g., GalT1).
- the components of the reaction mixture are contacted (e.g., in a single reaction vessel or sequentially) under conditions sufficient for the N-acetylglucosamine transferase and the galactosyl transferase to form a glycosylated first polypeptide having at least one glycan residue with a terminal -GlcNAc-Gal moiety or a GalNAc-Gal moiety.
- That glycan residue is preferably mono-antennary with respect to the newly added GlcNAc-Gal or -GalNAc-Gal moiety.
- the GlcNAc-Gal moiety is added to a mannose residue, which is part of a tri-mannosyl motif.
- the -GalNAc-Gal moiety is added to a serine or threonine residue of the first polypeptide.
- the invention provides a method of making a composition that contains a first erythropoietin (EPO) conjugate, wherein the first EPO conjugate includes a first number of poly(alkylene oxide) moieties covalently linked to an EPO polypeptide.
- the method includes: (a) contacting a mixture containing the first EPO conjugate with an anion exchange medium; (b) eluting the first EPO conjugate from the anion exchange medium, forming a first eluate including the first EPO conjugate; (c) contacting the first eluate with a hydrophobic interaction chromatography (HIC) medium; and (d) eluting the first EPO conjugate from the hydrophobic interaction chromatography medium.
- HIC hydrophobic interaction chromatography
- the method may further include: (e) eluting the first EPO conjugate from a cation exchange chromatography medium.
- step (e) is performed after step (d).
- step (e) is performed prior to step (c).
- the method may further include one or more dilution or diafiltration steps.
- diafiltration is used to concentrate and/or exchange the buffer in order to condition the sample for the next process step. For example, the eluate from the HIC step is concentrated and diafiltered into a new buffer system in order to prepare the sample for cation exchange chromatography.
- the mixture includes additional EPO conjugates, from which the first EPO conjugate is isolated.
- the mixture includes a second EPO conjugate having a second number of poly(alkylene oxide) moieties covalently linked to an EPO polypeptide.
- the first number and the second number are different, which means that the first EPO conjugate and the second EPO conjugate are glycoforms distinguished by the number of poly(alkylene oxide) moieties that are linked to each EPO polypeptide.
- the first EPO conjugate includes 3 poly(alkylene oxide) moieties, while the second EPO conjugate may include 0, 1, 2 or 4 poly(alkylene oxide) moieties.
- the method is useful to provide a composition including a first EPO conjugate, wherein the concentration of the second EPO conjugate in this composition is less than about 30%, less than about 25%, less than about 20%, less than about 15% and preferably less than about 10%, less than about 9%, less than about 8%, less than about 7%, less than about 6%, less than about 5%, less than about 4%, less than about 3%, less than about 2% or less than about 1%.
- the mixture includes more than one glycoform of the first EPO conjugate and the method provides a composition, in which the combined concentration of all glycoforms having a structure distinct from the structure of the first EPO conjugate is less than about 30%, less than about 25%, less than about 20%, less than about 15% and preferably less than about 10%, less than about 9%, less than about 8%, less than about 7%, less than about 6%, less than about 5%, less than about 4%, less than about 3%, less than about 2% or less than about 1%.
- an exemplary EPO sequence useful in conjunction with any of the above embodiments is represented by SEQ ID NO:1, which may include at least one mutation (e.g., Arg 139 to Ala 139 , Arg 143 to Ala 143 and Lys 154 to Ala 154 ).
- the EPO conjugates of the invention may include at least one N-linked glycan residue.
- the N-linked glycan residue is covalently linked to an amino acid residue selected from Asn 24 , Asn 38 and Asn 83 of SEQ ID NO:1.
- the EPO conjugate may further include an O-linked glycan residue.
- the O-linked glycan residue is covalently linked to a serine (e.g., Ser 126) residue of SEQ ID NO:1. Any of the above described glycan residues can optionally be linked to a poly(alkylene oxide) moiety.
- EPO is covalently linked to three poly(alkylene oxide) moieties (e.g., three PEG moieties).
- EPO is covalently linked to three poly(alkylene oxide) moieties (e.g., PEG), wherein at least two of the three poly(alkylene oxide) moieties are covalently linked to the EPO polypeptide via N-linked glycans.
- at least one N-linked glycan is mono-antennary.
- all three N-linked glycans are mono-antennary (e.g., as shown in FIG. 3A ).
- Exemplary tri-PEGylated EPO conjugates are shown in FIG. 3B .
- the EPO conjugate is formed by an enzymatically catalyzed glycomodification reaction, wherein a modified glycosyl moiety (e.g., a glycosyl moiety modified with at least one poly(alkylene oxide) moiety) is attached to the EPO polypeptide.
- a modified glycosyl moiety e.g., a glycosyl moiety modified with at least one poly(alkylene oxide) moiety
- the method of the invention may further include: contacting an EPO polypeptide and a modified glycosyl donor species (e.g., a modified sugar nucleotide) having a glycosyl moiety covalently linked to a polymer (e.g., a poly(alkylene oxide) moiety), in the presence of an enzyme (e.g., a glycosyltransferase), for which the modified glycosyl donor species is a substrate, under conditions sufficient for the enzyme to catalyze the formation of a covalent bond between the glycosyl moiety that is linked to the polymer and the EPO polypeptide.
- a modified glycosyl donor species e.g., a modified sugar nucleotide
- an enzyme e.g., a glycosyltransferase
- the modified glycosyl moiety is a sialic acid (SA) moiety.
- the enzyme is a sialyltransferase.
- the method may further include: recombinantly expressing the EPO polypeptide in a host cell, such as a bacterial (e.g., E. coli ), an insect cell, a mammalian cell (e.g., CHO) cell or a fungal cell.
- the EPO polypeptide is expressed in an insect cell line (e.g., Sf9) and is optionally purified from insect cell culture, e.g., according to the methods outlined in WO 06/105426 to Kang et al.
- the EPO peptide may be further modified through glycan remodeling to include a substantially uniform (e.g., insect-specific) glycosylation pattern.
- the method of the invention may further include: contacting (e.g., in a single reaction vessel) a glycosylated EPO polypeptide with a nucleotide-N-acetylglucosamine (GlcNAc) molecule and a nucleotide galactose (Gal) molecule in the presence of a N-acetylglucosamine transferase (e.g., GnT1 or GnT2), and a galactosyl transferase (e.g., GalT1), under conditions sufficient for said N-acetylglucosamine transferase and said galactosyl transferase to form a glycosylated EPO polypeptide having at least one glycan residue with a terminal -GlcNAc-Gal
- That glycan residue is preferably mono-antennary with respect to the newly added GlcNAc-Gal moiety.
- the -GlcNAc-Gal moiety is added to a mannose residue, which is part of a tri-mannosyl motive.
- each poly(alkylene oxide) moiety is a member independently selected from poly(ethylene glycol) (e.g., m-PEG) and poly(propylene glycol) (e.g., m-PPG). Exemplary poly(ethylene glycol) moieties are described herein, below.
- each poly(alkylene oxide) moiety has an independently selected molecular weight between about 1 kDa and about 200 kDa. Additional molecular weight ranges for poly(alkylene oxide) moieties are given herein, below.
- the first polypeptide conjugate includes at least one poly(alkylene oxide) moiety that is covalently linked to the first polypeptide via a glycosyl linking group.
- the glycosyl linking group is covalently linked to an amino acid residue of the first polypeptide.
- the glycosyl linking group is covalently linked to a glycosyl moiety of said first polypeptide.
- the glycosyl linking group is an intact glycosyl linking group.
- glycosyl linking groups are described herein and, for example, in WO 03/031464 to DeFrees et al., WO 04/99231, and PCT/U.S.07/74139 filed Jul. 23, 2007, the disclosures of which are incorporated herein by reference in their entirety.
- Exemplary intact glycosyl linking groups include sialic acid moieties, GlcNH and GlcNAc moieties, as well as Gal, GalNH and GalNAc moieties.
- HIC media that are useful in any of the above described embodiments, include butyl and phenyl resins, such as Phenyl 650S (e.g., ToyoPearl). Hydrophobic interaction chromatography and suitable HIC media are described herein below and, for example in Process Scale Bioseparations for the Biopharmaceutical Industry , Ed. Shukla A A, Etzel M R, Gadam S, CRC Press Taylor & Francis Group (2007), pages 197-206, the disclosure of which is incorporated herein by reference.
- Phenyl 650S e.g., ToyoPearl
- Hydrophobic interaction chromatography and suitable HIC media are described herein below and, for example in Process Scale Bioseparations for the Biopharmaceutical Industry , Ed. Shukla A A, Etzel M R, Gadam S, CRC Press Taylor & Francis Group (2007), pages 197-206, the disclosure of which is incorporated herein by reference.
- polypeptide conjugates isolated by the methods of the invention include a polypeptide and at least one modifying group covalently linked to the polypeptide, e.g., via a glycosyl linking group.
- exemplary polypeptide conjugates are discussed herein below and, for example WO 03/031464 to DeFrees et al., WO 04/99231 to DeFrees et al., and WO 04/33651 to DeFrees et al., the disclosures of which are incorporated herein by reference in their entirety.
- polypeptide that is part of polypeptide conjugates of the invention can be any glycosylated or non-glycosylated polypeptide.
- the polypeptide is a recombinant polypeptide.
- the polypeptide is expressed in a host cell selected from bacterial cells (e.g., E. coli ), insect cells (e.g., Spodoptera frugiperda cells), fungal cells (e.g., yeast cells), mammalian cells (e.g., CHO cells) and bacterial cells (e.g., E. coli cells). Methods for the expression of polypeptides in insect cell lines are discussed herein below.
- the polypeptide is chemically synthesized and optionally includes non-natural amino acids.
- the polypeptide can have any number of amino acids.
- the peptide or glycopeptide has a molecular weight of about 5 kDa to about 500 kDa.
- the peptide or glycopeptide has a molecular weight of about 10 kDa to about 100 kDa.
- the polypeptide has a molecular weight of about 10 kDa to about 30 kDa.
- the polypeptide has a molecular weight of about 20 kDa to about 25 kDa.
- Exemplary polypeptides include wild-type polypeptides and fragments thereof as well as polypeptides, which are modified from their naturally occurring counterpart (e.g., by mutation or truncation).
- a polypeptide may also be a fusion protein.
- Exemplary fusion proteins include those, in which the polypeptide is fused to a fluorescent protein (e.g., GFP), a therapeutic polypeptide, an antibody, a receptor ligand, a proteinaceous toxin, MBP, a Histag and the like.
- the polypeptide is a therapeutic polypeptide (i.e., authorized drug), such as those currently used as pharmaceutical agents.
- a therapeutic polypeptide i.e., authorized drug
- Exemplary polypeptides include growth factors, such as fibroblast growth factors (e.g., FGF-1, FGF-2, FGF-3, FGF-4, FGF-5, FGF-6, FGF-7, FGF-8, FGF-9, FGF-10, FGF-11, FGF-12, FGF-13, FGF-14, FGF-15, FGF-16, FGF-17, FGF-18, FGF-19, FGF-20, FGF-21, FGF-22 and FGF-23), blood coagulation factors (e.g., Factor V, Factor VII, Factor VIII, B-domain deleted Factor VIII, partial B-domain deleted Factor VIII, vWF-Factor VIII fusion (e.g., with full-length or B-domain deleted Factor VIII), Factor IX, Factor X and Factor XIII), hormones, such as human growth hormone (hGH) and follicle stimulating hormone (FSH), as well as cytokines, such as interleukins (e.g., IL-1, IL-2,
- polypeptides include enzymes, such as glucocerebrosidase, alpha-galactosidase (e.g., FabrazymeTM), acid-alpha-glucosidase (acid maltase), alpha-L-iduronidase (e.g., AldurazymeTM), thyroid peroxidase (TPO), beta-glucosidase (see e.g., enzymes described in U.S. patent application Ser. No. 10/411,044), and alpha-galactosidase A (see e.g., enzymes described in U.S. Pat. No. 7,125,843).
- enzymes such as glucocerebrosidase, alpha-galactosidase (e.g., FabrazymeTM), acid-alpha-glucosidase (acid maltase), alpha-L-iduronidase (e.g., AldurazymeTM), thyroid
- exemplary parent polypeptides include bone morphogenetic proteins (e.g., BMP-1, BMP-2, BMP-3, BMP-4, BMP-5, BMP-6, BMP-7, BMP-8, BMP-9, BMP-10, BMP-11, BMP-12, BMP-13, BMP-14, BMP-15), neurotrophins (e.g., NT-3, NT-4, NT-5), erythropoietins (EPO), growth differentiation factors (e.g., GDF-5), glial cell line-derived neurotrophic factor (GDNF), brain derived neurotrophic factor (BDNF), nerve growth factor (NGF), von Willebrand factor (vWF), vWF protease, granulocyte colony stimulating factor (G-CSF), granulocyte-macrophage colony stimulating factor (GM-CSF), ⁇ 1 -antitrypsin (ATT, or ⁇ -1 protease inhibitor), tissue-type plasminogen activator (TPA), hirudi
- polypeptide is EPO comprising the amino acid sequence of (SEQ ID NO:1), which is shown below:
- polypeptides that are antibodies.
- the term antibody is meant to include antibody fragments (e.g., Fc domains), single chain antibodies, Lama antibodies, nano-bodies and the like.
- antibody-fusion proteins such as Ig chimeras.
- Preferred antibodies include humanized, monoclonal antibodies or fragments thereof. All known isotypes of such antibodies are within the scope of the invention.
- Exemplary antibodies include those to growth factors, such as endothelial growth factor (EGF), vascular endothelial growth factors (e.g., monoclonal antibody to VEGF-A, such as ranibizumab (LucentisTM)) and fibroblast growth factors, such as FGF-7, FGF-21 and FGF-23) and antibodies to their respective receptors.
- growth factors such as endothelial growth factor (EGF)
- vascular endothelial growth factors e.g., monoclonal antibody to VEGF-A, such as ranibizumab (LucentisTM)
- fibroblast growth factors such as FGF-7, FGF-21 and FGF-283
- Other exemplary antibodies include anti-TNF-alpha monoclonal antibodies (see e.g., U.S. patent application Ser. No.
- TNF receptor-IgG Fc region fusion protein e.g., EnbrelTM
- anti-HER2 monoclonal antibodies e.g., HerceptinTM
- monoclonal antibodies to protein F of respiratory syncytial virus e.g., SynagisTM
- monoclonal antibodies to TNF- ⁇ e.g., RemicadeTM
- monoclonal antibodies to glycoproteins such as IIb/IIIa (e.g., ReoproTM)
- monoclonal antibodies to CD20 e.g., RituxanTM
- CD4 and alpha-CD3 monoclonal antibodies to PSGL-1 and CEA.
- Any modified (e.g., mutated) version of any of the above listed polypeptides is also within the scope of the invention.
- the polypeptide is expressed in insect cells.
- Insect cells suitable for use in the present invention are from any order of the class Insecta which can be hosts to recombinant viruses (e.g. baculovirus) or wild-type viruses, and which can grow and produce recombinant peptide products upon infection with the virus in a medium composition of the invention.
- the cells are from the Diptera or Lepidoptera orders.
- Preferred are insect cell lines that can be used to produce polypeptides having a substantially uniform, insect-specific glycosylation pattern.
- the polypeptide is expressed by a stably transfected cell.
- NDV nuclear polyhedrosis virus
- Insect cell lines derived from the following insects are exemplary: Carpocapsa pomonella (preferably cell line CP-128); Trichoplusia ni (preferably cell line TN-368); Autographa californica; Spodoptera frugiperda (preferably cell line Sf9); Lymantria dispar; Mamestra brassicae; Aedes albopictus; Orgyia pseudotsugata; Neodiprion sertifer; Aedes aegypti; Antheraea eucalypti; Gnorimoschema opercullela; Galleria mellonella; Spodoptera littoralis; Drosophila melanogaster, Heliothis zea; Spodoptera exigua; Rachiplusia ou; Plodia interpunctella; Amsacta moorei; Agrotis c - nitrum, Adoxophyes orana, Agrotis segetum, Bombyx mori, Hyponomeu
- the insect cells are from Spodoptera frugiperda , and in another exemplary embodiment, the cell line is Sf9 (ATCC CRL 1711).
- Sf9, Sf21, and High-Five insect cells are commonly used for baculovirus expression.
- Sf9 and Sf21 are ovarian cell lines from Spodoptera frugiperda .
- High-Five cells are egg cells from Trichoplusia ni .
- Sf9, Sf21 and High-Five cell lines may be grown at room temperature (e.g. 25 to 27° C.), and do not require CO 2 incubators. Their doubling time is between about 18 and 24 hours.
- the insect cell lines cultured to produce the peptides and glycopeptides of the invention are preferably those suitable for the reproduction of numerous insect-pathogenic viruses such as picornaviruses, parvoviruses, entomopox viruses, baculoviruses and rhabdoviruses.
- insect-pathogenic viruses such as picornaviruses, parvoviruses, entomopox viruses, baculoviruses and rhabdoviruses.
- NPV nucleopolyhedrosis viruses
- GV granulosis viruses
- Baculoviruses are characterized by rod-shaped virus particles which are generally occluded in occlusion bodies (also called polyhedra).
- the family Baculoviridae can be divided in two subfamilies: the Eubaculovirinae comprising two genera of occluded viruses; nuclear polyhedrosis virus (NPV) and granulosis virus (GV), and the subfamily Nudobaculovirinae comprising the nonoccluded viruses.
- the polypeptide expressed in any suitable expression system is isolated from cell culture before the polypeptide is modified with a modifying group.
- the polypeptide is first removed from the cell culture medium, cellular debris and other particles and is then further purified to remove contaminants, such as viral particles and unwanted proteins, using a variety of filtration and chromatographic purification devices.
- Polypeptide purification techniques are known. See, e.g., Protein Purification Methods, A Practical Approach , Ed. Harris E L V, Angal S, IRL Press Oxford, England (1989), Protein Purification , Ed. Janson J C, Ryden L, VCH-Verlag, Weinheim, Germany (1989), Process Scale Bioseparations for the Biopharmaceutical Industry , Ed.
- the modifying group of the invention can be any chemical moiety. Exemplary modifying groups are discussed below.
- the modifying group is a linear or branched polymeric modifying group (polymer).
- a polymeric modifying group includes at least one polymeric moiety, wherein each polymeric moiety is independently selected.
- the polymeric modifying group is water-soluble.
- a water-soluble polymeric modifying group includes at least one polar group. Exemplary polar groups, include polyether groups, hydroxyl groups and carboxylic acid groups.
- water-soluble polymers are known to those of skill in the art and are useful in practicing the present invention.
- the term water-soluble polymer encompasses species such as saccharides (e.g., dextran, amylose, hyalouronic acid, poly(sialic acid), heparans, heparins, etc.); poly(amino acids), e.g., poly(aspartic acid) and poly(glutamic acid); nucleic acids; synthetic polymers (e.g., poly(acrylic acid), poly(alkylene oxides), peptides, proteins, and the like.
- the polymer is a poly(alkylene oxide), such as a poly(ethylene glycol) or a polypropylene glycol.
- the water-soluble polymer is polyethylene glycol (PEG) or a PEG analog, e.g., methoxy-poly(ethylene glycol) (m-PEG).
- the water-soluble polymer is polypropylene glycol (PPG), e.g., methoxy-polypropylene glycol (m-PPG).
- PEG is frequently used to modify the properties of polypeptides, such as therapeutic proteins. For example, the in vivo half-life of therapeutic glycopeptides can be enhanced with PEG moieties.
- PEGylation Chemical modification of polypeptides with PEG increases their molecular size and typically decreases surface- and functional group-accessibility, each of which are dependent on the number and size of the PEG moieties attached to the polypeptide. Frequently, this modification results in an improvement of plasma half-live and in proteolytic-stability, as well as a decrease in immunogenicity and hepatic uptake (Chaffee et al. J. Clin. Invest. 89: 1643-1651 (1992); Pyatak et al. Res. Commun. Chem. Pathol Pharmacol. 29: 113-127 (1980)).
- the in vivo half-life of a polypeptide derivatized with a PEG moiety by a method of the invention is increased relative to the in vivo half-life of the non-derivatized parent polypeptide.
- the poly(ethylene glycol) or poly(propylene glycol) is not restricted to any particular form or molecular weight range.
- the size of these modifying groups may, for example, depend on the nature and size of the polypeptide to which they are attached and the properties desired for the modified polypeptide.
- the molecular weight is preferably between about 0.5 kDa and about 500 kDa.
- Branched polymers may be larger than 500 kDa.
- branched poly(ethylene glycol) or poly(propylene glycol) have a molecular weight from about 0.5 kDa to about 1000 kDa.
- the PEG or PPG molecule of use in the invention (branched or unbranched) has a molecular weight selected from about 0.5 kDa, 1 kDa, about 2 kDa, about 5 kDa, about 10 kDa, about 15 kDa, about 20 kDa, about 25 kDa, about 30 kDa, about 35 kDa, about 40 kDa, about 45 kDa, about 50 kDa, about 55 kDa, about 60 kDa, about 65 kDa, about 70 kDa, about 75 kDa, about 80 kDa, about 85 kDa, about 90 kDa, about 95 kDa, about 100 kDa, about 105 kDa, about 110 kDa, about 115 kDa, about 120 kDa, about 125 kDa, about 130 kDa, about 135 kDa, about 140 kD
- the polypeptide is EPO.
- the EPO peptide has at least two, and preferably three poly(ethylene glycol) moieties covalently linked thereto.
- each PEG molecule linked to the EPO peptide has a molecular weight from about 2 kDa to about 80 kDa, preferably from about 5 kDa to about 60 kDa and more preferably from about 10 kDa to about 40 kDa.
- Exemplary water-soluble polymers are those in which a substantial proportion of the polymer molecules in a sample of the polymer are of approximately the same molecular weight; such polymers are “homodisperse.”
- Exemplary poly(ethylene glycol) molecules of use in the invention include, but are not limited to, those having the formula:
- R 8 is H, OH, NH 2 , substituted or unsubstituted alkyl, substituted or unsubstituted aryl, substituted or unsubstituted heteroaryl, substituted or unsubstituted heterocycloalkyl, substituted or unsubstituted heteroalkyl, e.g., acetal, OHC—, H 2 N—(CH 2 ) q —, HS—(CH 2 ) q , or —(CH 2 ) q C(Y)Z 1 .
- the index “e” represents an integer from 1 to 2500.
- the indices b, d, and q independently represent integers from 0 to 20.
- the symbols Z and Z 1 independently represent OH, NH 2 , leaving groups, e.g., imidazole, p-nitrophenyl, HOBT, tetrazole, halide, S—R 9 , the alcohol portion of activated esters; —(CH 2 ) p C(Y 1 )V, or —(CH 2 ) p U(CH 2 ) s C(Y 1 ) v .
- the symbol Y represents H(2), ⁇ O, ⁇ S, ⁇ N—R 10 .
- the symbols X, Y, Y 1 , A 1 , and U independently represent the moieties O, S, N—R′′.
- the symbol V represents OH, NH 2 , halogen, S—R 12 , the alcohol component of activated esters, the amine component of activated amides, sugar-nucleotides, and proteins.
- the indices p, q, s and v are members independently selected from the integers from 0 to 20.
- the symbols R 9 , R 10 , R 11 and R 12 independently represent H, substituted or unsubstituted alkyl, substituted or unsubstituted heteroalkyl, substituted or unsubstituted aryl, substituted or unsubstituted heterocycloalkyl and substituted or unsubstituted heteroaryl.
- poly(ethylene glycol) useful in forming the conjugate of the invention is either linear or branched.
- Branched poly(ethylene glycol) molecules suitable for use in the invention include, but are not limited to those described by the following formula:
- R 8 and R 8′ are members independently selected from the groups defined for R 8 , above.
- a 1 and A 2 are members independently selected from the groups defined for A 1 , above.
- the indices e, f, o, and q are as described above.
- Z and Y are as described above.
- X 1 and X 1′ are members independently selected from S, SC(O)NH, HNC(O)S, SC(O)O, O, NH, NHC(O), (O)CNH and NHC(O)O, OC(O)NH.
- the branched PEG is based upon a cysteine, serine or di-lysine core.
- the poly(ethylene glycol) molecule is selected from the following structures:
- the poly(ethylene glycol) is a branched PEG having more than one PEG moiety attached.
- branched PEGs are described in U.S. Pat. No. 5,932,462; U.S. Pat. No. 5,342,940; U.S. Pat. No. 5,643,575; U.S. Pat. No. 5,919,455; U.S. Pat. No. 6,113,906; U.S. Pat. No. 5,183,660; WO 02/09766; Kodera Y., Bioconjugate Chemistry 5: 283-288 (1994); and Yamasaki et al., Agric. Biol. Chem., 52: 2125-2127, 1998.
- the molecular weight of each poly(ethylene glycol) of the branched PEG is less than or equal to 40,000 daltons.
- Representative polymeric modifying moieties include structures that are based on side chain-containing amino acids, e.g., serine, cysteine, lysine, and small peptides, e.g., lys-lys.
- Exemplary structures include:
- the free amine in the di-lysine structures can also be pegylated through an amide or urethane bond with a PEG moiety.
- the polymeric modifying moiety is a branched PEG moiety that is based upon a tri-lysine peptide.
- the tri-lysine can be mono-, di-, tri-, or tetra-PEG-ylated.
- Exemplary species according to this embodiment have the formulae:
- indices e, f and f′ are independently selected integers from 1 to 2500; and the indices q, q′ and q′′ are independently selected integers from 1 to 20.
- the branched polymers of use in the invention include variations on the themes set forth above.
- the di-lysine-PEG conjugate shown above can include three polymeric subunits, the third bonded to the ⁇ -amine shown as unmodified in the structure above.
- the use of a tri-lysine functionalized with three or four polymeric subunits labeled with the polymeric modifying moiety in a desired manner is within the scope of the invention.
- An exemplary branched modifying group including one or more polymeric moieties includes the formula:
- the branched polymer species according to this formula are essentially pure water-soluble polymers.
- C is carbon.
- X 5 is a non-reactive group.
- X 5 is selected from H, OH and C 1 -C 6 alkyl (e.g., CH 3 , —CH 2 CH 3 ) optionally substituted with OH.
- R 16 and R 17 are independently selected from non-reactive groups (e.g., H, unsubstituted alkyl, unsubstituted heteroalkyl) and polymeric arms (e.g., PEG).
- X 2 and X 4 are linkage fragments that are preferably essentially non-reactive under physiological conditions. X 2 and X 4 are independently selected.
- An exemplary linker includes neither aromatic nor ester moieties.
- these linkages can include one or more moiety that is designed to degrade under physiologically relevant conditions, e.g., esters, disulfides, etc.
- X 2 and X 4 join the polymeric arms R 16 and R 17 to C.
- Exemplary linkage fragments including X 2 and X 4 are independently selected and include S, SC(O)NH, HNC(O)S, SC(O)O, O, NH, NHC(O), (O)CNH and NHC(O)O, and OC(O)NH, CH 2 S, CH 2 O, CH 2 CH 2 O, CH 2 CH 2 S, (CH 2 ) o O, (CH 2 ) o S or (CH 2 ) o Y′-PEG wherein, Y′ is S, NH, NHC(O), C(O)NH, NHC(O)O, OC(O)NH, or O and o is an integer from 1 to 50.
- the linkage fragments X 2 and X 4 are different linkage fragments.
- the modifying group is derived from a natural or unnatural amino acid, amino acid analog or amino acid mimetic, or a small peptide formed from one or more such species.
- certain branched polymers found in the polypeptide conjugates of the invention have the formula, wherein La is a linker moiety that links the modifying group to the remainder of the polypeptide conjugate.
- L a is a linking moiety having the structure:
- X a and X b are independently selected linkage fragments and L 1 is selected from a bond, substituted or unsubstituted alkyl or substituted or unsubstituted heteroalkyl.
- Exemplary species for X a and X b include S, SC(O)NH, HNC(O)S, SC(O)O, O, NH, NHC(O), C(O)NH and NHC(O)O, and OC(O)NH.
- X 4 is a peptide bond to R 17 , which is an amino acid, di-peptide (e.g., Lys-Lys) or tri-peptide (e.g., Lys-Lys-Lys) in which the alpha-amine moiety(ies) and/or side chain heteroatom(s) are modified with a polymeric modifying moiety.
- R 17 is an amino acid, di-peptide (e.g., Lys-Lys) or tri-peptide (e.g., Lys-Lys-Lys) in which the alpha-amine moiety(ies) and/or side chain heteroatom(s) are modified with a polymeric modifying moiety.
- polypeptide conjugate includes a moiety selected from the group:
- the indices e and f are independently selected from the integers from 1 to 2500. In further exemplary embodiments, e and f are selected to provide a PEG moiety that is about 1 kDa, 2 kDa, 5 kDa, 10 kDa, 15 kDa, 20 kDa, 25 kDa, 30 kDa, 35 kDa, 40 kDa, 45 kDa, 50 kDa, 55 kDa, 60 kDa, 65 kDa, 70 kDa, 75 kDa and 80 kDa.
- the symbol Q represents substituted or unsubstituted alkyl (e.g., C 1 -C 6 alkyl, e.g., methyl), substituted or unsubstituted heteroalkyl or H.
- branched polymers have structures based on di-lysine (Lys-Lys) peptides, e.g.:
- the indices e, f, f′ and f′′ represent integers independently selected from 1 to 2500.
- the indices q, q′ and q′′ represent integers independently selected from 1 to 20.
- the conjugates of the invention include a formula which is a member selected from:
- Q is a member selected from H and substituted or unsubstituted C 1 -C 6 alkyl.
- the indices e and f are integers independently selected from 1 to 2500, and the index q is an integer selected from 0 to 20.
- the conjugates of the invention include a formula which is a member selected from:
- Q is a member selected from H and substituted or unsubstituted C 1 -C 6 alkyl, preferably Me.
- the indices e, f and f' are integers independently selected from 1 to 2500, and q and q' are integers independently selected from 1 to 20.
- the conjugate of the invention includes a structure according to the following formula:
- indices m and n are integers independently selected from 0 to 5000.
- the indices j and k are integers independently selected from 0 to 20.
- a 1 , A 2 , A 3 , A 4 , A 5 , A 6 , A 7 , A 8 , A 9 , A 10 and A 11 are members independently selected from H, substituted or unsubstituted alkyl, substituted or unsubstituted heteroalkyl, substituted or unsubstituted aryl, substituted or unsubstituted cycloalkyl, substituted or unsubstituted heterocycloalkyl, substituted or unsubstituted heteroaryl, —NA 12 A 13 , —OA 12 and —SiA 12 A 13 .
- a 12 and A 13 are members independently selected from substituted or unsubstituted alkyl, substituted or unsubstituted heteroalkyl, substituted or unsubstituted cycloalkyl, substituted or unsubstituted heterocycloalkyl, substituted or unsubstituted aryl, and substituted or unsubstituted heteroaryl.
- the branched polymer has a structure according to the following formula:
- a 1 and A 2 are members independently selected from OCH 3 and OH.
- the linker L a is a member selected from aminoglycine derivatives.
- Exemplary polymeric modifying groups according to this embodiment have a structure according to the following formulae:
- a 1 and A 2 are members independently selected from OCH 3 and OH.
- Exemplary polymeric modifying groups according to this example include:
- the stereocenter can be either racemic or defined. In one embodiment, in which such stereocenter is defined, it has (S) configuration. In another embodiment, the stereocenter has (R) configuration.
- one or more of the m-PEG arms of the branched polymer can be replaced by a PEG moiety with a different terminus, e.g., OH, COOH, NH 2 , C 2 -C 10 -alkyl, etc.
- the structures above are readily modified by inserting alkyl linkers (or removing carbon atoms) between the ⁇ -carbon atom and the functional group of the side chain.
- “homo” derivatives and higher homologues, as well as lower homologues are within the scope of cores for branched PEGs of use in the present invention.
- linear and branched PEG conjugates set forth herein may be prepared using art-recognized methods.
- Several reviews and monographs on the functionalization and conjugation of PEG are available. See, for example, Harris, Cellol. Chem. Phys . C25: 325-373 (1985); Scouten, Methods in Enzymology 135: 30-65 (1987); Wong et al., Enzyme Microb. Technol. 14: 866-874 (1992); Delgado et al., Critical Reviews in Therapeutic Drug Carrier Systems 9: 249-304 (1992); Zalipsky, Bioconjugate Chem. 6: 150-165 (1995); and Bhadra, et al., Pharmazie, 57:5-29 (2002).
- the modifying group is covalently linked to the polypeptide via a glycosyl linking group.
- the saccharide component of the modified sugar when interposed between the polypeptide and a modifying group, becomes a “glycosyl linking group.”
- the glycosyl linking group is formed from a mono- or oligosaccharide that, after modification with a modifying group, is a substrate for an appropriate enzyme, such as a glycosyltransferase.
- the glycosyl linking group is formed from a glycosyl-mimetic moiety.
- the polypeptide conjugates of the invention can include glycosyl linking groups that are mono- or multi-valent (e.g., antennary structures).
- conjugates of the invention include both species in which a modifying group is attached to a polypeptide via a monovalent glycosyl linking group. Also included within the invention are conjugates in which more than one modifying group is attached to a polypeptide via a multivalent linking group. Exemplary linking groups are disclosed in PCT/U.S.07/74139 filed Jul. 23, 2007, the disclosure of which is incorporated by reference herein in its entirety.
- the invention provides a method for the isolation of a glycopeptide that is conjugated to a polymeric modifying moiety through an intact glycosyl linking group having a formula that is selected from:
- R 2 is H, CH 2 OR 7 , COOR 7 or OR 7 , in which R 7 represents H, substituted or unsubstituted alkyl or substituted or unsubstituted heteroalkyl.
- R 7 represents H, substituted or unsubstituted alkyl or substituted or unsubstituted heteroalkyl.
- COOR 7 is a carboxylic acid or carboxylate
- both forms are represented by the designation of the single structure COO ⁇ or COOH.
- the symbols R 3 , R 4 , R 5 , R 6 and R 6′ independently represent H, substituted or unsubstituted alkyl, OR 8 , NHC(O)R 9 .
- the index d is 0 or 1.
- R 8 and R 9 are independently selected from H, substituted or unsubstituted alkyl, substituted or unsubstituted heteroalkyl, sialic acid or polysialic acid.
- At least one of R 3 , R 4 , R 5 , R 6 or R 6′ includes the polymeric modifying moiety e.g., PEG, linked through a bond or a linking group.
- R 6 and R 6′ together with the carbon to which they are attached are components of the pyruvyl side chain of sialic acid. In a further exemplary embodiment, this side chain is functionalized with the polymeric modifying moiety.
- R 6 and R 6′ together with the carbon to which they are attached are components of the side chain of sialic acid and the polymeric modifying moiety is a component of R 5 .
- the polymeric modifying moiety is bound to the sugar core, generally through a heteroatom, e.g, nitrogen, on the core through a linker, L, as shown below:
- R 1 is the polymeric moiety and L is selected from a bond and a linking group.
- the index w represents an integer selected from 1-6, preferably 1-3 and more preferably 1-2.
- Exemplary linking groups include substituted or unsubstituted alkyl, substituted or unsubstituted heteroalkyl moieties and sialic acid.
- An exemplary component of the linker is an acyl moiety.
- An exemplary compound according to the invention has a structure according to Formulae I or II, in which at least one of R 2 , R 3 , R 4 , R 5 , R 6 or R 6′ has the formula:
- At least one of R 2 , R 3 , R 4 , R 5 , R 6 or R 6′ has the formula:
- R 1 is a linear polymeric modifying moiety
- the polymeric modifying moiety-linker construct is a branched structure that includes two or more polymeric chains attached to central moiety.
- the construct has the formula:
- R 1 and L are as discussed above and w' is an integer from 2 to 6, preferably from 2 to 4 and more preferably from 2 to 3.
- L When L is a bond it is formed between a reactive functional group on a precursor of R 1 and a reactive functional group of complementary reactivity on the saccharyl core.
- a precursor of L can be in place on the glycosyl moiety prior to reaction with the R 1 precursor.
- the precursors of R 1 and L can be incorporated into a preformed cassette that is subsequently attached to the glycosyl moiety.
- the selection and preparation of precursors with appropriate reactive functional groups is within the ability of those skilled in the art.
- coupling the precursors proceeds by chemistry that is well understood in the art.
- L is a linking group that is formed from an amino acid, or small peptide (e.g., 1-4 amino acid residues) providing a modified sugar in which the polymeric modifying moiety is attached through a substituted alkyl linker.
- exemplary linkers include glycine, lysine, serine and cysteine.
- the PEG moiety can be attached to the amine moiety of the linker through an amide or urethane bond.
- the PEG is linked to the sulfur or oxygen atoms of cysteine and serine through thioether or ether bonds, respectively.
- R 5 includes the polymeric modifying moiety.
- R 5 includes both the polymeric modifying moiety and a linker, L, joining the modifying moiety to the remainder of the molecule.
- L can be a linear or branched structure.
- the polymeric modifying can be branched or linear.
- the present invention provides methods for the isolation of an erythropoietin peptide conjugate comprising the moiety:
- D is a member selected from —OH and R 1 -L-HN—; G is a member selected from H and R 1 -L- and —C(O)(C 1 -C 6 )alkyl; R 1 is a moiety comprising a straight-chain or branched poly(ethylene glycol) residue; and L is a linker, e.g., a bond (“zero order”), substituted or unsubstituted alkyl and substituted or unsubstituted heteroalkyl.
- D is a member selected from —OH and R 1 -L-HN—
- G is a member selected from H and R 1 -L- and —C(O)(C 1 -C 6 )alkyl
- R 1 is a moiety comprising a straight-chain or branched poly(ethylene glycol) residue
- L is a linker, e.g., a bond (“zero order”), substituted or unsubstituted alkyl and
- the invention provides a conjugate formed between a modified sugar of the invention and a substrate EPO peptide.
- the sugar moiety of the modified sugar becomes a glycosyl linking group interposed between the peptide substrate and the modifying group.
- An exemplary glycosyl linking group is an intact glycosyl linking group, in which the glycosyl moiety or moieties forming the linking group are not degraded by chemical (e.g., sodium metaperiodate) or enzymatic (e.g., oxidase) processes.
- Selected conjugates of the invention include a modifying group that is attached to the amine moiety of an amino-saccharide, e.g., mannosamine, glucosamine, galactosamine, sialic acid etc.
- exemplary modifying group-intact glycosyl linking group cassettes according to this motif are based on a sialic acid structure, such as those having the formulae:
- R 1 and L are as described above. Further detail about the structure of exemplary R 1 groups is provided below.
- the conjugate is formed between a substrate EPO and a saccharyl moiety in which the modifying group is attached through a linker at the 6-carbon position of the saccharyl moiety.
- illustrative conjugates according to this embodiment have the formula:
- saccharyl moieties include, without limitation, glucose, glucosamine, N-acetyl-glucosamine, galactose, galactosamine, N-acetyl-galactosamine, mannose, mannosamine, N-acetyl-mannosamine, and the like.
- the glycosyl structures on the peptide conjugates of the invention can have substantially any structure.
- the glycans can be O-linked or N-linked.
- each of the pyranose and furanose derivatives discussed above can be a component of a glycosyl moiety of a peptide.
- the invention provides a modified EPO peptide that includes a glycosyl group having the formula:
- the group has the formula:
- the group has the formula:
- the group has the formula:
- index p represents and integer from 1 to 10; and a is either 0 or 1.
- a glycoPEGylated EPO peptide of the invention includes at least one N-linked glycosyl residue selected from the glycosyl residues set forth below:
- R 15′ represents H, OH (e.g., Gal-OH), a sialyl moiety, a polymer modified sialyl moiety (i.e., glycosyl linking group-polymeric modifying moiety (Sia-L-R 1 )) or a sialyl moiety to which is bound a polymer modified sialyl moiety (e.g., Sia-Sia-L-R 1 ) (“Sia-Sia p ”).
- An exemplary EPO peptide of the invention will include at least one glycan having a R 15′ .
- the oxygen, with the open valence, of Formulae I and II is preferably attached through a glycosidic linkage to a carbon of a Gal or GalNAc moiety.
- the oxygen is attached to the carbon at position 3 of a galactose residue.
- the modified sialic acid is linked ⁇ 2,3- to the galactose residue.
- the sialic acid is linked ⁇ 2,6- to the galactose residue.
- the modified glycan is bound to one or more position selected from Asn 24, Asn 38, Asn 83 and/or Ser 126.
- the EPO is derived from mammalian cells and the modifying group is only on the glycan at Asn 24.
- the glycosyl linking moiety is linked to a Sia residue through another Sia residue, e.g.:
- An exemplary species according to this motif is prepared by conjugating Sia-L-R 1 to a terminal sialic acid of the glycan at Asn 24 using an enzyme that forms Sia-Sia bonds, e.g., CST-II, ST8Sia-II, ST8Sia-III and ST8Sia-IV.
- the glycans have a formula that is selected from the group:
- the glycans of this group generally correspond to those found on an EPO peptide that is produced by insect cells (e.g., Sf9), followed by remodeling of the glycan and glycoPEGylation according to the methods set forth herein.
- insect-derived EPO that is expressed with a tri-mannosyl core is subsequently contacted with a GlcNAc donor and a GlcNAc transferase and a Gal donor and a Gal transferase.
- Appending GlcNAc and Gal to the tri-mannosyl core is accomplished in either two steps or a single step.
- a modified sialic acid is added to at least one branch of the glycosyl moiety as discussed herein.
- Those Gal moieties that are not functionalized with the modified sialic acid are optionally “capped” by reaction with a sialic acid donor in the presence of a sialyl transferase.
- At least 60% of terminal Gal moieties in a population of peptides is capped with sialic acid, preferably at least 70%, more preferably, at least 80%, still more preferably at least 90% and even more preferably at least 95%, 96%, 97%, 98% or 99% are capped with sialic acid.
- an exemplary modified EPO peptide of the invention will include at least one glycan with an R 15′ moiety having a structure according to Formulae I or II.
- the EPO is derived from insect cells, which are remodeled by adding GlcNAc and Gal to the mannose core.
- the remodeled peptide is glycopegylated using a sialic acid bearing a linear PEG moiety, affording an EPO peptide that comprises at least one moiety having the formula:
- the EPO peptide includes three such moieties, one attached at each of Asn 24, Asn 38 and Asn 83. In another embodiment, the peptide includes two such moieties attached at a combination of two of these Asn moieties.
- a composition that is a mixture of these two species (i.e., PEG 3 and PEG 2 ). The mixture preferably includes at least 75%, preferably at least 80%, more preferably at least 85%, still more preferably 90% and even more preferably 95%, 96%, 97% or 98% of the species that includes the three modified glycosyl residues. Unmodified terminal Gal residues are optionally capped with Sia as discussed above.
- the peptide is expressed in insect cells, remodeled and glycopegylated.
- e for each of the modified glycosyl moieties is an integer that provides as PEG moiety having a molecular weight of approximately 10 kDa.
- membrane filtration and chromatographic techniques described below are useful steps within the methods of the invention and apply to the isolation of polypeptide conjugates, in which a polypeptide is linked to at least one modifying group, such as a poly(alkylene oxide) moiety. It is to be understood that unless the order of steps is explicitly recited, the exemplary steps can be performed in any desired order.
- the methods of the invention includes one or more membrane filtration steps.
- Membrane filtration is a separation technique widely used for clarifying, concentrating, and purifying polypeptides.
- the polypeptide purification process of the present invention includes at least one diafiltration/ultrafiltration step, e.g., as the final process step to generate a composition suitable for storage.
- diafiltration/ultrafiltration is performed to condition a mixture for a chromatographic process step.
- the eluate from a hydrophobic interaction chromatography step is concentrated and the buffer is exchanged to prepare the sample for the next purification step (e.g., cation exchange chromatography).
- the diafiltration step is employed to concentrate the sample. In another exemplary embodiment the diafiltration step is employed to alter the buffer. In yet another exemplary embodiment, the new buffer is suitable for storage of the purified polypeptide conjugate.
- the diafiltration/ultrafiltration membrane can have any molecular weight cuttoff (MWCO) specification.
- the feed is passed through an ultrafiltration membrane with a MWCO suitable to concentrate the purified polypeptide conjugate.
- the selected MWCO will depend on the combined size of the polypeptide and the modifying group, such as the size of a poly(alkylene oxide) moiety covalently linked to the polypeptide.
- the membrane is chosen to have a MWCO that is substantially lower than the molecular weight of the purified peptide conjugate.
- the ultrafiltration membrane is selected to have a MWCO that is 3 to 6 times lower than the molecular weight of the peptide conjugate to be retained by the membrane.
- the diafiltration membrane has a MWCO of about 2 kDa to about 500 kDa. In another exemplary embodiment, the diafiltration membrane has a MWCO of about 5 kDa to about 400 kDa, about 5 kDa to about 300 kDa or about 5 kDa to about 200 kDa.
- the diafiltration membrane has a MWCO of about 5 kDa to about 180 kDa, 5 kDa to about 160 kDa, 5 kDa to about 140 kDa, 5 kDa to about 130 kDa, 5 kDa to about 120 kDa, 5 kDa to about 110 kDa, or 5 kDa to 100 kDa.
- the diafiltration membrane has a MWCO of about 5 kDa to about 80 kDa, 5 kDa to about 60 kDa, 5 kDa to about 40 kDa or 5 kDa to about 20 kDa.
- the diafiltration membrane has a MWCO of about 8 kDa to about 12 kDa and preferably about 10 kDa.
- filtration is effected using a transmembrane pressure between about 1 and about 30 psi and a filter membrane with a MWCO of between about 5 kDa to about 15 kDa, and preferably 10 kDa.
- the filtration step produces a retentate stream and a permeate stream.
- the retentate may be recycled to a reservoir for the peptide solution feed under conditions of essentially constant peptide concentration in the feed by adding a buffer solution to the retentate.
- the surface area of the filtration membrane used will generally depend on the amount of peptide conjugate to be purified.
- the membrane may be made of a low-binding material to minimize adsorptive losses and is preferably durable, cleanable, and chemically compatible with the buffers to be used.
- a number of suitable membranes are commercially available.
- the ultrafiltration/diafiltration membrane is a member selected from cellulose acetate, regenerated cellulose and polyethersulfone. Suitable membranes include those, in which the membrane polymer is chemically modified. In a preferred embodiment, the membrane is regenerated cellulose.
- the flow rate is adjusted to maintain a constant transmembrane pressure.
- filtration will proceed faster with higher pressures and higher flow rates, but higher flow rates may also result in damage to the peptide or loss of peptide due to passage through the membrane.
- various devices may have certain pressure limitations on their operation, and the pressure is adjusted according to the manufacturer's specification. In an exemplary embodiment, the pressure is between about 1 to about 30 psi, and in another exemplary embodiment the pressure is between about 8 psi to about 15 psi.
- the circulation pump is a peristaltic pump or diaphragm pump in the feed channel and the pressure is controlled by adjusting the retentate valve.
- the retentate is collected.
- Water or an aqueous buffer e.g. diafiltration buffer
- the wash liquid may be combined with the original retentate containing the concentrated peptide.
- the retentate is optionally dialyzed against another buffer, such as TRIS or HEPES.
- the purified product is stored at a low temperature.
- the product is stored at about ⁇ 20° C. at a polypeptide concentration of about 1 mg to about 10 mg of peptide conjugate per mL storage buffer.
- the product solution maybe sterile filtered, e.g., using a membrane filter having a pore size of about 2 ⁇ M (e.g., cellulose acetate filter).
- chromatographic techniques such as size exclusion chromatography (gel filtration), ion exchange chromatography, hydrophobic interaction chromatography (HIC), affinity chromatography, mixed-mode chromatography, hydroxyapatite and fluoroapatite chromatography are used for the isolation of polypeptides and proteins. These technologies can also be used to isolate polypeptide conjugates.
- methods of the invention employ a combination of several chromatographic techniques. The order in which these steps are performed is dependent on the nature of the polypeptide conjugate being purified and the nature of the contaminants to be removed.
- Suitable techniques for the practice of the invention separate the polypeptide conjugate of interest from a variety of contaminants on the basis of charge, degree of hydrophobicity, and/or size. Different chromatographic resins and membranes are available for each of these techniques, allowing accurate tailoring of the purification scheme.
- the components in a mixture interact differently with the column material and move at different rates along the column length, achieving a physical separation that increases as the components pass through the column.
- components of the mixture including the peptide conjugate of interest, adhere selectively to the separation medium, while other components are found in the flow-through.
- the initially retained components are then eluted differentially by varying the composition of the solvent or buffer system.
- the desired components are found in the flow-through while impurities are retained on the column and thus removed from the mixture.
- the methods of the invention employ at least one ion exchange chromatography step.
- Anion and cation exchange chromatography are known in the art. Ion exchange chromatography separates compounds based on their net charge. Ionic molecules are classified as either anions (having a negative charge) or cations (having a positive charge). Some molecules (e.g., proteins) may have both anionic and cationic groups. A positively charged support (anion exchanger) will bind a compound with an overall negative charge. Conversely, a negatively charged support (cation exchanger) will bind a compound with an overall positive charge. Ion exchange matrices can be further categorized as either strong or weak exchangers.
- Strong ion exchange matrices are charged (ionized) across a wide range of pH levels. Weak ion exchange matrices are ionized within a narrow pH range.
- the ionic groups of exchange columns are covalently bound to the gel matrix and are compensated by small concentrations of counter ions, which are present in the buffer.
- the most common ion exchange chemistries include: quaternary ammonium residues (Q) for strong anion exchange, diethylaminoethyl residues (DEAE) for weak anion exchange, sulfopropyl (SP) resins and sulfonic acid (S) resins for strong cation exchange and carboxymethyl residues (CM) for weak cation exchange.
- the sample components are preferably collected at the top of the column.
- the gradient is begun with the addition of a stronger eluting mobile phase, the sample components begin their separation. If poor separation is observed, it might be improved by a change in the gradient slope. If the polypeptide conjugate does not bind to the column under the selected conditions, the composition and/or the pH of the starting buffer should be changed.
- the buffer system can further be optimized by choosing different buffer salts since each buffer composition solvates the ion exchanger and the sample components uniquely.
- any conventional buffer system with a salt concentration of about 5 mM up to about 50 mM can be used for ion exchange chromatography.
- positively charged buffering ions are used for anion exchangers and negatively charged ones are used for cation exchangers.
- Phosphate buffers are generally used on both exchanger types.
- the highest salt concentration that permits binding of the peptide of interest is used as the starting condition.
- all buffers are prepared from MilliQ-water and filtered (0.45 or 0.22 ⁇ m filter).
- a sample containing the peptide conjugate of interest is loaded onto an anion exchanger in a loading buffer comprising a salt concentration below the concentration at which the peptide would elute from the column.
- the pH of the buffer is selected so that the purified peptide is retained on the anion exchange medium. Changing the pH of the buffer alters the charge of the peptide, and lowering the pH value shortens the retention time with anion exchangers.
- the isoelectric point (pI) of a protein is the pH at which the charge of a protein is zero.
- the pH value of the buffer is kept 1.5 to 2 times higher than the pI value of the peptide of interest.
- the anion exchange conditions are selected to preferentially bind impurities, while the purified peptide is found in the flow-through.
- the column may be washed with several column volumes (CV) of buffer to remove unbound substances and/or those substances that bind weakly to the resin. Fractions are then eluted from the column using, for example, a saline gradient according to conventional methods. The salt in the solution competes with the protein in binding to the column and the protein is released. Components with weak ionic interactions elute at a lower salt concentration than components with a strong ionic interaction. Sample fractions are collected from the column. Fractions containing high levels of the desired peptide and low levels of impurities are pooled or processed separately.
- CV column volumes
- anion exchange used in the process of the current invention is employed to isolate the polypeptide conjugate from contaminants such as particulates, chemicals and proteins/peptides (e.g., enzymes used in a glycoPEGylation reaction).
- Anion exchange media are known to those of skill in the art. Exemplary anion exchange media are described, e.g., in Protein Purification Methods, A Practical Approach , Ed. Harris E L V, Angal S, IRL Press Oxford, England (1989); Protein Purification , Ed. Janson J C, Ryden L, VCH-Verlag, Weinheim, Germany (1989); Process Scale Bioseparations for the Biopharmaceutical Industry , Ed. Shukla A A, Etzel M R, Gadam S, CRC Press Taylor & Francis Group (2007), pages 188-196 ; Protein Purification Handbook , GE Healthcare 2007 (18-1132-29) and Protein Purification, Principles, High Resolution Methods and Applications (2 nd Edition 1998), Ed.
- An exemplary anion exchanger of the invention is selected from quaternary ammonium filters and DEAE resins.
- the anion exchanger is a quaternary ammonium resin (e.g. Mustang Q ion exchange membrane, Pall Corporation).
- the anion exchanger is Sartobind Q.
- Other useful resins include QXL, Capto and BigBeads resins.
- the method of the invention includes at least one cation exchange step.
- a sample containing the peptide conjugate of interest is loaded onto a cation exchange resin in a loading buffer comprising a salt concentration below the concentration at which the peptide would elute from the column.
- the pH of the loading buffer is selected so that the peptide conjugate of interest is retained on the cation exchange resin.
- Changing the pH of the buffer alters the charge of the peptide and increasing the pH of the buffer shortens the retention times with cation exchangers.
- cation exchanges are performed at 1.5 to 2 pH units below the peptide's pI.
- the cation exchange conditions are selected to preferentially bind impurities, while the purified peptide is found in the flow-through.
- the column is washed with several column volumes of buffer to remove unbound substances and those substances that bind weakly to the resin. Fractions are then eluted from the column using a salt gradient according to conventional methods. Sample fractions are collected from the column. One or more fraction containing high levels of the desired peptide and low levels of impurities are collected, and optionally pooled.
- the cation exchangers used in the process of the current invention provide one of the primary purification steps of the purification process.
- the cation exchanger removes undesired proteins from the mixture, which contains the peptide conjugate of interest.
- the cation exchange step is useful to remove unwanted glycoforms of the purified polypeptide conjugate.
- Cation exchange media are known to those of skill in the art. Exemplary cation exchange media are described, e.g., in Protein Purification Methods, A Practical Approach , Ed. Harris E L V, Angal S, IRL Press Oxford, England (1989); Protein Purification , Ed. Janson J C, Ryden L, VCH-Verlag, Weinheim, Germany (1989); Process Scale Bioseparations for the Biopharmaceutical Industry , Ed. Shukla A A, Etzel M R, Gadam S, CRC Press Taylor & Francis Group (2007), pages 188-196 ; Protein Purification Handbook , GE Healthcare 2007 (18-1132-29) and Protein Purification, Principles, High Resolution Methods and Applications (2 nd Edition 1998), Ed.
- cation exchange resins of use in the invention are selected from sulfonic acid (S) and carboxymethyl (CM) supports.
- the cation exchanger is a sulfonic acid support (e.g. UNOsphereS, Bio-Rad Laboratories) or a sulphopropyl (SP) resin.
- the cation exchange resin is selected from SPFF, SPHP sepharose, BigBeads SP, Capto S and the like.
- the cation exchanger is Source 15S.
- the ion exchangers used in the methods of the invention are optionally membrane adsorbers rather than chromatographic resins or supports.
- the membrane adsorber is a cation exchanger.
- the membrane adsorber is a sulfonic acid (S) cation exchanger (e.g. Sartobind S, Sartorius AG).
- S sulfonic acid
- the membrane adsorber is optionally disposable.
- the peptide conjugate purification process of the invention includes mixed-mode or pseudo-affinity chromatography.
- the process involves chromatography performed on ceramic or crystalline apatite media, such as hydroxyapatite (HA) chromatography and fluoroapatite (FA) chromatography.
- HA and FA chromatography are effective purification mechanisms, providing biomolecule selectivity, complementary to ion exchange and/or hydrophobic interaction techniques. Hydroxyapatite and fluoroapatite chromatography are known in the art.
- the apatite medium is Adhere MMC.
- Exemplary hydroxyapatite sorbents of type I and type II are selected from ceramic and crystalline materials. Hydroxyapatite sorbents are available in different particle sizes (e.g. type 1, Bio-Rad Laboratories). In an exemplary embodiment, the particle size of the hydroxyapatite sorbent is between about 20 ⁇ m and about 180 ⁇ m, between about 20 ⁇ m and about 100 ⁇ m or between about 60 ⁇ m and about 100 ⁇ m. In a particular example, the particle size of the hydroxyapatite sorbent is about 80 ⁇ m.
- the hydroxyapatite sorbent is composed of cross-linked agarose beads with microcrystals of hydroxyapatite entrapped in the agarose mesh.
- the agarose is chemically stabilized (e.g. with epichlorohydrin under strongly alkaline conditions).
- the hydroxyapatite sorbent is HA Ultrogel (Pall Corporation).
- Exemplary type I and type II fluoroapatite sorbents are selected from ceramic (e.g., bead-like particles) and crystalline materials. Ceramic fluoroapatite sorbents are available in different particle sizes (e.g. type 1 and type 2, Bio-Rad Laboratories). In an exemplary embodiment the particle size of the ceramic fluoroapatite sorbent is from about 20 ⁇ m to about 180 ⁇ m, preferably about 20 to about 100 ⁇ m, more preferably about 20 ⁇ m to about 80 ⁇ m. In one example, the particle size of the ceramic fluoroapatite medium is about 40 ⁇ m (e.g., type 1 ceramic fluoroapatite).
- the fluoroapatite medium includes hydroxyapatite in addition to fluoroapatite.
- the fluoroapatite medium is Bio-Rad's CFTTM Ceramic Fluoroapatite.
- the loading flow velocity is selected from about 30 to about 900 cm/h, from about 150 to about 900 cm/h, preferably from about 500 to about 900 cm/h and, more preferably, from about 600 to about 900 cm/h.
- the pH of the elution buffer is selected from about pH 7 to about pH 9, and preferably from about pH 7.5 to about pH 8.0.
- the present invention provides a method of purifying a recombinant peptide by hydroxyapatite or fluoroapatite chromatography.
- the method includes the following steps: (a) desalting a mixture containing the peptide, forming a desalted mixture (e.g.
- the mixture containing the peptide of interest is desalted prior to subjecting the mixture to HA or fluoroapatite chromatography.
- the desalting step increases the capacity of the apatite column to bind the peptide of interest.
- the apatite column capacity increases with decreasing salt conductivity of the load, which contains the peptide.
- the mass loading of peptide per liter of HA resin is from about 1 to about 25 g/L, from about 1 to about 20 g/L, preferably from about 1 to about 15 g/L and more preferably from about 1 to about 10 g/L.
- the conductivity of the load can be decreased using a method selected from desalting and diluting.
- the conductivity of the loading buffer is lowered by desalting and preferred conductivities are from about 0.1 to about 4.0 mS/cm, preferably from about 0.1 to about 1.0 mS/cm, more preferably from about 0.1 to about 0.6 mS/cm and, still more preferably, from about 0.1 to about 0.4 mS/cm.
- desalting of peptide conjugate solutions is achieved using membrane filters wherein the membrane filter has a MWCO smaller than the peptide/protein of interest.
- the peptide/protein is found in the retentate and is reconstituted in a buffer of choice.
- the MWCO of the membrane used for desalting must be relatively small in order to avoid leaking of the peptide through the membrane pores.
- filtering a large volume of liquid through a small MWCO membrane typically requires large membrane areas and the filtering process is time consuming.
- desalting of the HA or fluoroapatite chromatography load is accomplished using size-exclusion chromatography (e.g. gel filtration).
- size-exclusion chromatography e.g. gel filtration
- the technique separates molecules on the basis of size.
- high molecular weight components can travel through the column more easily than smaller molecules, since their size prevents them from entering bead pores. Accordingly, low-molecular weight components take longer to pass through the column.
- low molecular weight materials, such as unwanted salts can be separated from the peptide of interest.
- the column material is selected from dextran, agarose, and polyacrylamide gels, in which the gels are characterized by different particle sizes.
- the material is selected from rigid, aqueous-compatible size exclusion materials.
- An exemplary gel filtration resin of the invention is Sepharose G-25 resin (GE Healthcare).
- desalting is performed subsequent to cation exchange chromatography (e.g. after Source 15S chromatography).
- an amino acid is added to the elution buffer, which is used to elute the peptide of interest from the HA or fluoroapatite resin.
- the amino acid is added to the elution buffer at a final concentration of about 5 mM to about 50 mM, about 10 mM to about 40 mM, preferably about 15 mM to about 30 mM and, more preferably, about 20 mM.
- the addition of an amino acid (e.g. glycine) to the elution buffer increases the step recovery of peptide from HA chromatography when compared to the recovery obtained without the addition of an amino acid.
- the recovery of peptide is increased by addition of the amino acid at least about 1% to about 20%, by at least about 1% to about 15%, by at least about 1% to about 10%, preferably by at least about 1% to about 7% and, more preferably, by about 5%.
- the addition of an amino acid causes the elution peak of the purified peptide to be sharper. Thus, less peptide is recovered in the tail fractions of the peak and more peptide is recovered in the main peak.
- the addition of an amino acid does not decrease the purity of the product from HA chromatography.
- the amino acid is glycine.
- glycine is added to the elution buffer at a final concentration of 20 mM.
- Hydrophobic interaction chromatography is a liquid chromatography technique that separates biomolecules based on differences in their surface hydrophobicity.
- hydrophobic amino acid side chains exposed on the surface of a polypeptide can interact with hydrophobic moieties on the HIC matrix.
- the amount, of exposed hydrophobic amino acids differs between polypeptides and so does the ability of polypeptides to interact with HIC gels.
- Hydrophobic interaction between a biomolecule and the HIC matrix is typically enhanced by high ionic strength buffers, and of biomolecules is most often performed at high salt concentrations. The elution of the peptide of interest from the column is then initiated by decreasing salt gradients.
- the HIC resin is selected for optimal resolution of different polypeptide glycoforms.
- Exemplary HIC resins useful in the methods of the invention are described, e.g., in Protein Purification Methods, A Practical Approach , Ed. Harris ELV, Angal S, IRL Press Oxford, England (1989) page 224 , Protein Purification , Ed. Janson J C, Ryden L, VCH-Verlag, Weinheim, Germany (1989) pages 207-226 , Process Scale Bioseparations for the Biopharmaceutical Industry , Ed.
- HIC media are distinguished by the hydrophobic moiety that they carry, by the particle size (e.g. bead size), the pore size and the density of the hydrophobic moieties on the HIC matrix (e.g. low substitution or high substitution).
- the hydrophobic moieties of the column matrix are members selected from alkyl groups, aromatic groups and ethers.
- Exemplary hydrophobic alkyl groups include lower alkyl groups, such as n-propyl, isopropyl, n-butyl, iso-butyl, and n-octyl.
- Exemplary aromatic groups include substituted and unsubstituted phenyl.
- the matrix of the HIC medium is a member selected from agarose, sepharose (GE Healthcare), polystyrene, divinylbenzene, and combinations thereof.
- Exemplary HIC resins include Butyl Fast Flow and Phenyl Fast Flow (e.g., GE Healthcare) in either low or high substituted versions.
- the HIC resin is a phenyl resin.
- the HIC resin is Phenyl650S or Phenyl650M (e.g., Tosohaas, Toyopearl).
- the HIC medium is selected from the following commercial resins:
- the amount of polypeptide conjugate loaded onto the HIC medium is between about 0.05 and about 1.0 mg conjugate/mL resin. In one example, the loaded amount of polypeptide conjugate is selected between about 0.05 and 0.3 mg conjugate/mL resin. In another example, the HIC medium is loaded with between about 0.1 and about 0.2 mg conjugate/mL resin (e.g., 0.15-0.18 mg/mL). In another embodiment, the amount of polypeptide conjugate loaded onto the HIC column is optimized for recovery of peptide conjugate and resolution of glycoforms.
- the HIC loading conditions are selected to create an HIC eluate that includes less than about 8%, preferably less than about 7%, more preferably less than about 6%, even more preferably less than about 5% and most preferably less than about 4% of EPO-PEG 2 .
- the loading buffer (the buffer in which the purified polypeptide conjugate is applied to the HIC column) is selected to bind the purified polypeptide conjugate to the HIC medium. Unbound impurities are then washed off the column using a HIC wash buffer. Consequently, polypeptide conjugates are eluted using an HIC elution buffer.
- the HIC loading buffer, the HIC wash buffer and the HIC elution buffer each contain one or more salts, such as sodium acetate (NaOAc), sodium chloride (NaCl), sodium sulfate (Na 2 SO 4 ) and sodium phosphate.
- salts such as sodium acetate (NaOAc), sodium chloride (NaCl), sodium sulfate (Na 2 SO 4 ) and sodium phosphate.
- concentration ranges for these and other salts are generally optimized for each type of HIC resin to affect optimal binding of the polypeptide conjugate being purified.
- the HIC loading buffer includes sodium sulfate (Na 2 SO 4 ) or ammonium sulfate, (NH 4 ) 2 SO 4 .
- the concentration of sodium- or ammonium sulfate in the loading buffer is about 100 mM to about 1200 mM.
- the concentration of sodium sulfate in the HIC loading buffer is about 300 mM to about 1100 mM, about 300 mM to about 1000 mM, about 300 mM to about 900 mM, about 300 mM to about 800 mM, about 300 mM to about 700 mM, about 300 mM to about 600 mM or about 300 mM to about 500 mM.
- the concentration of sodium sulfate in the HIC loading buffer is about 400 mM to about 800 mM. In a further exemplary embodiment, the concentration of sodium sulfate in the HIC loading buffer is about 500 mM to about 700 mM, and preferably about 600 mM.
- the HIC loading buffer, HIC wash buffer and HIC elution buffer include sodium phosphate.
- the concentration of sodium phosphate in any of these buffers is selected between about 5 mM and about 70 mM.
- the concentration of sodium phosphate in the HIC wash buffer is selected between about 10 mM and about 50 mM, between about 10 mM and about 30 mM or between about 20 mM and about 30 mM.
- the sodium phosphate concentration in the HIC wash buffer and elution buffer is about 25 mM.
- the HIC wash buffer has a pH of about 4.0 to about 8.0.
- the pH of the HIC wash buffer is selected from about 5.0 to about 8.0.
- the pH is selected from about 6 to about 8.
- the pH is selected from about 6.5 to about 8.0.
- the pH of the HIC wash buffer is selected from about 7.0 to about 8.0, from about 7.0 to about 7.9, from about 7.0 to about 7.8, from about 7.0 to about 7.7, from about 7.0 to about 7.6 or from about 7.0 to about 7.5.
- the pH of the HIC wash buffer is about 7.5.
- the purified polypeptide conjugate is eluted from the HIC resin using a gradient of decreasing sodium sulfate concentration.
- the elution buffer does not contain any sodium sulfate.
- HIC is employed as a method to separate polypeptide glycoforms, each covalently linked to at least one poly(alkylene oxide) moiety.
- the elution gradient profile is selected to affect optimal resolution of different polypeptide glycoforms contained in the purified mixture.
- the HIC elution buffer includes 25 mM sodium phosphate and a combination of gradient and hold periods spanning a range of about 600 mM sodium sulfate to no sodium sulfate in the phosphate buffer is employed to elute polypeptide conjugates from the HIC medium.
- HIC is performed subsequent to anion exchange chromatography.
- the flow-through from the anion exchanger, which contains the partially purified polypeptide conjugate is conditioned for hydrophobic interaction chromatography.
- the anion exchange flow-through may be diluted with a buffer suitable as a loading buffer for HIC.
- the anion exchange flow-through can be diluted with a buffer containing sodium sulfate to adjust the sodium sulfate concentration in the HIC load (e.g., a sodium sulfate concentration suitable to bind the polypeptide conjugate to the HIC medium, e.g., about 600 mM).
- the anion exchange flow-through is concentrated before dilution.
- the anion exchange flow-through is subjected to diafiltration/ultrafiltration for concentration and/or buffer exchange.
- the polypeptide conjugate of interest is purified from a mixture (e.g., a reaction mixture, such as a glycoPEGylation reaction) using the exemplary purification process outlined in FIG. 1 .
- a mixture e.g., a reaction mixture, such as a glycoPEGylation reaction
- the product of the glycoPEGylation reaction is subjected to anion exchange chromatography/filtration (e.g., using a Sartobind Q resin).
- impurities are bound by the anion exchange medium, while the purified polypeptide conjugate is found in the flow-through.
- this anion exchange step is useful to remove catalytic enzymes used in a glycan remodeling and/or glycomodification (e.g., glycoPEGylation) reaction performed prior to the anion exchange procedure.
- the anion exchange step is useful to isolate the polypeptide conjugate from at least one glycosyltransferase contained in the glycoPEGylation reaction mixture.
- the flow-through of the anion exchange step containing the partially purified polypeptide conjugate is conditioned and then loaded onto a hydrophobic interaction chromatography resin.
- the HIC medium is Phenyl 650S.
- the anion exchange flow-through is conditioned to generate a HIC loading sample that includes a sufficient salt concentration to affect binding of the polypeptide conjugate to the HIC medium.
- the anion exchange flow-trough is diluted with a buffer containing sodium sulfate.
- the dilution buffer contains sufficient sodium sulfate to generate a HIC loading sample having a sodium sulfate concentration between about 500 mM and about 700 mM.
- the anion exchange flow-through is diluted so that the HIC loading sample includes about 600 mM of sodium sulfate.
- the HIC resin is washed with a wash buffer to elute unbound impurities.
- the HIC wash buffer is a phosphate buffer.
- the HIC wash buffer contains about 25 mM sodium phosphate at a pH of about 7.5.
- the polypeptide conjugate is eluted from the HIC medium using an elution buffer.
- the polypeptide conjugate is eluted from the HIC medium using a phosphate buffer (e.g., 25 mM sodium phosphate at pH 7.5) and a gradient of decreasing sodium sulfate in the phosphate buffer.
- the conjugate is eluted using a gradient from about 600 mM to about 0 mM sodium sulfate.
- Eluate fractions are collected and optionally analyzed for product content.
- Product containing fractions are pooled and the resulting HIC pool is optionally conditioned for loading onto a cation exchange medium.
- the HIC pool is concentrated and the buffer is exchanged using diafiltration.
- the diafiltration membrane has a MWCO of 10 kDa.
- the volume of the HIC pool is reduced to between about 1/30 and about 1/10 of the original volume. In a particular example, the HIC pool volume is reduced to about 1/20 of the original volume.
- the buffer may then be exchanged, for example, by diluting the sample with the new buffer and subsequently re-concentrating the sample. The dilution and re-concentration steps may be repeated (e.g., 2-6 times) until the new buffer has the desired composition (e.g., the desired salt conductivity).
- the partially purified polypeptide conjugate may be transferred into the desired buffer using a two step buffer exchange.
- the buffer In the first buffer exchange step, the buffer may be changed to a phosphate buffer that does not include sodium sulfate.
- the pH of the resulting conjugate solution may optionally be adjusted (e.g., using sodium acetate.
- the buffer In a second buffer exchange step, the buffer may be changed to a buffer system suitable for loading onto a cation exchanger.
- the second buffer may include about 10 mM sodium acetate at a pH of about 5.4.
- the loading buffer for the cation exchange step has a salt conductivity between about 1.0 and about 3.0 mS/cm (e.g., about 1.5 mS/cm).
- the diafiltered HIC pool is subjected to cation exchange.
- the cation exchanger is Source 15S.
- the cation exchange medium is useful to further reduce the content of unwanted glycoforms of the purified polypeptide conjugate.
- the partially purified polypeptide conjugate is applied to the cation exchange medium and unbound impurities are eluted using a cation exchange wash buffer (e.g., 10 mM sodium acetate, pH 5.4).
- the bound polypeptide conjugate is then eluted using a cation exchange elution buffer.
- the conjugate is eluted using increasing NaCl concentrations in the above wash buffer.
- the conjugate is eluted using a gradient of 0-0.5 M NaCl.
- the gradient elution profile which may include a combination of gradient and hold periods, is selected for optimized glycoform resolution. Eluate fractions are collected and optionally analyzed (e.g., for product content and purity). Selected product containing fractions are pooled to form a cation exchange pool.
- the cation exchange pool is concentrated and diafiltered into a storage buffer. In one example, this diafiltration step also uses a 10 kDa MWCO membrane. In one embodiment, the volume of the cation exchange pool is reduced to about 1/100 to about 1/25 of its original volume (e.g., about 1/50 of the original volume).
- the concentrated cation exchange pool is then subjected to buffer exchange, for example, by diluting the sample with the new buffer and subsequently re-concentrating the sample. The dilution and re-concentration step may be repeated (e.g., 2-6 times) until the new buffer has the desired composition.
- the final retentate is reconstituted into a storage buffer.
- Exemplary storage buffers include those having a sodium chloride concentration that is in the physiological range.
- the storage buffer may be a sodium acetate buffer including about 150 mM NaCl.
- the concentrated product pool is reconstituted in the storage buffer to reach a desired peptide concentration.
- the final conjugate concentration is selected between about 0.5 and about 2 mg/mL.
- the final solution is optionally sterile filtered, for example through a cellulose acetate membrane.
- the purification process outlined in FIG. 1 may optionally include an additional chromatography step.
- the process includes a hydroxyapatite (HA) or fluoroapatite chromatography step.
- the apatite chromatography is performed after anion exchange chromatography.
- the apatite chromatography is performed after HIC.
- the apatite chromatography is performed after cation exchange chromatography.
- the partially purified polypeptide conjugate solution may be desalted, for example, using a size exclusion column (e.g. G25) to lower the salt conductivity of the conjugate solution in preparation for apatite chromatography.
- a size exclusion column e.g. G25
- the polypeptide conjugate purified by the above described process is an EPO-conjugate.
- the invention provides a composition made by a method of the invention.
- the invention provides a composition including a first polypeptide conjugate, said first polypeptide conjugate having a first number of poly(alkylene oxide) moieties, each of the poly(alkylene oxide) moieties covalently linked to the first polypeptide via an intact glycosyl linking group.
- the composition is made by a method including: (a) contacting a mixture comprising the first polypeptide conjugate with a hydrophobic interaction chromatography (HIC) medium; and (b) eluting the first polypeptide conjugate from the hydrophobic interaction chromatography medium.
- HIC hydrophobic interaction chromatography
- the invention provides an isolated first polypeptide conjugate made by a method comprising: separating the first polypeptide conjugate including a first number of poly(alkylene oxide) moieties covalently linked to a first polypeptide, from a second polypeptide conjugate comprising a second number of poly(alkylene oxide) moieties covalently linked to a second polypeptide.
- the first number is selected from 1 to 20 and the second number is selected from 0-20. In another embodiment, the first number and the second number are different.
- the two polypeptide conjugates are separated by: (a) contacting a mixture comprising the first polypeptide conjugate and the second polypeptide conjugate with a hydrophobic interaction chromatography (HIC) medium; and (b) eluting the first polypeptide conjugate from the hydrophobic interaction chromatography medium.
- HIC hydrophobic interaction chromatography
- the first polypeptide is a member selected from erythropoietin (EPO), bone morphogenetic protein 2 (BMP-2), bone morphogenetic protein 7 (BMP-7), bone morphogenetic protein 15 (BMP-15), neurotrophin-3 (NT-3), von Willebrand factor (vWF) protease, granulocyte colony stimulating factor (G-CSF), granulocyte-macrophage colony stimulating factor (GM-CSF), interferon alpha, interferon beta, interferon gamma, ⁇ 1 -antitrypsin ( ⁇ -1 protease inhibitor), glucocerebrosidase, tissue-type plasminogen activator (TPA), interleukin-2 (IL-2), leptin, hirudin, urokinase, human DNase, insulin, hepatitis B surface protein (HbsAg), chimeric diphtheria toxin-IL-2, human
- EPO erythropoiet
- the invention provides a composition including a first erythropoietin (EPO) conjugate, the first EPO conjugate having a first number of poly(alkylene oxide) moieties covalently linked to an EPO polypeptide via a glycosyl linking group (e.g., an intact glycosyl linking group).
- EPO erythropoietin
- the composition is made by a method including: (a) contacting a mixture including the first EPO conjugate with an anion exchange medium; (b) eluting the first EPO conjugate from the anion exchange medium, forming a first eluate comprising the first EPO conjugate; (c) contacting the first eluate with a hydrophobic interaction chromatography (HIC) medium; and (d) eluting the first EPO conjugate from the hydrophobic interaction chromatography medium.
- HIC hydrophobic interaction chromatography
- the invention provides a pharmaceutical formulation including a composition made by a method of the invention and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier.
- the pharmaceutical formulation includes an isolated polypeptide conjugate made by a method of the invention and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier.
- the isolated polypeptide conjugate is an EPO-conjugate.
- the invention provides methods of treatment utilizing a composition (e.g., an isolated polypeptide conjugate) made by a method of the invention.
- a composition e.g., an isolated polypeptide conjugate
- the invention provides a method of treating a condition in a subject in need thereof, the condition characterized by compromised red blood cell production in the subject, the method comprising: administering to the subject an amount of a composition of the invention, effective to ameliorate the condition in the subject.
- the subject is a mammal, such as a human.
- the composition includes an EPO conjugate made by a method of the invention.
- the invention provides a method of treating a tissue injury in a subject in need thereof.
- the injury is caused by a member selected from ischemia, trauma, inflammation and contact with a toxic substance.
- the method includes: administering to a subject an amount of a composition made by a method of the invention (e.g., an isolated polypeptide conjugate) that is effective in ameliorating the damage associated with the tissue injury.
- a composition made by a method of the invention e.g., an isolated polypeptide conjugate
- the subject is a mammal, such as a human.
- the composition includes an EPO conjugate made by a method of the invention.
- the invention provides a method of enhancing red blood cell production in a mammal, said method comprising administering to said mammal a composition made by a method of the invention.
- the subject is a mammal, such as a human.
- the composition includes an EPO conjugate made by a method of the invention.
- the protein concentration was determined using either a UV method (280 nm) or was determined using BCA Protein Assay kit according to manufacture's instructions (Pierce).
- the ratio of each EPO-PEG form [EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa) 1-4 ] was determined using C 3 RP HPLC chromatography (Zorbax 300SB-C3, 150 ⁇ 2.1 mm, 5 micron, 45° C.).
- the HPLC was performed using the following solutions: A, 0.1% TFA in water, and B, 0.09% TFA in ACN.
- the mobile phase was performed as a gradient from 42-55% B over 14 min, 55-95% B over 2 min, a 2 min wash at 95% B and then 95-42% B over 2 min.
- the total time conduct the chromatography was 30 min using a flow rate of 0.6 mL/min. Mixture 1 was used as a reference standard to test system suitability.
- the injection volume was varied to give a standard injection concentration of 5 to 10 ⁇ g of EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa) 3 based on protein. Protein absorbance was detected at 214 nm and the peak areas of the EPO species were used to determine the protein purity. All peaks were integrated using 32 karat software. The EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa) 4 peak could typically not be integrated accurately due to its small area.
- the EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa) 3 isoform purity and aggregation were determined by SEC HPLC chromatography (TSK-gel G5000PW ⁇ L, 7.8 ⁇ 300 mm, 10 micron, 4° C.).
- the isocratic mobile phase 100 mM sodium phosphate, 150 mM sodium chloride, pH 7.0 was used to perform the method at a flow rate of 0.5 mL/min.
- This example describes the development of an isolation process for the isolation of EPO conjugates from a glycoPEGylation reaction mixture.
- the resulting process is characterized by high overall EPO conjugate recovery and produces the desired EPO conjugate [EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa) 3 ] in high purity.
- the composition produced by the process is essentially free of other EPO-PEG glycoforms, such as mono-, di- and tetra-PEGylated EPO conjugates.
- the desired EPO-PEG conjugate is a glycoPEGylated erythropoietin protein that contains three 10 kDa mPEG groups attached to each of the three monoantennary N-linked glycans.
- the EPO polypeptide is produced by expression of the protein from Sf9 cells using a Baculovirus infection protocol.
- the insect cell expression system produces EPO with three N-linked glycans, at Asn 24 , Asn 38 and Asn 83 , each containing a trimannosyl core as the predominant species.
- a variety of other glycan structures are present in small amounts that vary with fermentation conditions.
- the other structures include trimannosyl core with an additional GlcNAc, higher mannose forms (Man 4 , Man 5 ), missing glycans, and GlcNAc-(Fuc) stub arising as a result of an endoglycosidase-type (Endo-H) activity.
- GlcNAc-(Fuc) stub arising as a result of an endoglycosidase-type (Endo-H) activity.
- a small percentage of the EPO molecules contain O-linked glycans at Ser 126 .
- a very low level ( ⁇ 1%) of phosphorylcholine-linked glycans (PC-glycan) has also been identified in the insect cell-derived EPO.
- EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa) 3 which contains three PEGylated mono-antennary N-linked glycans.
- EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa) 1-2 are also present in lesser amounts, arising from the EPO forms missing one or more glycans or containing one or more GlcNAc-stub glycans.
- EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa) 4 (and higher) are produced at very low levels.
- EPO glycoforms which contain the tri-mannosyl core with an additional GlcNAc on the Man ⁇ 1,6 branch. Both branches of these glycans can be built out and PEGylated under the reaction conditions, resulting in biantennary PEGylated glycans on a tetra-PEG (or higher) EPO species. Exemplary EPO glycoforms are depicted in FIG. 3 .
- GlycoPEGylated EPO isolated using reversed-phase chromatography and cation exchange chromatography provided a composition containing greater than or equal to about 85% EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa) 3 , about 3-14% EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa) 2 , about 1-8% EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa) 4-6 and less than or equal to about 1% EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa) i .
- the above composition is referred to as Mixture 1.
- HIC was capable of separating different PEG states (glycoforms) contained in a mixture, which results from a glycoPEGylation process (e.g., fractionation of isoforms EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa) 1-4 ).
- the HIC purification method was optimized by evaluating a variety of HIC resins and process parameters.
- a process based on Phenyl 650S resin e.g., Tosohaas, Toyopearl was selected for incorporation into the new isolation process.
- an anion exchange step which is useful to remove enzyme components of the glycoPEGylation reaction. Enzymes are bound by the anion exchange medium, while the EPO-PEG conjugates EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa) 1-6 are found in the flow through.
- Tricorn 5 column packed with 1 mL (0.5 cm ⁇ 5 cm) of the appropriate resin (Table 1) or a prepacked HiTrap column (1 mL, 0.7 cm ⁇ 2.5 cm) was attached to an AKTA FPLC system (GE Healthcare). Product elution was monitored by absorbance at 280 nm. Each column was equilibrated with 5 column volumes (CV) of Buffer B (as indicated in Table 1). Mixture 1 (100 mcg, 250 mcL) was diluted to 1.25 mL with 1 mL of Buffer B and injected using a 2 mL sample loop. The unbound material was washed with 5 CV of Buffer B.
- the EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa) 3 was eluted with the following gradient elution using Buffer A (as indicated in Table 1): 100-0% Buffer B over 20 CV followed by 0% Buffer B for 5 CV. All steps were performed at 0.64 mL/min (196 cm/hr). The resulting chromatograms were compared and selected fractions were analysed by SDS-PAGE. Resins were selected for their capability to retain the EPO-PEG conjugates, their capability to resolve different glycoforms and peak shapes.
- Phenyl-FF Low sub was compared to Phenyl 650M and Butyl 650M using either 25 mM Na phosphate, 1 M ammonium Sulfate, pH 7.0 or 25 mM Na phosphate, 4 M ammonium Sulfate, pH 7.0 as binding buffer (loading buffer). Butyl 650M was only tested with ammonium sulfate and resulted in a very wide and tailing elution peak. Both Phenyl 650M and Phenyl-FF low sub had a more symmetric peak shape when using sodium sulfate. The use of sodium chloride resulted in extremely broad elution peaks.
- a third round of HIC testing compares the Phenyl 650M purification of Mixture 1 with different buffers.
- Buffer B 1 M Na Sulfate+0.5 M NaCl+20 mM NaOAc, pH 5.0 was tested as this condition had worked for purification of the EPO intermediate prior to PEGylation. This condition resulted in a broad elution peak with multiply bumps, as did the same buffer without 0.5M NaCl (1 M Na Sulfate+20 mM NaOAc, pH 5.0).
- Phenyl 650M was tested using Mixture 1 bound to the column using 4 M NaCl+buffer A, pH 7.0 and the elution was performed with 25 mM Na phosphate, 20% ethylene glycol, pH 7.0.
- a Tricorn 5 column packed with a 1 mL (0.5 cm ⁇ 5 cm) Phenyl 650M resin was attached to an AKTA FPLC system continuously monitoring absorbance at A280.
- the column was equilibrated with 5 column volumes (CV) of Buffer B (1 M sodium sulfate, 25 mM sodium phosphate, pH 7.0). Product elution was monitored by absorbance at 280 nm.
- the glycoPEGylation enzymes were individually injected on Phenyl 650M to compare the elutio profiles to Mixture 1 using the following condition: Buffer A: 25 mM Na phosphate, pH 7.0. Buffer B: 1 M Na Sulfate+buffer A, pH 7.0. Elution gradient: 100 ⁇ 0% B over 20 cv. The MBP-SBD-ST3Gal3, MBP-GnT1 and MBP-GalT1 all eluted in the same portion of the gradient. Mixture 1 elutes just prior to the enzymes. Although Mixture 1 and glycoPEGylation enzymes do not completely co-elute, Mixture 1 and the leading portion of the enzyme elution peaks seemed to overlap.
- the concentration of sodium sulfate required to bind Mixture 1 bind Phenyl 650M was investigated.
- a Tricorn 5 column was packed with Phenyl 650M resin (1 mL, 0.5 cm 5 cm) as described above and attached to a Varian HPLC system. Each column was equilibrated with 5 column volumes (CV) of one of the buffers listed below. Product elution was monitored by absorbance at 280 nm.
- EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa) 3 was eluted using a gradient of Buffer A (25 mM sodium phosphate, pH 7.0): 100-0% Buffer B over 20 CV (gradient change 5% Buffer B/CV), and then 0% Buffer B for 5 CV. Chromatography operations were performed at a flow rate of 0.64 mL/min (196 cm/hr). EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa) 3 peak fractions were stored at 4° C. until analysis by SDS-PAGE.
- Tricorn 5 column was packed with Phenyl 650S resin (1 mL, 0.5 cm ⁇ 5 cm) as described above and attached to an AKTA FPLC system. Product elution was monitored by absorbance at 280 nm. Three separate purifications were performed each using a different elution gradient. The columns from each experiment were equilibrated with 5 column volumes (CV) of Buffer B (25 mM sodium phosphate, 0.6 M sodium sulfate, pH 7.5).
- Buffer B 25 mM sodium phosphate, 0.6 M sodium sulfate, pH 7.5.
- Gradient 3 100-60% Buffer B over 2 CV, hold for 1 CV, 60-20% Buffer B over 20 CV (gradient change 2% Buffer B/CV), 20-0% Buffer B over 2 CV and then 0% Buffer B for 5 CV. Chromatography operations were performed at a flow rate of 0.64 mL/min. Chromatography elution profiles were compared and selected fractions were analyzed by SDS PAGE. Out of the three gradient profiles tested, Gradient 3 provided the best separation of the EPO-PEG species.
- the EPO-PEG x mixture (0.8 mg EPO protein conjugate; 1 mL) solution was adjusted to a sodium sulfate concentration of 0.6 M by addition of 0.4 mL of Buffer A (25 mM sodium phosphate, selected pH) and 0.6 mL of buffer (2 M sodium sulfate, 25 mM sodium phosphate, selected pH). This solution was then diluted with an equal volume of Buffer B and the entire sample (4 mL) was injected onto the column. The column was washed with 5 CV of Buffer B and the product eluted using a gradient using Buffer A.
- Buffer A 25 mM sodium phosphate, selected pH
- buffer 2 M sodium sulfate, 25 mM sodium phosphate, selected pH
- the step yield was calculated as the ratio of EPO-PEG protein recovered after HIC chromatography (combined fractions) versus the EPO-PEG injected onto the column 4
- Standard purification conditions (Buffer A: 25 mM sodium phosphate, pH 7.5.
- Buffer B 25 mM sodium phosphate, 0.6M sodium sulfate, pH 7.5 (with 0.05 mg EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa) 1-4 /mL resin loaded) were compared to purification runs with buffer A and B prepared at pH 6.5, 7.0 and 8.0.
- the elution peaks (A280) are shifted slightly to the left and right of the standard elution condition.
- the X-axis of these A280 traces were shifted to overlay the peaks.
- Comparison of the X-axis shifted peaks shows similar peak traces with respect to the elution of EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa) 2 , EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa) 3 , and EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa) 4 . This is especially true for pH 7.0, 7.5 and 8.0. The pH 6.5 run had a slightly lower peak max and a little less resolution was noted between the EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa) 3 and EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa) 4 peaks.
- EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa) 4 Integration of EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa) 4 is difficult at low levels but is detected by silver stain SDS-PAGE. No aggregation of EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa) 3 is detected by SEC analysis. SDS-PAGE analysis shows that the purity of each EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa) 3 pool is similar. However, the pH 6.5 purified material contained a higher amount of a approximate 50 kDa proteolyses band. A minor amount of this proteolysis product was also detected for the pH 7.0 purified material.
- the EPO-PEG x mixture (0.8 mg EPO protein; 1 mL) solution was adjusted to a sodium sulfate concentration of 0.6 M by addition of 0.4 mL of Buffer A (various concentrations of sodium phosphate, pH 7.5) and 0.6 mL of buffer (2 M sodium sulfate, various concentrations of sodium phosphate, pH 7.5). This solution was then diluted with an equal volume of Buffer B and the entire sample (4 mL) was injected onto the column. The column was washed with 5 CV of Buffer B and the product eluted using a gradient using Buffer A.
- the step yield was calculated as the ratio of EPO-PEG protein recovered after HIC chromatography (combined fractions) versus the amount EPO-PEG injected onto the column 4
- Standard purification conditions (Buffer A: 25 mM sodium phosphate, pH 7.5.
- Buffer B 25 mM sodium phosphate, 0.6M sodium sulfate, pH 7.5 (0.05 mg EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa) 1-4 /mL resin loaded) were compared to purification runs with buffer A and B prepared with 15 and 50 mM sodium phosphate. Resulting A280 elution profiles were compared. The 15 mM Na phosphate eluted material elutes earliest, followed by the 25 mM Na phosphate and finally 50 mM Na phosphate. The shift in elution profile is due to the relative changes in buffer conductivity (see table 3).
- Table 3 compares EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa) 3 recovery, MBP-ELISA, RP-HPLC, and SEC analysis data. No significant difference was observed between the EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa) 3 purified within this 15 to 50 mM sodium phosphate concentration range. Recovery is between 60.2 and 61.9%.
- MBP-ELISA indicates ⁇ 0.083-0.085 mcg MBP/mg EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa) 3 remaining RP-HPLC analysis showed that the amount of EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa) 2 remaining in the EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa) 3 peak is between 3.7 and 4.5%.
- the EPO-PEG x mixture (0.8 mg EPO protein; 1 mL) solution was adjusted to a sodium sulfate concentration by the addition of 0.3-0.5 mL of Buffer A (25 mM sodium phosphate, pH 7.5) and 0.5-0.7 mL of buffer (2 M sodium sulfate, 25 mM sodium phosphate, pH 7.5) depending on the sodium sulfate concentration used in the experiment.
- Buffer A 25 mM sodium phosphate, pH 7.5
- buffer 2 M sodium sulfate, 25 mM sodium phosphate, pH 7.5
- the step yield was calculated as the ratio of EPO-PEG protein recovered after HIC chromatography (combined fractions) versus the amount of EPO-PEG injected onto the column. 4 The percent of EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa) 3 in the main product peak. 5 The percent of EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa) 2 in the main product peak. 6 The amount of MBP protein in the main product peak as determine by the ELISA versus the amount of EPO-PEG protein. 7 The amount of aggregate EPO-PEG in the product peak observed by SEC.
- Standard purification conditions (Buffer A: 25 mM sodium phosphate, pH 7.5. Buffer B: 25 mM sodium phosphate, 0.6M sodium sulfate, pH 7.5. With 0.05 mg EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa) 1-4 /mL resin loaded) were compared to purification runs with buffer B prepared with 0.5 and 0.7 M sodium sodium sulfate. Elution profiles (A280) were compared. The run with buffer B containing 0.5 M Na sulfate elutes earliest, followed by the 0.6 M Na sulfate and finally 0.7 M Na sulfate run. The X-axis of these A280 traces were shifted to overlay the peaks.
- Table 4 compares EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa) 3 recovery, MBP-ELISA, RP-HPLC, and SEC analysis data. No significant difference was noted between the EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa) 3 purified within the 0.5 to 0.7 M sodium sulfate concentration range. Recovery is between 61.5 and 64.2%.
- ELISA indicates ⁇ 0.04-0.083 mcg MBP/mg EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa) 3 remaining RP-HPLC analysis showed that the amount of EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa) 2 remaining in the EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa) 3 peak is between 3.4 and 4.6%.
- the EPO-PEG x mixture was adjusted to a sodium sulfate concentration of 0.6 M and a final volume of 4 mL. This solution was injected onto the column. The column was washed with 5 CV of Buffer B and the product eluted using a gradient using Buffer A. A gradient of 100-60% Buffer B over 2 CV, hold for 1 CV, 60-35% Buffer B over 13 CV, hold for 1 CV and then 0% Buffer B for 5 CV. The chromatography flow rate was 2.0 mL/min (150 cm/hr) and the column elution monitored by the absorbance at 280 nm. The chromatography elution profiles were compared. Fractions were pooled and analyzed by SDS-PAGE. Analysis of the main product peak is summarized in Table 5, below:
- Comparison of the resulting elution profiles shows a decrease in resolution between the EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa) 2 and EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa) 3 peaks as the amount of protein loaded onto the column is increased.
- RP-HPLC analysis was used to compare the amount of EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa) 2 remaining in the EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa) 3 pooled peak.
- Table 5 compares EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa) 3 recovery, MBP-ELISA, RP-HPLC, and SEC analysis data. No significant difference was noted between the EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa) 3 purified within the investigated column loading range.
- EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa) 2 in the EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa) 3 peak since the peaks were pooled in the same manner. Integration of the EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa) 4 was difficult at low levels but the glycoform was detected by silver stain SDS-PAGE. No aggregation of EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa) 3 was detected by SEC analysis.
- Phenyl 650M and Phenyl 650S chromatography resins were examined.
- a Tricorn 10 column was packed with 15.7 mL (1.0 cm id ⁇ 20 cm) of either Phenyl 650S or Phenyl 650M.
- Each column was equilibrated with 5 column volumes (CV) of buffer B (25 mM sodium phosphate, 0.6 M sodium sulfate, pH 7.5).
- the EPO-PEG x (0.8 mg EPO protein; 1 mL) solution was adjusted to a sodium sulfate concentration of 0.6 M by the addition of 0.4 mL of Buffer A (25 mM sodium phosphate, pH 7.5) and 0.6 mL of buffer (2 M sodium sulfate, 25 mM sodium phosphate, pH 7.5). This solution was then diluted with an equal volume of Buffer B and the entire sample (4 mL) was injected onto the column. The column was washed with 5 CV of Buffer B and the product eluted using a gradient using Buffer A.
- the step yield was calculated as the ratio of EPO-PEG protein recovered after HIC chromatography (combined fractions) versus the amount of EPO-PEG injected onto the column. 4 The percent of EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa) 3 in the main product peak. 5 The percent of EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa) 2 in the main product peak. 6 The amount of MBP protein contained in the main product peak as determine by ELISA versus the amount of EPO-PEG protein. 7 The amount of aggregate EPO-PEG in the product peak observed by SEC.
- Phenyl 650S 35 micron bead size
- Phenyl 650M 65 micron bead size
- Buffer A 25 mM sodium phosphate, pH 7.5.
- Buffer B 25 mM sodium phosphate, 0.6M sodium sulfate, pH 7.5 (0.05 mg EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa) 1-4 /mL resin loaded).
- Comparison of the resulting elution profiles showed that Phenyl 650S has a better resolution between EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa) 2 and EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa) 3 .
- the total system and column pressure measurements show the average pressure throughout the Phenyl 650M purification was approximately 0.12 mPa, while the Phenyl 650S pressure was approximately 0.29 mPa.
- EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa) 3 purification using Phenyl Sepharose HP 34 micron beads size
- Buffer A 25 mM sodium phosphate, pH 7.5.
- Buffer B 25 mM sodium phosphate, 0.6M sodium sulfate, pH 7.5, with 0.05 mg EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa) 1-4 /mL resin loaded.
- the elution profile showed no actual resolution between EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa) i , EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa) 2 , EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa) 3 and EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa) 4 (chromatogram not shown). Since there was no resolution between the various PEG states no analysis was performed on the eluted material.
- the mixture e.g., flowthrough from an anion chromatography medium
- HIC hydrophobic interaction chromatography
- An exemplary HIC procedure is outlined below: An XK26 column was packed with Phenyl 650S resin (106 mL, 2.6 cm ⁇ 20 cm) and attached to an AKTA Explorer 100 system.
- the EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa) 3 was eluted from the column using the following gradient elution procedure using Buffer A (25 mM sodium phosphate, pH 7.5). Gradient: 100-60% Buffer B over 2 CV, hold for 1 CV, 60-35% Buffer B over 13 CV (gradient change 1.92% Buffer B/CV), hold 1 CV and then 0% Buffer B for 5 CV. The equilibration, load and wash steps were performed at a flow rate of 8 mL/min (90 cm/hr).
- Buffer A 25 mM sodium phosphate, pH 7.5
- Gradient 100-60% Buffer B over 2 CV, hold for 1 CV, 60-35% Buffer B over 13 CV (gradient change 1.92% Buffer B/CV), hold 1 CV and then 0% Buffer B for 5 CV.
- the equilibration, load and wash steps were performed at a flow rate of 8 mL/min (90 cm/hr).
- Phenyl 650S Chromatography was scaled up from a 0.8 mg EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa) 1-4 load (15.7 mL column) to a 22.4 mg load (106 mL column). The standard conditions were used except the amount of material loaded on the column was increased from 0.05 to 0.2 mg EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa) 1-4 /mL resin. The EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa) 3 peak was pooled as shown in FIG. 2B resulting in a 408 mL peak pool (3.85 CV).
- EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa) 3 Prior to concentration 16.1 mg EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa) 3 was recovered (72%) with 5.7% EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa) 2 remaining from the original 14.9% EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa) 2 in the load material. Concentration and diafiltration into 10 mM sodium acetate, 150 mM NaCl, pH 5.4 using a Pellicon-2 XL 50 cm 2 yielded a 95% recovery.
- the purification process began with a Sartobind Q membrane used in a negative binding mode which allowed the PEG-EPO conjugates to flow through while capturing glycoPEGylation enzymes, such as MBP-GnT1, MBP-GalT1, MBP-SBD-ST3Gal3 and other enzyme contaminants.
- glycoPEGylation enzymes such as MBP-GnT1, MBP-GalT1, MBP-SBD-ST3Gal3 and other enzyme contaminants.
- the various PEG species generated in the glycoPEGylation reaction were then fractionated using HIC on a Phenyl 650S resin (also compare Example 1), which enriched the EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa) 3 to a concentration of >96% (step yield approximately 75%).
- EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa) 3 product was subjected to available drug product release tests. The purity was found to be greater than 99% by HPLC (combined glycoforms).
- the concentration of EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa) 3 in the final composition was 96.9%.
- the concentration of EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa) 2 was 2.5% and the concentration of EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa) 4 was 0.6%.
- Other EPO-PEG glycoforms were not detected in the final composition. There was less than 1% aggregate by SEC.
- Human EPO intermediate protein (produced by Baculovirus fermentation and purified) was stored frozen in 20 mM HEPES, pH 7.5 at ⁇ 20° C. at a concentration of 1.29 mg/mL as determined by BCA assay.
- MBP-GnT1 was stored frozen in 50 mM Tris, pH 7.0, 138 mM NaCl at ⁇ 20° C. The reported activity assay value of 0.5 U/mL was used.
- RP-HPLC analysis determined the protein concentration to be 0.3 mg/mL.
- MBP-GalT1 was stored frozen in 20 mM HEPES, pH 7.5, 200 mM NaCl at ⁇ 20° C.
- the activity was reported to be 15 U/mL, with a protein concentration of 1.0 mg/mL as determined by RP-HPLC.
- MBP-SBD-ST3Gal3 was stored frozen in 20 mM HEPES, pH 7.0 at ⁇ 20° C. The reported activity was 2.05 U/mL and the protein concentration was measured to be 1.06 mg/mL by BCA assay.
- UDP-GlcNAc and UDP-Gal were prepared as 60 mg/mL stock solutions in 100 mM HEPES, pH 7.0, 20 mM NaCl, 0.02% NaN 3 immediately prior to use.
- CMP-SA-PEG-10 kDa was prepared as a 200 mg/mL stock solution in 100 mM HEPES, pH 7.0, 20 mM NaCl, 0.02% NaN 3 immediately prior to use.
- EPO intermediate protein (25 mg, 19.4 mL, 1.25 micromoles by BCA assay) was concentrated to a volume of 1.0 mL in a Centricon Plus-20 centrifugal filter (5 kDa MWCO) and then diluted with 15 mL of 100 mM HEPES, pH 7.0, 20 mM NaCl, 0.02% NaN 3 .
- the EPO solution was concentrated to 0.94 mL (26.7 mg/mL).
- MBP-SBD-ST3Gal3 (3.05 mL, 6.25 U) was diluted with 13 mL of 100 mM HEPES, pH 7.0, 20 mM NaCl, 0.02% NaN 3 in another Centricon Plus-20 centrifugal filter (5 kDa MWCO) and was concentrated to 0.51 mL (12.3 U/mL).
- UDP-GlcNAc 25 micromoles, 0.27 mL
- UDP-Gal 25 micromoles, 0.25 mL
- stock solutions both at 60 mg/mL in 100 mM HEPES, pH 7.0, 20 mM NaCl, 0.02% NaN 3
- MBP-GnT1 0.5 mL, 0.25 U
- MBP-GalT1 (0.33 mL, 5 U)
- the concentrated MBP-SBD-ST3Gal3 (0.51 mL of 12.3 U/mL, 6.25 U, from above
- CMP-SA-PEG-10 kDa 25 micromole, 1.25 mL of 200 mg/mL solution in 100 mM HEPES, pH 7.0, 20 mM NaCl, 0.02% NaN 3
- MnCl 2 5 mM, 0.104 mL of 200 mM solution in water
- the cartridge was flushed with 20 mM HEPES, 1 M NaCl, pH 7.0 (approximately 100 mL), followed by 20 mM HEPES, 20 mM NaCl, pH 7.0 (approximately 100 mL) both at a flow rate of 15 mL/min.
- the PEG-EPO reaction mixture (approximately 25 mg, 6 mg/mL, 4.2 mL) was diluted with 20 mM HEPES, 20 mM NaCl, pH 7.0 (22.8 mL) to a final volume of 27 mL.
- the PEG-EPO pool was analyzed by MBP-ELISA for residual enzyme contaminants (Table 8) and then divided into two portions: The majority fraction (62 mL, 15.25 mg) was purified by HIC chromatography on Phenyl 650S resin as described below. A small sample (18 mL, 4.4 mg) was purified by an alternate process including Fluoroapatite chromatography.
- Bound impurities were eluted from the column with 20 mM HEPES, 1 M NaCl, pH 7.0 (13 mL) at a flow rate of 15 mL/min.
- An XK26 column was packed with Phenyl 650S resin (106 mL, 2.6 cm ⁇ 20 cm) as described herein above and was attached to an AKTA Explorer 100 system continuously monitoring absorbance at 214, 254 and 280 nm.
- the column was equilibrated with 5 column volumes (CV) 25 mM sodium phosphate, 0.6M sodium sulfate, pH 7.5 (212 mL).
- the Sartobind Q PEG-EPO product pool (62 mL, 18 mg, 0.17 mg PEG-EPO/mL resin, pH 6.94, 2.59 mS/cm) was diluted 1:1 with 1.2 M sodium sulfate, 25 mM sodium phosphate pH 7.5 (62 mL) to adjust the sodium sulfate concentration to 0.6 M.
- the conditioned sample (124 mL) was applied to the column. Unbound material was washed from the column using 5 CV of 25 mM sodium phosphate, 0.6M sodium sulfate, pH 7.5 (212 mL) at a flow rate of 8 mL/min (90 cm/hr).
- the PEG-EPO species were fractionated and eluted with the following gradient using Buffer A (25 mM sodium phosphate, pH 7.5) and Buffer B (25 mM sodium phosphate, 0.6M sodium sulfate, pH 7.5) at 8 mL/min (90 cm/hr): 100-60% B over 2 CV, isocratic hold at 60% B for 1 CV, 60-35% B over 13 CV (gradient change 1.92% B/CV), isocratic hold at 35% B for 1 CV, 35-0% B over 1 CV and 0% B for 5 CV.
- the flow through and wash fraction were collected in the bottle from a 1 L Nalgene filter unit and 12 mL elution fractions were collected in 14 mL Falcon tubes.
- Tricorn 10 column was packed with Source 15S (15.7 mL, 1 cm ⁇ 20 cm) and attached to an AKTA Explorer 100 system continuously monitoring absorbance at 214, 254 and 280 nm.
- the column was equilibrated with 5 column volumes (CV) 10 mM Na acetate, pH 5.4 (Buffer A).
Landscapes
- Chemical & Material Sciences (AREA)
- Health & Medical Sciences (AREA)
- Organic Chemistry (AREA)
- Life Sciences & Earth Sciences (AREA)
- General Health & Medical Sciences (AREA)
- Medicinal Chemistry (AREA)
- Molecular Biology (AREA)
- Genetics & Genomics (AREA)
- Biochemistry (AREA)
- Biophysics (AREA)
- Proteomics, Peptides & Aminoacids (AREA)
- Engineering & Computer Science (AREA)
- Zoology (AREA)
- Bioinformatics & Cheminformatics (AREA)
- Gastroenterology & Hepatology (AREA)
- Wood Science & Technology (AREA)
- Analytical Chemistry (AREA)
- Chemical Kinetics & Catalysis (AREA)
- General Chemical & Material Sciences (AREA)
- Veterinary Medicine (AREA)
- Public Health (AREA)
- Animal Behavior & Ethology (AREA)
- Pharmacology & Pharmacy (AREA)
- Toxicology (AREA)
- Biotechnology (AREA)
- Microbiology (AREA)
- General Engineering & Computer Science (AREA)
- Epidemiology (AREA)
- Nuclear Medicine, Radiotherapy & Molecular Imaging (AREA)
- Hematology (AREA)
- Diabetes (AREA)
- Peptides Or Proteins (AREA)
- Preparation Of Compounds By Using Micro-Organisms (AREA)
- Medicinal Preparation (AREA)
- Medicines That Contain Protein Lipid Enzymes And Other Medicines (AREA)
Abstract
Description
- The present application is a U.S. National Phase of PCT Application No. PCT/US2007/080353 filed Oct. 3, 2007 and claims priority under 35 USC 119(e) to U.S. Provisional Patent Application No. 60/848,969, filed on Oct. 3, 2006, U.S. Provisional Patent Application No. 60/864,117, filed on Nov. 2, 2006; U.S. Provisional Patent Application No. 60/868,057, filed on Nov. 30, 2006; U.S. Provisional Patent Application No. 60/887,517, filed on Jan. 31, 2007; U.S. Provisional Patent Application No. 60/951,159, filed on Jul. 20, 2007; U.S. Provisional Patent Application No. 60/955,001, filed on Aug. 9, 2007; and U.S. Provisional Patent Application No. 60/956,468, filed Aug. 17, 2007, each of which is incorporated herein by reference in their entirety for all purposes.
- The invention pertains to the field of polypeptide manufacturing. In particular, the invention relates to processes for the purification of polypeptide conjugates, especially those conjugates including poly(alkylene oxide)-based modification groups.
- The current literature contains a wealth of information directed to polypeptide purification methodologies, which primarily involve chromatographic approaches as well as membrane filtration techniques. However, effective methods for the purification of modified polypeptides (e.g., PEGylated polypeptides) are not well known. The modification of polypeptides with polymeric moieties causes a significant shift in the chemical and physical properties of those polypeptides. Methods, which are useful for the purification of non-modified polypeptides are not necessarily effective in capturing their modified versions.
- When a glycosylated or non-glycosylated polypeptide is subjected to a chemical modification reaction, side-products may be formed in addition to the desired modified polypeptide. In order to isolate a desired product from a reaction mixture, the process must not only be suitable to remove chemical reagents, but must also be capable of removing unwanted side-products. This is especially important when the polypeptide is to be used as a therapeutic agent. Polypeptide modification technologies, which rely on the specificity of enzymes, may result in a reaction product that is characterized by improved homogeneity when compared to other chemical methods. However, expression of a recombinant polypeptide in a cell (e.g., bacterial, insect, yeast or mammalian cell) typically results in a polypeptide population that, at leas to some extend, is characterized by a variety of glycan structures. Subsequent modification of the polypeptide, e.g., via those glycans, results in a heterogenous product. Although remodeling glycan structures prior to chemical or enzymatic modification of the polypeptide can significantly improve the quality of the product, a certain degree of heterogeneity remains. Hence, a need exists for production processes designed to isolate a desired polypeptide conjugate from a reaction mixture that may not only contain chemical reagents (e.g., those derived from unreacted modifying groups) and/or catalytic enzymes, but may also include polypeptide conjugate by-products. The present invention addresses these and other needs.
- The present invention provides processes for the isolation (e.g., large-scale purification) of polypeptide conjugates. The polypeptide conjugates of the present invention include a polypeptide that is modified with a modifying group, such as a polymer. Exemplary polymers include water-soluble polymers. The methods of the invention are particularly useful for the isolation of polypeptide conjugates that include poly(alkylene oxide)-based polymers, such as poly(ethylene glycol) and poly(propylene glycol). While reverse-phase (RP) chromatography can be used to purify polypeptides that are derivatized with such highly polar, water-soluble polymers, the technique is not desirable because it requires the use of water-soluble organic solvents, such as acetonitrile. Organic solvents, especially in large-scale processes are not only associated with environmental concerns, but can also effect the chemical stability of the purified polypeptide conjugate. Therefore, process steps that rely on aqueous solutions are generally preferred. Hence, in one embodiment, the current invention provides methods that allow for the isolation of polypeptide conjugates essentially without the use of organic solvents.
- An exemplary method of the invention involves at least one chromatographic procedure that is effective in separating polypeptide conjugates having at least one poly(alkylene oxide) moiety from other components of a mixture. The methods of the invention can be used to isolate such polypeptide conjugate from any mixture. In one example, the mixture is a reaction mixture (e.g., the product of a chemical PEGylation reaction or an ezymatically catalyzed PEGylation reaction, e.g., glycoPEGylation reaction) and may optionally include other polypeptide conjugates. Preferred methods of the invention utilize hydrophobic interaction chromatography (HIC) media. In one embodiment, HIC is used in conjunction with at least one additional chromatography step selected from anion exchange chromatography, mixed-mode chromatography, cation exchange chromatography and hydroxyapatite or fluoroapatite chromatography. In another embodiment, HIC is used in conjunction with at least one of anion exchange chromatography, mixed-mode chromatography and cation exchange chromatography. The inventors have discovered that HIC in conjunction with cation chromatography represents an efficient method for the resolution of polypeptide conjugates that include at least one poly(alkylene oxide moiety). In particular, it was discovered that HIC, followed by cation exchange can resolve EPO-PEG3 species from EPO-PEG2 species. In one example, HIC in conjunction with cation exchange provided a composition of purified EPO-[PEG(10 kDa)]3 having a very low residual concentration of EPO-[PEG(10 kDa)]2.
- An exemplary method of the invention that includes anion exchange and cation exchange chromatography in addition to HIC is outlined in
FIG. 1 . In one embodiment, the methods of the invention are useful for the separation of different glycoforms of a polypeptide conjugate, especially those glycoforms distinguished by the number of poly(alkylene oxide) moieties that are linked to the polypeptide. Unwanted glycoforms may be formed as by-products under the reaction conditions used to form the desired polypeptide conjugate. - Hence, in a first aspect, the invention provides a method of making a composition that includes a first polypeptide conjugate, the first polypeptide conjugate having a first number of poly(alkylene oxide) moieties covalently linked to the first polypeptide. The method includes: (a) contacting a mixture containing the first polypeptide conjugate with a hydrophobic interaction chromatography (HIC) medium; and (b) eluting the first polypeptide conjugate from the HIC medium. In one example according to this aspect, the mixture includes a second polypeptide conjugate, wherein the second polypeptide conjugate has a second number of poly(alkylene oxide) moieties covalently linked to the second polypeptide, wherein the first number and the second number are different. For example, the first polypeptide conjugate includes 3 poly(alkylene oxide) moieties, while the second polypeptide conjugate includes either 0, 1, 2 or 4 poly(alkylene oxide) moieties. In one example, the poly(alkylene oxide) is poly(ethylene glycol) (PEG).
- In a second aspect, the invention provides a method of isolating a first polypeptide conjugate including a first number of poly(alkylene oxide) moieties covalently linked to a first polypeptide, from a second polypeptide conjugate that includes a second number of poly(alkylene oxide) moieties covalently linked to a second polypeptide, wherein the first number is selected from 1 to 20 and the second number is selected from 0-20, the first number and the second number being different. The method includes: (a) contacting a mixture containing the first polypeptide conjugate and the second polypeptide conjugate with a hydrophobic interaction chromatography (HIC) medium; and (b) eluting the first polypeptide conjugate from said hydrophobic interaction chromatography medium. In one example according to this aspect, the first polypeptide conjugate includes 3 poly(alkylene oxide) moieties, while the second polypeptide conjugate includes 0, 1, 2, 4, 5, 6 or 7 poly(alkylene oxide) moieties.
- In one example according to any of the above embodiments, the first polypeptide and the second polypeptide have the same amino acid sequence. In another example according to any of the above embodiments, both the first and the second polypeptide are EPO.
- In a third aspect, the invention provides a method of forming a composition that contains a first erythropoietin (EPO) conjugate, wherein the first EPO conjugate includes a first number of poly(alkylene oxide) moieties covalently linked to an EPO polypeptide. The method includes: (a) contacting a mixture containing the first EPO conjugate with an anion exchange medium; (b) eluting the first EPO conjugate from the anion exchange medium, forming a first eluate including the first EPO conjugate; (c) contacting the first eluate with a hydrophobic interaction chromatography (HIC) medium; and (d) eluting the first EPO conjugate from the hydrophobic interaction chromatography medium. The method may further include (e.g., after step d): (e) eluting the first EPO conjugate from a cation exchange chromatography medium.
- In one embodiment, the method further includes forming the polypeptide conjugate either chemically or through enzymatically catalyzed glycomodification (e.g., glycoPEGylation using a glycosyltransferase and an appropriate glycosyl donor molecule, such as a modified sugar nucleotide). GlycoPEGylation methods are art-recognized; see for example, WO 03/031464 to DeFrees et al. or WO 04/99231, the disclosures of which are incorporated herein by reference in their entirety.
- The invention further provides compositions, which are made by the methods of the invention as well as pharmaceutical formulations including the composition of the invention. In addition, the invention provides methods of treatment utilizing the compositions of the invention.
- Other objects and advantages of the invention will be apparent to those of skill in the art from the detailed description that follows.
-
FIG. 1 is an overall view of an exemplary polypeptide conjugate purification process according to a method of the invention. The diafiltration/ultrafiltration step following hydrophobic interaction chromatography (HIC) is optional. -
FIG. 2A is an exemplary chromatogram showing the resolution of tri-PEGylated EPO from mono-, di-, tri- and tetra-PEGylated EPO glycoforms using hydrophobic interaction chromatography withPhenyl 650S as the separation medium. -
FIG. 2B is an expanded view of the EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)2, EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)3 and EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)4 elution peaks of the chromatogram inFIG. 2A . The letters (E), (F) and (G) indicate fractions that were pooled, wherein (F) indicates the elution of EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)3. -
FIG. 3A is a scheme of an exemplary EPO polypeptide conjugate of the invention having an insect-specific glycosylation pattern that includes three N-linked, monoantennary glycan residues covalently linked to amino acid residues N24, N38 and N83. Each glycan residue is covalently linked to a 10 kDa PEG moiety via a terminal galactose (Gal) moiety.FIG. 3A also includes an exemplary reaction scheme, which can be used to synthesize the EPO conjugate. The substrate for the enzymatically catalyzed conversions is an EPO polypeptide, which includes at least one glycan residue having a trimannosyl moiety. In a first step, an N-acetyl glucosamine transferase (GnT-1) is used, which adds a GlcNAc moiety to only one of the terminal mannose moieties. In the second step, a Gal moiety is linked to the newly added GlcNAc moiety using a galactosyl transferase (GalT-1) forming a terminal -GlcNAc-Gal moiety. The first and the second step maybe performed in the same reaction vessel. In the third step, a sialic acid moiety that is modified with a PEG moiety is linked to the terminal Gal moiety using a sialyl transferase (ST3Gal3). -
FIG. 3B is a representation of an exemplary composition of the invention that includes various glycoforms of an exemplary polypeptide conjugate (e.g., EPO conjugate). Each glycoform is distinguished from other glycoforms by the number of PEG moieties that are covalently linked to the polypeptide, or by the structure of the glycans through which the PEG moieties are linked to the polypeptide. Shown percentage values are exemplary. -
FIG. 4A is a reverse phase (RP) HPLC chromatogram of an exemplary glycoPEGylation reaction mixture containing EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)1-4 performed at a 25 mg scale. A Zorbax 300SB-C3 (150×2.1 mm, 5 micron) column was used in the analysis. The following eluants were used: 0.1% TFA in water (Buffer A) and 0.09% TFA in CAN (Buffer B). The gradient was 42-55% B in 14 min followed by 55-95% B in 2 min. The flow rate was 0.6 mL/min. Absorption was measured at 214 nm. The numbered peaks represent: (1) Mono-PEG-EPO=EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)1; (2) di-PEG-EPO=EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)2; (3) tri-PEG-EPO=EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)3 and (4) tetra-PEG-EPO=EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)4. -
FIG. 4B is a reverse phase (RP) HPLC chromatogram of an exemplary composition of the invention containing purified EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)3 as the major component, the composition obtained using a method of the invention. The numbered peaks represent: (1) tri-PEG-EPO=EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)3 and (2) di-PEG-EPO=EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)2. -
FIG. 5 is a schematic representation of exemplary glycopegylated EPO isoforms isolated from Chinese Hamster Ovary cells. A. An exemplary 40 kilodaton O-linked pegylated glycoform. B: One of several 30 kilodatton N-linked pegylated glycoforms. The modified sialic acid moiety comprising the PEG molecule may occur on any one or more of any of the branches of the N-linked glycosyl residue. Furthermore the illustration is exemplary in that any glycosylated EPO molecule may comprise any mixture of mono-, bi- tri-, or tetra-antennary N-linked glycosyl residues and any one or more of the branches may further comprise a modified sialic acid moiety. - PEG, poly(ethyleneglycol); PPG, poly(propyleneglycol); Ara, arabinosyl; Fru, fructosyl; Fuc, fucosyl; Gal, galactosyl; GalNAc, N-acetylgalactosaminyl; Glc, glucosyl; GlcNAc, N-acetylglucosaminyl; Man, mannosyl; ManAc, mannosaminyl acetate; Xyl, xylosyl; and NeuAc, sialyl (N-acetylneuraminyl); M6P, mannose-6-phosphate; BEVS, baculovirus expression vector system; CV, column volume; NTU, nominal turbidity units; vvm, volume/volume/min.
- Unless defined otherwise, all technical and scientific terms used herein generally have the same meaning as commonly understood by one of ordinary skill in the art to which this invention belongs. Generally, the nomenclature used herein and the laboratory procedures in cell culture, molecular genetics, organic chemistry and nucleic acid chemistry and hybridization are those well known and commonly employed in the art. Standard techniques are used for nucleic acid and peptide synthesis. The techniques and procedures are generally performed according to conventional methods in the art and various general references (see generally, Sambrook et al. M
OLECULAR CLONING : A LABORATORY MANUAL, 2d ed. (1989) Cold Spring Harbor Laboratory Press, Cold Spring Harbor, N.Y., which is incorporated herein by reference), which are provided throughout this document. The nomenclature used herein and the laboratory procedures in analytical chemistry, and organic synthetic described below are those well known and commonly employed in the art. Standard techniques, or modifications thereof, are used for chemical syntheses and chemical analyses. - All oligosaccharides described herein are described with the name or abbreviation for the non-reducing saccharide (i.e., Gal), followed by the configuration of the glycosidic bond (α or β), the ring bond (1 or 2), the ring position of the reducing saccharide involved in the bond (2, 3, 4, 6 or 8), and then the name or abbreviation of the reducing saccharide (i.e., GlcNAc). Each saccharide is preferably a pyranose. For a review of standard glycobiology nomenclature see, Essentials of Glycobiology Varki et al. eds. CSHL Press (1999).
- Oligosaccharides are considered to have a reducing end and a non-reducing end, whether or not the saccharide at the reducing end is in fact a reducing sugar. In accordance with accepted nomenclature, oligosaccharides are depicted herein with the non-reducing end on the left and the reducing end on the right.
- Where substituent groups are specified by their conventional chemical formulae, written from left to right, they equally encompass the chemically identical substituents, which would result from writing the structure from right to left, e.g., —CH2O— is intended to also recite —OCH2—.
- The term “alkyl” by itself or as part of another substituent, means, unless otherwise stated, a straight or branched chain, or cyclic (i.e., cycloalkyl)hydrocarbon radical, or combination thereof, which may be fully saturated, mono- or polyunsaturated and can include di-(e.g., alkylene) and multivalent radicals, having the number of carbon atoms designated (i.e. C1-C10 means one to ten carbons). Examples of saturated hydrocarbon radicals include, but are not limited to, groups such as methyl, ethyl, n-propyl, isopropyl, n-butyl, t-butyl, isobutyl, sec-butyl, cyclohexyl, (cyclohexyl)methyl, cyclopropylmethyl, homologs and isomers of, for example, n-pentyl, n-hexyl, n-heptyl, n-octyl, and the like. An unsaturated alkyl group is one having one or more double bonds or triple bonds. Examples of unsaturated alkyl groups include, but are not limited to, vinyl, 2-propenyl, crotyl, 2-isopentenyl, 2-(butadienyl), 2,4-pentadienyl, 3-(1,4-pentadienyl), ethynyl, 1- and 3-propynyl, 3-butynyl, and the higher homologs and isomers. The term “alkyl,” unless otherwise noted, is also meant to include those derivatives of alkyl defined in more detail below, such as “heteroalkyl.” Alkyl groups that are limited to hydrocarbon groups are termed “homoalkyl”.
- The term “alkylene” by itself or as part of another substituent means a divalent radical derived from an alkane, as exemplified, but not limited, by —CH2CH2CH2CH2—, and further includes those groups described below as “heteroalkylene.” Typically, an alkyl (or alkylene) group will have from 1 to 24 carbon atoms, with those groups having 10 or fewer carbon atoms being preferred in the present invention. A “lower alkyl” or “lower alkylene” is a shorter chain alkyl or alkylene group, generally having eight or fewer carbon atoms.
- The terms “alkoxy,” “alkylamino” and “alkylthio” (or thioalkoxy) are used in their conventional sense, and refer to those alkyl groups attached to the remainder of the molecule via an oxygen atom, an amino group, or a sulfur atom, respectively.
- The term “heteroalkyl,” by itself or in combination with another term, means, unless otherwise stated, a stable straight or branched chain, or cyclic hydrocarbon radical, or combinations thereof, consisting of the stated number of carbon atoms and at least one heteroatom selected from the group consisting of O, N, Si and S, and wherein the nitrogen and sulfur atoms may optionally be oxidized and the nitrogen heteroatom may optionally be quaternized. The heteroatom(s) O, N and S and Si may be placed at any interior position of the heteroalkyl group or at the position at which the alkyl group is attached to the remainder of the molecule. Examples include, but are not limited to, —CH2—CH2—O—CH3, —CH2—CH2—NH—CH3, —CH2—CH2—N(CH3)—CH3, —CH2—S—CH2—CH3, —CH2—CH2, —S(O)—CH3, —CH2—CH2—S(O)2—CH3, —CH═CH—O—CH3, —Si(CH3)3, —CH2—CH═N—OCH3, and CH═CH—N(CH3)—CH3. Up to two heteroatoms may be consecutive, such as, for example, —CH2—NH—OCH3 and CH2—O—Si(CH3)3. Similarly, the term “heteroalkylene” by itself or as part of another substituent means a divalent radical derived from heteroalkyl, as exemplified, but not limited by, —CH2—CH2—S—CH2—CH2— and CH2—S—CH2—CH2—NH—CH2—. For heteroalkylene groups, heteroatoms can also occupy either or both of the chain termini (e.g., alkyleneoxy, alkylenedioxy, alkyleneamino, alkylenediamino, and the like). Still further, for alkylene and heteroalkylene linking groups, no orientation of the linking group is implied by the direction in which the formula of the linking group is written. For example, the formula —CO2R′— represents both —C(O)OR′ and —OC(O)R′.
- The terms “cycloalkyl” and “heterocycloalkyl”, by themselves or in combination with other terms, represent, unless otherwise stated, cyclic versions of “alkyl” and “heteroalkyl”, respectively. Additionally, for heterocycloalkyl, a heteroatom can occupy the position at which the heterocycle is attached to the remainder of the molecule. Examples of cycloalkyl include, but are not limited to, cyclopentyl, cyclohexyl, 1-cyclohexenyl, 3-cyclohexenyl, cycloheptyl, and the like. Examples of heterocycloalkyl include, but are not limited to, 1-(1,2,5,6-tetrahydropyridyl), 1-piperidinyl, 2-piperidinyl, 3-piperidinyl, 4-morpholinyl, 3-morpholinyl, tetrahydrofuran-2-yl, tetrahydrofuran-3-yl, tetrahydrothien-2-yl, tetrahydrothien-3-yl, 1-piperazinyl, 2-piperazinyl, and the like.
- The terms “halo” or “halogen,” by themselves or as part of another substituent, mean, unless otherwise stated, a fluorine, chlorine, bromine, or iodine atom. Additionally, terms such as “haloalkyl,” are meant to include monohaloalkyl and polyhaloalkyl. For example, the term “halo(C1-C4)alkyl” is mean to include, but not be limited to, trifluoromethyl, 2,2,2-trifluoroethyl, 4-chlorobutyl, 3-bromopropyl, and the like.
- The term “aryl” means, unless otherwise stated, a polyunsaturated, aromatic, substituent that can be a single ring or multiple rings (preferably from 1 to 3 rings), which are fused together or linked covalently. The term “heteroaryl” refers to aryl groups (or rings) that contain from one to four heteroatoms selected from N, O, S, Si and B, wherein the nitrogen and sulfur atoms are optionally oxidized, and the nitrogen atom(s) are optionally quaternized. A heteroaryl group can be attached to the remainder of the molecule through a heteroatom. Non-limiting examples of aryl and heteroaryl groups include phenyl, 1-naphthyl, 2-naphthyl, 4-biphenyl, 1-pyrrolyl, 2-pyrrolyl, 3-pyrrolyl, 3-pyrazolyl, 2-imidazolyl, 4-imidazolyl, pyrazinyl, 2-oxazolyl, 4-oxazolyl, 2-phenyl-4-oxazolyl, 5-oxazolyl, 3-isoxazolyl, 4-isoxazolyl, 5-isoxazolyl, 2-thiazolyl, 4-thiazolyl, 5-thiazolyl, 2-furyl, 3-furyl, 2-thienyl, 3-thienyl, 2-pyridyl, 3-pyridyl, 4-pyridyl, 2-pyrimidyl, 4-pyrimidyl, 5-benzothiazolyl, purinyl, 2-benzimidazolyl, 5-indolyl, 1-isoquinolyl, 5-isoquinolyl, 2-quinoxalinyl, 5-quinoxalinyl, 3-quinolyl, and 6-quinolyl. Substituents for each of the above noted aryl and heteroaryl ring systems are selected from the group of acceptable substituents described below.
- For brevity, the term “aryl” when used in combination with other terms (e.g., aryloxy, arylthioxy, arylalkyl) includes both aryl and heteroaryl rings as defined above. Thus, the term “arylalkyl” is meant to include those radicals in which an aryl group is attached to an alkyl group (e.g., benzyl, phenethyl, pyridylmethyl and the like) including those alkyl groups in which a carbon atom (e.g., a methylene group) has been replaced by, for example, an oxygen atom (e.g., phenoxymethyl, 2-pyridyloxymethyl, 3-(1-naphthyloxy)propyl, and the like).
- Each of the above terms (e.g., “alkyl,” “heteroalkyl,” “aryl” and “heteroaryl”) are meant to include both substituted and unsubstituted forms of the indicated radical. Preferred substituents for each type of radical are provided below.
- Substituents for the alkyl and heteroalkyl radicals (including those groups often referred to as alkylene, alkenyl, heteroalkylene, heteroalkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, heterocycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, and heterocycloalkenyl) are generically referred to as “alkyl group substituents,” and they can be one or more of a variety of groups selected from, but not limited to: substituted or unsubstituted aryl, substituted or unsubstituted heteroaryl, substituted or unsubstituted heterocycloalkyl, —OR′, ═O, ═NR′, ═N—OR′, —NR′R″, —SR′, -halogen, —SiR′R″R′″, —OC(O)R′, —C(O)R′, —CO2R′, —CONR′R″, —OC(O)NR′R″, —NR″C(O)R′, —NR′—C(O)NR″R′″, —NR″C(O)2R′, —NR—C(NR′R″R′″)═NR″″, —NR—C(NR′R″)═NR′″, —S(O)R′, —S(O)2R′, —S(O)2NR′R″, —NRSO2R′, —CN and NO2 in a number ranging from zero to (2 m′+1), where m' is the total number of carbon atoms in such radical. R′, R″, R′″ and R″″ each preferably independently refer to hydrogen, substituted or unsubstituted heteroalkyl, substituted or unsubstituted aryl, e.g., aryl substituted with 1-3 halogens, substituted or unsubstituted alkyl, alkoxy or thioalkoxy groups, or arylalkyl groups. When a compound of the invention includes more than one R group, for example, each of the R groups is independently selected as are each R′, R″, R′″ and R″″ groups when more than one of these groups is present. When R′ and R″ are attached to the same nitrogen atom, they can be combined with the nitrogen atom to form a 5-, 6-, or 7-membered ring. For example, —NR′R″ is meant to include, but not be limited to, 1-pyrrolidinyl and 4-morpholinyl. From the above discussion of substituents, one of skill in the art will understand that the term “alkyl” is meant to include groups including carbon atoms bound to groups other than hydrogen groups, such as haloalkyl (e.g., —CF3 and —CH2CF3) and acyl (e.g., —C(O)CH3, —C(O)CF3, —C(O)CH2OCH3, and the like).
- Similar to the substituents described for the alkyl radical, substituents for the aryl and heteroaryl groups are generically referred to as “aryl group substituents.” The substituents are selected from, for example: substituted or unsubstituted alkyl, substituted or unsubstituted heteroalkyl, substituted or unsubstituted aryl, substituted or unsubstituted heteroaryl, substituted or unsubstituted heterocycloalkyl, —OR′, ═O, ═NR′, ═N—OR′, —NR′R″, —SR′, -halogen, —SiR′R″R′″, —OC(O)R′, —C(O)R′, —CO2R′, —CONR′R″, —OC(O)NR′R″, —NR″C(O)R′, —NR′—C(O)NR″R′″, —NR″C(O)2R′, —NR—C(NR′R″R′″)═NR″″, —NR—C(NR′R″)═NR′″, —S(O)R′, —S(O)2R′, —S(O)2NR′R″, —NRSO2R′, —CN and NO2, —R′, —N3, —CH(Ph)2, fluoro(C1-C4)alkoxy, and fluoro(C1-C4)alkyl, in a number ranging from zero to the total number of open valences on the aromatic ring system; and where R′, R″, R′″ and R″″ are preferably independently selected from hydrogen, substituted or unsubstituted alkyl, substituted or unsubstituted heteroalkyl, substituted or unsubstituted aryl and substituted or unsubstituted heteroaryl. When a compound of the invention includes more than one R group, for example, each of the R groups is independently selected as are each R′, R″, R′″ and R′″″ groups when more than one of these groups is present.
- Two of the substituents on adjacent atoms of the aryl or heteroaryl ring may optionally be replaced with a substituent of the formula -T-C(O)—(CRR′)q—U—, wherein T and U are independently —NR—, —O—, —CRR′— or a single bond, and q is an integer of from 0 to 3. Alternatively, two of the substituents on adjacent atoms of the aryl or heteroaryl ring may optionally be replaced with a substituent of the formula -A-(CH2)r—B—, wherein A and B are independently —CRR′—, —O—, —NR—, —S—, —S(O)—, —S(O)2—, —S(O)2NR′— or a single bond, and r is an integer of from 1 to 4. One of the single bonds of the new ring so formed may optionally be replaced with a double bond. Alternatively, two of the substituents on adjacent atoms of the aryl or heteroaryl ring may optionally be replaced with a substituent of the formula —(CRR′)s—X—(CR″R′″)d—, where s and d are independently integers of from 0 to 3, and X is —O—, —NR′—, —S—, —S(O)—, —S(O)2—, or S(O)2NR′—. The substituents R, R′, R″ and R′″ are preferably independently selected from hydrogen or substituted or unsubstituted (C1-C6)alkyl.
- As used herein, the term “acyl” describes a substituent containing a carbonyl residue, C(O)R. Exemplary species for R include H, halogen, alkoxy, substituted or unsubstituted alkyl, substituted or unsubstituted aryl, substituted or unsubstituted heteroaryl, and substituted or unsubstituted heterocycloalkyl.
- As used herein, the term “fused ring system” means at least two rings, wherein each ring has at least 2 atoms in common with another ring. “Fused ring systems may include aromatic as well as non aromatic rings. Examples of “fused ring systems” are naphthalenes, indoles, quinolines, chromenes and the like.
- As used herein, the term “heteroatom” includes oxygen (O), nitrogen (N), sulfur (S), silicon (Si) and boron (B).
- The symbol “R” is a general abbreviation that represents a substituent group. Exemplary substituent groups include substituted or unsubstituted alkyl, substituted or unsubstituted heteroalkyl, substituted or unsubstituted aryl, substituted or unsubstituted heteroaryl, and substituted or unsubstituted heterocycloalkyl groups.
- The term “pharmaceutically acceptable salts” includes salts of the active compounds which are prepared with relatively nontoxic acids or bases, depending on the particular substituents found on the compounds described herein. When compounds of the present invention contain relatively acidic functionalities, base addition salts can be obtained by contacting the neutral form of such compounds with a sufficient amount of the desired base, either neat or in a suitable inert solvent. Examples of pharmaceutically acceptable base addition salts include sodium, potassium, calcium, ammonium, organic amino, or magnesium salt, or a similar salt. When compounds of the present invention contain relatively basic functionalities, acid addition salts can be obtained by contacting the neutral form of such compounds with a sufficient amount of the desired acid, either neat or in a suitable inert solvent. Examples of pharmaceutically acceptable acid addition salts include those derived from inorganic acids like hydrochloric, hydrobromic, nitric, carbonic, monohydrogencarbonic, phosphoric, monohydrogenphosphoric, dihydrogenphosphoric, sulfuric, monohydrogensulfuric, hydriodic, or phosphorous acids and the like, as well as the salts derived from relatively nontoxic organic acids like acetic, propionic, isobutyric, maleic, malonic, benzoic, succinic, suberic, fumaric, lactic, mandelic, phthalic, benzenesulfonic, p-tolylsulfonic, citric, tartaric, methanesulfonic, and the like. Also included are salts of amino acids such as arginate and the like, and salts of organic acids like glucuronic or galactunoric acids and the like (see, for example, Berge et al., Journal of Pharmaceutical Science, 66: 1-19 (1977)). Certain specific compounds of the present invention contain both basic and acidic functionalities that allow the compounds to be converted into either base or acid addition salts.
- The neutral forms of the compounds are preferably regenerated by contacting the salt with a base or acid and isolating the parent compound in the conventional manner. The parent form of the compound differs from the various salt forms in certain physical properties, such as solubility in polar solvents, but otherwise the salts are equivalent to the parent form of the compound for the purposes of the present invention.
- In addition to salt forms, the present invention provides compounds, which are in a prodrug form. Prodrugs of the compounds described herein are those compounds that readily undergo chemical changes under physiological conditions to provide the compounds of the present invention. Additionally, prodrugs can be converted to the compounds of the present invention by chemical or biochemical methods in an ex vivo environment. For example, prodrugs can be slowly converted to the compounds of the present invention when placed in a transdermal patch reservoir with a suitable enzyme or chemical reagent.
- Certain compounds of the present invention can exist in unsolvated forms as well as solvated forms, including hydrated forms. In general, the solvated forms are equivalent to unsolvated forms and are encompassed within the scope of the present invention. Certain compounds of the present invention may exist in multiple crystalline or amorphous forms. In general, all physical forms are equivalent for the uses contemplated by the present invention and are intended to be within the scope of the present invention.
- Certain compounds of the present invention possess asymmetric carbon atoms (optical centers) or double bonds; the racemates, diastereomers, geometric isomers and individual isomers are encompassed within the scope of the present invention.
- The compounds of the invention may be prepared as a single isomer (e.g., enantiomer, cis-trans, positional, diastereomer) or as a mixture of isomers. In a preferred embodiment, the compounds are prepared as substantially a single isomer. Methods of preparing substantially isomerically pure compounds are known in the art. For example, enantiomerically enriched mixtures and pure enantiomeric compounds can be prepared by using synthetic intermediates that are enantiomerically pure in combination with reactions that either leave the stereochemistry at a chiral center unchanged or result in its complete inversion. Alternatively, the final product or intermediates along the synthetic route can be resolved into a single stereoisomer. Techniques for inverting or leaving unchanged a particular stereocenter, and those for resolving mixtures of stereoisomers are well known in the art and it is well within the ability of one of skill in the art to choose and appropriate method for a particular situation. See, generally, Furniss et al. (eds.), V
OGEL'S ENCYCLOPEDIA OF PRACTICAL ORGANIC CHEMISTRY 5TH ED ., Longman Scientific and Technical Ltd., Essex, 1991, pp. 809-816; and Heller, Acc. Chem. Res. 23: 128 (1990). - The graphic representations of racemic, ambiscalemic and scalemic or enantiomerically pure compounds used herein are taken from Maehr, J. Chem. Ed., 62: 114-120 (1985): solid and broken wedges are used to denote the absolute configuration of a chiral element; wavy lines indicate disavowal of any stereochemical implication which the bond it represents could generate; solid and broken bold lines are geometric descriptors indicating the relative configuration shown but not implying any absolute stereochemistry; and wedge outlines and dotted or broken lines denote enantiomerically pure compounds of indeterminate absolute configuration.
- The terms “enantiomeric excess” and diastereomeric excess” are used interchangeably herein. Compounds with a single stereocenter are referred to as being present in “enantiomeric excess,” those with at least two stereocenters are referred to as being present in “diastereomeric excess.”
- The compounds of the present invention may also contain unnatural proportions of atomic isotopes at one or more of the atoms that constitute such compounds. For example, the compounds may be radiolabeled with radioactive isotopes, such as for example tritium (3H), iodine-125 (125I) or carbon-14 (14C). All isotopic variations of the compounds of the present invention, whether radioactive or not, are intended to be encompassed within the scope of the present invention.
- “Reactive functional group,” as used herein refers to groups including, but not limited to, olefins, acetylenes, alcohols, phenols, ethers, oxides, halides, aldehydes, ketones, carboxylic acids, esters, amides, cyanates, isocyanates, thiocyanates, isothiocyanates, amines, hydrazines, hydrazones, hydrazides, diazo, diazonium, nitro, nitriles, mercaptans, sulfides, disulfides, sulfoxides, sulfones, sulfonic acids, sulfinic acids, acetals, ketals, anhydrides, sulfates, sulfenic acids isonitriles, amidines, imides, imidates, nitrones, hydroxylamines, oximes, hydroxamic acids thiohydroxamic acids, allenes, ortho esters, sulfites, enamines, ynamines, ureas, pseudoureas, semicarbazides, carbodiimides, carbamates, imines, azides, azo compounds, azoxy compounds, and nitroso compounds. Reactive functional groups also include those used to prepare bioconjugates, e.g., N-hydroxysuccinimide esters, maleimides and the like. Methods to prepare each of these functional groups are well known in the art and their application or modification for a particular purpose is within the ability of one of skill in the art (see, for example, Sandler and Karo, eds. O
RGANIC FUNCTIONAL GROUP PREPARATIONS , Academic Press, San Diego, 1989). - As used herein, “pharmaceutically acceptable carrier” includes any material, which when combined with the conjugate retains the conjugates' activity and is non-reactive with the subject's immune systems. “Pharmaceutically acceptable carrier” includes solids and liquids, such as vehicles, diluents and solvents. Examples include, but are not limited to, any of the standard pharmaceutical carriers such as a phosphate buffered saline solution, water, emulsions such as oil/water emulsion, and various types of wetting agents. Other carriers may also include sterile solutions, tablets including coated tablets and capsules. Typically such carriers contain excipients such as starch, milk, sugar, certain types of clay, gelatin, stearic acid or salts thereof, magnesium or calcium stearate, talc, vegetable fats or oils, gums, glycols, or other known excipients. Such carriers may also include flavor and color additives or other ingredients. Compositions comprising such carriers are formulated by well known conventional methods.
- As used herein, “administering” means oral administration, administration as a suppository, topical contact, intravenous, intraperitoneal, intramuscular, intralesional, or subcutaneous administration, administration by inhalation, or the implantation of a slow-release device, e.g., a mini-osmotic pump, to the subject. Adminsitration is by any route including parenteral and transmucosal (e.g., oral, nasal, vaginal, rectal, or transdermal), particularly by inhalation. Parenteral administration includes, e.g., intravenous, intramuscular, intra-arteriole, intradermal, subcutaneous, intraperitoneal, intraventricular, and intracranial. Moreover, where injection is to treat a tumor, e.g., induce apoptosis, administration may be directly to the tumor and/or into tissues surrounding the tumor. Other modes of delivery include, but are not limited to, the use of liposomal formulations, intravenous infusion, transdermal patches, etc.
- The term “ameliorating” or “ameliorate” refers to any indicia of success in the treatment of a pathology or condition, including any objective or subjective parameter such as abatement, remission or diminishing of symptoms or an improvement in a patient's physical or mental well-being. Amelioration of symptoms can be based on objective or subjective parameters; including the results of a physical examination and/or a psychiatric evaluation.
- The term “therapy” refers to “treating” or “treatment” of a disease or condition including preventing the disease or condition from occurring in a subject (e.g., human) that may be predisposed to the disease but does not yet experience or exhibit symptoms of the disease (prophylactic treatment), inhibiting the disease (slowing or arresting its development), providing relief from the symptoms or side-effects of the disease (including palliative treatment), and relieving the disease (causing regression of the disease).
- The term “effective amount” or “an amount effective to” or a “therapeutically effective amount” or any gramatically equivalent term means the amount that, when administered to an animal or human for treating a disease, is sufficient to effect treatment for that disease.
- The term “insect cell culture” refers to the in vitro growth and culturing of cell derived from organisms of the Class Insecta. “Insect cell culture” also refers to a cell culture comprising cells of the Class Insecta which have been grown and cultured in vitro.
- “Peptide” refers to a polymer in which the monomers are amino acids and are joined together through amide bonds, alternatively referred to as a polypeptide. Additionally, unnatural amino acids, for example, β-alanine, phenylglycine and homoarginine are also included. Amino acids that are not gene-encoded may also be used in the present invention. Furthermore, amino acids that have been modified to include reactive groups, glycosylation sites, polymers, therapeutic moieties, biomolecules and the like may also be used in the invention. All of the amino acids used in the present invention may be either the
D - orL -isomer. TheL -isomer is generally preferred. In addition, other peptidomimetics are also useful in the present invention. As used herein, “peptide” refers to both glycosylated and unglycosylated peptides. Also included are petides that are incompletely glycosylated by a system that expresses the peptide. For a general review, see, Spatola, A. F., in CHEMISTRY AND BIOCHEMISTRY OF AMINO ACIDS , PEPTIDES AND PROTEINS , B. Weinstein, eds., Marcel Dekker, New York, p. 267 (1983). The term peptide includes molecules that are commonly referred to as proteins or polypeptides. - A “glycopeptide” as the term is used herein refers to a peptide having at least one carbohydrate moiety covalently linked thereto. It is understood that a glycopeptide may be a “therapeutic glycopeptide”. The term “glycopeptide” is used interchangeably herein with the terms “glycopolypeptide” and “glycoprotein.”
- The term “peptide conjugate” refers to species of the invention in which a peptide is conjugated with a modified sugar as set forth herein.
- As used herein, the term “modified sugar” refers to a naturally- or non-naturally-occurring carbohydrate that is enzymatically added onto an amino acid or a glycosyl residue of a peptide in a process of the invention. The modified sugar is selected from a number of enzyme substrates including, but not limited to sugar nucleotides (mono-, di-, and tri-phosphates), activated sugars (e.g., glycosyl halides, glycosyl mesylates) and sugars that are neither activated nor nucleotides. The “modified sugar” is covalently functionalized with a “modifying group.” Useful modifying groups include, but are not limited to, PEG moieties, therapeutic moieties, diagnostic moieties, biomolecules and the like. The modifying group is preferably not a naturally occurring, or an unmodified carbohydrate. The locus of functionalization with the modifying group is selected such that it does not prevent the “modified sugar” from being added enzymatically to a peptide.
- The term “glycoconjugation” as used herein, refers to the enzymatically mediated conjugation of a modified sugar species to an amino acid or glycosyl residue of a polypeptide, e.g., an erythropoietin peptide prepared by the method of the present invention. A subgenus of “glycoconjugation” is “glyco-PEGylation,” in which the modifying group of the modified sugar is poly(ethylene glycol), an alkyl derivative (e.g., m-PEG) or reactive derivative (e.g., H2N-PEG, HOOC-PEG) thereof.
- The terms “large-scale” and “industrial-scale” are used interchangeably and refer to a reaction cycle or process that produces at least about 250 mg, preferably at least about 500 mg, and more preferably at least about 1 gram of peptide at the completion of a single cycle.
- The term, “glycosyl linking group,” as used herein refers to a glycosyl residue to which a modifying group (e.g., PEG moiety, therapeutic moiety, biomolecule) is covalently attached; the glycosyl linking group joins the modifying group to the remainder of the conjugate. In the methods of the invention, the “glycosyl linking group” becomes covalently attached to a glycosylated or unglycosylated polypeptide, thereby linking the modifying group to an amino acid and/or glycosyl residue of the polypeptide. A “glycosyl linking group” is generally derived from a “modified sugar” by the enzymatic attachment of the “modified sugar” to an amino acid and/or glycosyl residue of the polypeptide. The glycosyl linking group can be a saccharide-derived structure that is degraded during formation of modifying group-modified sugar cassette (e.g., oxidation→Schiff base formation→reduction), or the glycosyl linking group may be intact. An “intact glycosyl linking group” refers to a linking group that is derived from a glycosyl moiety in which the saccharide monomer that links the modifying group and to the remainder of the conjugate is not degraded, e.g., oxidized, e.g., by sodium metaperiodate. “Intact glycosyl linking groups” of the invention may be derived from a naturally occurring oligosaccharide by addition of glycosyl unit(s) or removal of one or more glycosyl unit from a parent saccharide structure. A “glycosyl linking group” may include a glycosyl-mimetic moiety. For example, the glycosyl transferase (e.g., sialyl transferase), which is used to add the modified sugar to a glycosylated polypeptide, exhibits tolerance for a glycosyl-mimetic substrate (e.g., a modified sugar in which the sugar moiety is a glycosyl-mimetic moiety—e.g., sialyl-mimetic moiety). The transfer of the modified glycosyl-mimetic sugar results in a conjugate having a glycosyl linking group that is a glycosyl-mimetic moiety.
- The term “glycosyl-mimetic moiety,” as used herein refers to a moiety, which structurally resembles a glycosyl moiety (e.g., a hexose or a pentose). Examples of “glycosyl-mimetic moiety” include those moieties, wherein the glycosidic oxygen or the ring oxygen of a glycosyl moiety, or both, has been replaced with a bond or another atom (e.g., sulfur), or another moiety, such as a carbon- (e.g., CH2), or nitrogen-containing group (e.g., NH). Examples include substituted or unsubstituted cyclohexyl derivatives, cyclic thioethers, cyclic secondary amines, moieties including a thioglycosidic bond, and the like. In one example, the “glycosyl-mimetic moiety” is transferred in an enzymatically catalyzed reaction onto an amino acid residue of a polypeptide or a glycosyl moiety of a glycopeptide. This can, for instance, be accomplished by activating the “glycosyl-mimetic moiety” with a leaving group, such as a halogen.
- The term, “polypeptide glycoform” or “glycoform” as used herein refers to two polypeptide conjugates having the same amino acid sequence, but having a different glycosylation pattern with respect to the glycan residues to which the modifying group(s), e.g., poly(alkylene oxide) moieties, are covalently linked. Two polypeptide conjugates having a different number of modifying groups (e.g., poly(alkylene oxide) moieties) also referred to as glycoforms.
FIG. 3B shows exemplary glycoforms of an EPO polypeptide conjugate. Illustrated are tri-PEGylated, di-PEGylated and tetra-PEGylated glycoforms of an EPO-PEG conjugate, wherein the EPO includes an insect-specific glycosylation pattern. Other exemplary EPO-PEG glycoforms may be derived from EPO expressed in CHO cells, as depicted inFIG. 5 . Additional EPO-PEG glycoforms, which may be isolated according to the methods of the invention are disclosed in U.S. patent application Ser. No. 10/997,405 filed Nov. 24, 2004 and U.S. patent application Ser. No. 11/144,223 filed Jun. 2, 2005, the disclosures of which are disclosed herein in their entirety. EPO-PEG conjugates discussed in the Examples, below, are alternatively referred to as EPO-PEG “species”, “forms” or “states”. - The term “isolated” refers to a material that is essentially free from components, which are used to produce the material. For peptide conjugates of the invention, the term “isolated” refers to a material that is essentially free from components which normally accompany the material in the mixture used to prepare the peptide conjugate. The terms “isolated” and “pure” are used interchangeably. Typically, isolated peptide conjugates of the invention have a level of purity expressed as a range. For example, the lower end of the range is about 50%, about 55%, about 60%, about 65%, about 70%, about 75% or about 80% and the upper end of the range is about 55%, about 60%, about 65%, about 70%, about 75%, about 80%, about 85%, about 90%, about 95% or more than about 95%.
- When the peptide conjugates are more than about 90% pure, their purities are preferably expressed as a range. For example, the lower end of the range being about 90%, about 92%, about 94%, about 96% or about 98% and the upper end of the range being about 92%, about 94%, about 96%, about 98% or about 100%.
- Methods for the determination of purity are known to those of skill in the art. Purity of a polypeptide conjugate may be determined by any suitable, art-recognized method of analysis (e.g., band intensity on a silver stained gel, polyacrylamide gel electrophoresis, ELISA, HPLC and the like). An exemplary method is size-exclusion chromatography (SEC) HPLC, described herein below. Purity may be determined using relative “area under the curve” (AUC) values, which can typically be obtained for peaks in a chromatogram, such as an HPLC chromatogram. Optionally, purities are determined by chromatographic or other means using a standard curve generated using a reference material of known purity. Purity may also be determined on a weight-by-weight basis.
- Methods that are useful for the determination of “purity” (e.g., those described above) are also useful for the determination of the “concentration” of a particular component in a mixture (e.g., a composition of the invention) or relative concentration of one component with respect to one or more other components. For example, SEC HPLC may be used to determine the ratio between different glycoforms or to determine the concentration of a specific glycoform in a composition of the invention.
- “Essentially each member of the population” as used herein, speaks to the “homogeneity” of the sites on the peptide and to a population of peptide that share a common structure, e.g., a common glycosylation pattern glycosyl structure.
- “Homogeneity” refers to the structural consistency across a population of polypeptides. Thus, in a glycopeptide of the invention, in which each glycan residue has the same structure, the glycopeptide is said to be about 100% homogeneous. Similarly, when a in a population of glycopeptides, each glycopeptide has glycan residues of the same structure, such that each peptide of the population is essentially of the same molecular species, the population is said to be about 100% homogeneous. Homogeneity is typically expressed as a range. The lower end of the range of homogeneity for the peptide conjugates is about 60%, about 70% or about 80% and the upper end of the range of purity is about 70%, about 80%, about 90% or more than about 90%.
- When the peptide conjugates are more than or equal to about 90% homogeneous, their homogeneity is also preferably expressed as a range. The lower end of the range of homogeneity is about 90%, about 92%, about 94%, about 96% or about 98%. The upper end of the range of purity is about 92%, about 94%, about 96%, about 98% or about 100%. The homogeneity of the peptide conjugates is typically determined by one or more methods known to those of skill in the art, e.g., gel electrophoresis, liquid chromatography-mass spectrometry (LC-MS), matrix assisted laser desorption mass time of flight spectrometry (MALDI-TOF), capillary electrophoresis, and the like.
- “Substantially uniform glycosylation pattern,” when referring to a glycopeptide species of the invention, refers to the percentage of glycosylation sites on the polypeptide that have a glycan residue of the same structure. For example a polypeptide that includes multiple N-linked or O-linked glycosylation sites may have a glycosyl residue of the same structure present at all comparable glycosylation sites, at about 90% of all comparable sites, about 80% or about 75% of all comparable glycosylation sites. In these instances the polypeptide would be said to have a “substantially uniform glycosylation pattern”. Alternatively, when a population of glycopeptides share a common glycosylation pattern, the population may be said to have a “substantially uniform glycosylation pattern” when a majority of the peptides in the population represent essentially a single molecular species.
- For instance, when a population of glycosylated polypeptides are isolated from a cell, without further modification, the members of the population may include a range of variations in the precise structure of their glycan residues. However, in an exemplary embodiment, peptides isolated from insect cells have a substantially uniform insect-specific glycosylation pattern. This refers to the fact that the majority of polypeptides, or substantially all of the polypeptides, in the preparation represent one distinct molecular species.
- The term “substantially” in the above definitions of “substantially uniform” generally means at least about 40%, at least about 45%, at least about 50%, at least about 55%, at least about 60%, at least about 65%, at least about 70%, 71%, 72%, 73%, 74%, 75%, 76%, 77%, 78%, 79%, at least about 80%, 81%, 82%, 83%, 84%, 85%, 86%, 87%, 88%, 89%, at least about 90%, 91%, 92%, 93%, 94%, 95%, 96%, 97%, 98%, 99%, or even 100% of the acceptor moieties are glycosylated with the expected insect cell specific glycosylation pattern.
- The term “insect specific glycosylation pattern” refers to the glycosylation pattern found on mature glycopeptides produced by insect cells. Typically, insect cells generate simple N-linked oligosaccharides terminating in mannose (for review, see e.g., Essentials of Glycobiology A. Varki et al. eds, CSHL Press (1999) pgs: 32-33). Typically, N-linked glycans produced by insect cell lines produce glycoproteins that (at maturity) include a Man3GlcNAc2 structure. Fucose units may also be found on the GlcNAc residue that is directly linked to the peptide. A mature peptide emerging from a cell with an “insect specific glycosylation pattern” thus includes one or more glycans having a trimannosyl (Man3) or Man3GlcNAc2 structure. “Insect specific glycosylation pattern” also refers to polypeptide populations, in which essentially all of the polypeptides have glycan structures terminating with a common motive (e.g., the Man3 or Man3GlcNAc2 motive) and are not degraded, e.g., to expose one of the two GlcNAc residues directly bound to the polypeptide.
- The term “loading buffer” refers to the buffer, in which the polypeptide conjugate being purified is applied to a purification device, e.g. a chromatography column or a filter cartridge. Typically, the loading buffer is selected so that separation of the peptide conjugate of interest from unwanted impurities can be accomplished. For instance, when purifying the polypeptide conjugate on a hydroxyapatite (HA) or fluoroapatite column the pH of the loading buffer and the salt concentration in the loading buffer may be selected so that the polypeptide conjugate is initially retained on the column while certain impurities are found in the flow through. In other example, the loading buffer is selected to retain impurities while the desired polypeptide conjugate is found in the flow-through.
- The term “elution buffer” refers to the buffer, which is typically used to remove (elute) the polypeptide conjugate from the purification device (e.g. a chromatographic column or filter cartridge) to which it was applied earlier. Typically, the elution buffer is selected so that separation of the polypeptide conjugate of interest from unwanted impurities can be accomplished. Often, the concentration of a particular ingredient, such as a particular salt (e.g. NaCl) in the elution buffer is varied during the elution procedure (gradient). The gradient may be continuous or stepwise (interrupted by hold periods).
- The term “controlled room temperature” refers to a temperature of at least about 10° C., at least about 15° C., at least about 20° C. or at least about 25° C. Typically, controlled room temperature is between about 20° C. and about 25° C.
- The present invention provides processes for the isolation (e.g., large-scale isolation) of polypeptide conjugates from a mixture. The polypeptide conjugates isolated by the methods of the invention include at least one modifying group. Exemplary modifying groups include polymers, such as poly(alkylene oxide) moieties (e.g., poly(ethylene glycol) or poly(propylene glycol)). Exemplary modifying groups are described herein, below.
- In one embodiment, the polypeptide conjugate is isolated from a reaction mixture. In one example, the reaction mixture is the product of a chemical reaction, such as a chemical PEGylation reaction. In one example according to this embodiment, the reaction mixture may contain chemicals, such as unreacted polymeric reagents and/or hydrolysis products thereof. In another example, the reaction mixture is the product of an enzymatically catalyzed reaction, such as an enzymatically catalyzed glycoPEGylation reaction. In this instance, the reaction mixture may include enzymes, and may further include reagents, such as unreacted enzyme substrates (e.g., nucleotide sugars and the like). In one example, the methods of the invention are suitable for the isolation of a polypeptide conjugate from the above listed reaction mixture components.
- In another embodiment, the methods of the invention are useful to isolate a desired polypeptide conjugate from a mixture that includes other polypeptide conjugates, which are sought to be separated from the desired polypeptide conjugate. Such “unwanted” polypeptide conjugates or side-products may be generated during the same reaction that leads to the formation of the desired polypeptide conjugate. For example, a recombinant polypeptide is subjected to a chemical PEGylation reaction. The reaction product includes different polypeptide conjugates, in which each type of polypeptide conjugate includes a different number of PEG moieties, e.g., the majority of the polypeptide conjugates includes three PEG moieties, while a small percentage of the polypeptide conjugates in the reaction mixture is covalently linked to only one or two PEG moieties. In another example, a recombinantly produced polypeptide is subjected to an enzymatically catalyzed glycoPEGylation reaction. Due to a heterogenous glycosylation pattern of the polypeptide population used in the reaction, the reaction mixture includes different polypeptide conjugates, in which each type of polypeptide conjugate has a different structure with respect to the number of PEG moieties covalently linked to the polypeptide and/or the structure of the glycan residues, to which each PEG moiety is attached to the polypeptide. The mixture may also contain unreacted polypeptide.
- The inventors have discovered that hydrophobic interaction chromatography (HIC) resins, such as butyl and phenyl resins (e.g.,
Phenyl 650S) are particularly useful for the isolation of polypeptides modified with at least one poly(alkylene oxide) moiety. In particular, it has become apparent that HIC is superior in separating different glycoforms of a polypeptide conjugate, especially glycoforms that are distinguished by the number of poly(alkylene oxide) moieties that are linked to the polypeptide. - For example, HIC is efficient in separating an erythropoietin (EPO) conjugate that includes three poly(ethylene glycol) (PEG) moieties from other EPO conjugates that include 0, 1, 2, 4, 5, 6 or 7 PEG moieties. In addition, HIC can be used to separate polypeptide conjugates that include the same number of poly(alkylene oxide) moieties, but wherein the polypeptide conjugates have a different glycosylation pattern.
- In addition to hydrophobic interaction chromatography, the methods of the invention may further employ additional chromatographic steps. In one embodiment, the method includes anion exchange or mixed-mode chromatography in addition to HIC. In another embodiment, the method includes cation exchange chromatography in addition to HIC. In yet another embodiment, the method includes both, anion exchange or mixed-mode chromatography and cation exchange chromatography in addition to HIC. In a further embodiment, the method includes hydroxyapatite or fluoroapatite chromatography in addition to HIC. The chromatographic steps employed in the methods of the invention can be performed in any desired order. In one embodiment, anion exchange or mixed-mode chromatography is performed prior to hydrophobic interaction chromatography. In another embodiment, anion exchange or mixed-mode chromatography is performed after hydrophobic interaction chromatography. In yet another embodiment, cation exchange chromatography is performed prior to hydrophobic interaction chromatography. In a further embodiment, cation exchange chromatography is performed after hydrophobic interaction chromatography. In one embodiment, hydroxyapatite or fluoroapatite chromatography is performed prior to HIC. In another embodiment, hydroxyapatite or fluoroapatite chromatography is performed after HIC.
- Hence, in a first aspect, the invention provides a method of making a composition that includes a first polypeptide conjugate, wherein the first polypeptide conjugate includes a first number of poly(alkylene oxide) moieties covalently linked to a first polypeptide. The method includes: (a) contacting a mixture containing the first polypeptide conjugate with a hydrophobic interaction chromatography (HIC) medium; and (b) eluting the first polypeptide conjugate from the HIC medium. The method may further include: (c) eluting the first polypeptide conjugate from an anion exchange or mixed-mode chromatography medium. In one embodiment, step (c) is performed prior to step (a). In another embodiment, step (c) is performed after step (b). The method may further include: (d) eluting the first polypeptide conjugate from a cation exchange chromatography medium. In one embodiment, step (d) is performed prior to step (a). In another embodiment, step (d) is performed after step (b).
- In one embodiment according to this aspect, the mixture includes additional polypeptide conjugates, from which the first polypeptide conjugate is isolated. In an exemplary embodiment, the mixture includes a second polypeptide conjugate, wherein the second polypeptide conjugate has a second number of poly(alkylene oxide) moieties covalently linked to a second polypeptide. In one example, the first polypeptide and the second polypeptide have the same amino acid sequence. In another example, the first polypeptide and the second polypeptide have a different amino acid sequence. In one example, the first number and the second number are different, which means that the first polypeptide conjugate and the second polypeptide conjugate are distinguished by the number of poly(alkylene oxide) moieties that are linked to each polypeptide. For example, the first polypeptide conjugate includes 3 poly(alkylene oxide) moieties, while the second polypeptide conjugate includes either 0, 1, 2 or 4 poly(alkylene oxide) moieties. In one particular example, the first polypeptide and the second polypeptide have the same amino acid sequence and the first polypeptide conjugate and the second polypeptide conjugate are distinguished by a different number of poly(alkylene oxide) moieties (first number and second number are different).
- In one example, according to any of the above embodiments, the method of the invention is useful to provide a composition including a first polypeptide conjugate, wherein the concentration of the second polypeptide conjugate in this composition is less than about 30%, less than about 25%, less than about 20%, less than about 15% and preferably less than about 10%, less than about 9%, less than about 8%, less than about 7%, less than about 6%, less than about 5%, less than about 4%, less than about 3%, less than about 2% or less than about 1%. In another embodiment, the mixture includes more than one glycoform of the first polypeptide conjugate and the method provides a composition, in which the combined concentration of all glycoforms having a structure distinct from the first polypeptide conjugate is less than about 30%, less than about 25%, less than about 20%, less than about 15% and preferably less than about 10%, less than about 9%, less than about 8%, less than about 7%, less than about 6%, less than about 5%, less than about 4%, less than about 3%, less than about 2% or less than about 1%.
- In one example according to any of the above embodiments, the first polypeptide is a glycopeptide and comprises a first glycosylation pattern that includes at least one glycan residue covalently linked to the first polypeptide. Each glycan residue can be linked to at least one polymeric modifying group, such as a poly(alkylene oxide) moiety. In another example according to the above embodiments, the first polypeptide includes a first number of poly(alkylene oxide) moieties, each of which is covalently linked to the first polypeptide via an N-linked or O-linked glycan.
- In yet another embodiment, the method of the invention is useful to separate two polypeptide glycoforms that may include the same number of modifying groups, but that have different glycosylation patterns. Hence, in one example, the mixture from which the first polypeptide is isolated, includes a third polypeptide conjugate that includes a third number of poly(alkylene oxide) moieties. In one example, the third polypeptide conjugate and the first polypeptide conjugate include the same number of poly(alkylene oxide) moieties, but the third polypeptide has a glycosylation pattern that differs from the glycosylation pattern of the first polypeptide conjugate by at least one glycosyl moiety. For example, the third polypeptide conjugate includes a glycan residue that is not present in the first polypeptide conjugate. In an exemplary embodiment, the third polypeptide includes an O-linked glycan, while the first polypeptide includes only N-linked glycans (see, e.g.,
FIG. 3B , tri-PEGylated EPO structures). In another exemplary embodiment, the third polypeptide includes a truncated glycan residue, while the corresponding glycan residue of the first polypeptide conjugate is intact (i.e., includes a larger number of glycosyl moieties). - In a second aspect, the invention provides a method of isolating a first polypeptide conjugate including a first number of poly(alkylene oxide) moieties covalently linked to a first polypeptide, from a second polypeptide conjugate that includes a second number of poly(alkylene oxide) moieties covalently linked to a second polypeptide. The method includes: (a) contacting a mixture containing the first polypeptide conjugate and the second polypeptide conjugate with a hydrophobic interaction chromatography (HIC) medium; and (b) eluting the first polypeptide conjugate from said hydrophobic interaction chromatography medium. The method may further include: (c) eluting the first polypeptide conjugate from an anion exchange chromatography medium. In one embodiment step (c) is performed prior to step (a). In another embodiment, step (c) is performed after step (b). The method may further include: (d) eluting the first polypeptide conjugate from a cation exchange chromatography medium. In one embodiment, step (d) is performed prior to step (a). In another embodiment, step (d) is performed after step (b).
- In one example according to any of the above embodiments, the first number of poly(alkylene oxide) moieties that are linked to the first polypeptide is selected from 1 to about 40. In another example, the first number is selected from 1 to about 30. In yet another example, the first number is selected from 1 to about 20. In a further example, the first number is selected from 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9 and about 10. In another example, the first polypeptide conjugate includes exactly three poly(alkylene oxide) moieties.
- In one example according to any of the above embodiments, the second number of poly(alkylene oxide) moieties that are linked to the second polypeptide is selected from 0 to about 40. In another example, the second number is selected from 0 to about 30. In yet another example, the second number is selected from 0 to about 20. In a further example, the second number is selected from 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9 and about 10. In another example, the first number and the second number are different. For example, the first polypeptide conjugate includes 3 poly(alkylene oxide) moieties, while the second polypeptide conjugate includes either 0, 1, 2 or 4 poly(alkylene oxide) moieties. One of skill will understand that a polypeptide that is not linked to a poly(alkylene oxide) moiety (second number=0), represents unreacted polypeptide and is not technically a conjugate unless it contains other modifying groups.
- In one example according to any of the above embodiments, the first polypeptide and the second polypeptide have the same amino acid sequence. In another example according to any of the above embodiments, the first polypeptide is a therapeutic polypeptide. Exemplary therapeutic polypeptides are described herein, below. In yet another example according to any of the above embodiments, the first polypeptide is EPO. In another example according to any of the above embodiments, both the first polypeptide and the second polypeptide are EPO. In yet another example, both the first polypeptide and the third polypeptide are EPO.
- In one embodiment of the invention, the first polypeptide conjugate is formed by an enzymatically catalyzed glycomodification reaction, during which a modified glycosyl moiety [e.g., a glycosyl moiety modified with at least one poly(alkylene oxide) moiety] is covalently linked to the first polypeptide. Hence, in one example according to any of the above embodiments, the method of the invention may further include: contacting the first polypeptide and a modified glycosyl donor species (e.g., a modified sugar nucleotide) having a glycosyl moiety covalently linked to a polymer (e.g., a poly(alkylene oxide) moiety), in the presence of an enzyme (e.g., a glycosyltransferase), for which the modified glycosyl donor species is a substrate, under conditions sufficient for the enzyme to catalyze the formation of a covalent bond between the glycosyl moiety that is linked to the polymer and the first polypeptide. In one example, the modified glycosyl moiety is a sialic acid (SA) moiety. In one example, the enzyme is a sialyltransferase. In another example, the polymer is PEG (e.g., m-PEG). GlycoPEGylation methods are art-recognized; see for example, WO 03/031464 to DeFrees et al. or WO 04/99231, the disclosures of which are incorporated herein by reference in their entirety.
- In one example according to any of the above embodiments, the method of the invention may further include: recombinantly expressing the first polypeptide in a host cell, such as an insect cell, a mammalian cell (e.g., a CHO cell) or a fungal cell (e.g., yeast cell). In one example, the first polypeptide is expressed in an insect cell line (e.g., a Spodoptera frugiperda cell, e.g., Sf9).
- The first polypeptide may be further modified (e.g., through glycan remodeling) to include a substantially uniform (e.g., insect-specific) glycosylation pattern. The glycosylation pattern of the peptides can be elaborated, trimmed back or otherwise modified by methods utilizing enzymes. The methods of remodeling peptides using enzymes that transfer a sugar donor to an acceptor are discussed in detail in WO 03/031464 to De Frees et al. (published Apr. 17, 2003); U.S. Patent Application 20040137557 (filed Nov. 5, 2002); U.S. Patent Application 20050143292 (filed Nov. 24, 2004) and WO 05/051327 (filed Nov. 24, 2004), each of which is incorporated herein by reference in its entirety.
- Hence, in one embodiment, the method of the invention may further include: contacting the first polypeptide and a glycosyl donor molecule (e.g., a nucleotide sugar) in the presence of an enzyme for which the glycosyl donor molecule is a substrate, under conditions sufficient for the enzyme to form a covalent bond between a glycosyl moiety of the glycosyl donor molecule and the first polypeptide. The polypeptide used as a substrate in this reaction may be glycosylated or non-glycosylated. The enzyme may be a glycosyltransferase, such as a GlcNAc-transferase, a GalNAc-transferase, a Gal-transferase or a sialyltransferase.
- Thus, in one example, the method of the invention includes: contacting a glycosylated or non-glycosylated first polypeptide and a nucleotide-N-acetylglucosamine (GlcNAc) or a nucleotide-N-acetylgalactosamine (GalNAc) molecule in the presence of a N-acetylglucosamine transferase (e.g., GnT1 or GnT2) or a N-acetylgalactosamine transferase, respectively. The reaction mixture may further include a nucleotide galactose (Gal) molecule, and a galactosyl transferase (e.g., GalT1). The components of the reaction mixture are contacted (e.g., in a single reaction vessel or sequentially) under conditions sufficient for the N-acetylglucosamine transferase and the galactosyl transferase to form a glycosylated first polypeptide having at least one glycan residue with a terminal -GlcNAc-Gal moiety or a GalNAc-Gal moiety. That glycan residue is preferably mono-antennary with respect to the newly added GlcNAc-Gal or -GalNAc-Gal moiety. In one embodiment, the GlcNAc-Gal moiety is added to a mannose residue, which is part of a tri-mannosyl motif. In another embodiment, the -GalNAc-Gal moiety is added to a serine or threonine residue of the first polypeptide.
- In a third aspect, the invention provides a method of making a composition that contains a first erythropoietin (EPO) conjugate, wherein the first EPO conjugate includes a first number of poly(alkylene oxide) moieties covalently linked to an EPO polypeptide. The method includes: (a) contacting a mixture containing the first EPO conjugate with an anion exchange medium; (b) eluting the first EPO conjugate from the anion exchange medium, forming a first eluate including the first EPO conjugate; (c) contacting the first eluate with a hydrophobic interaction chromatography (HIC) medium; and (d) eluting the first EPO conjugate from the hydrophobic interaction chromatography medium. The method may further include: (e) eluting the first EPO conjugate from a cation exchange chromatography medium. In one example, step (e) is performed after step (d). In another example, step (e) is performed prior to step (c). The method may further include one or more dilution or diafiltration steps. In one example, diafiltration is used to concentrate and/or exchange the buffer in order to condition the sample for the next process step. For example, the eluate from the HIC step is concentrated and diafiltered into a new buffer system in order to prepare the sample for cation exchange chromatography.
- In one embodiment according to this aspect, the mixture includes additional EPO conjugates, from which the first EPO conjugate is isolated. In an exemplary embodiment, the mixture includes a second EPO conjugate having a second number of poly(alkylene oxide) moieties covalently linked to an EPO polypeptide. In one embodiment, the first number and the second number are different, which means that the first EPO conjugate and the second EPO conjugate are glycoforms distinguished by the number of poly(alkylene oxide) moieties that are linked to each EPO polypeptide. For example, the first EPO conjugate includes 3 poly(alkylene oxide) moieties, while the second EPO conjugate may include 0, 1, 2 or 4 poly(alkylene oxide) moieties. In one example, the method is useful to provide a composition including a first EPO conjugate, wherein the concentration of the second EPO conjugate in this composition is less than about 30%, less than about 25%, less than about 20%, less than about 15% and preferably less than about 10%, less than about 9%, less than about 8%, less than about 7%, less than about 6%, less than about 5%, less than about 4%, less than about 3%, less than about 2% or less than about 1%. In another embodiment, the mixture includes more than one glycoform of the first EPO conjugate and the method provides a composition, in which the combined concentration of all glycoforms having a structure distinct from the structure of the first EPO conjugate is less than about 30%, less than about 25%, less than about 20%, less than about 15% and preferably less than about 10%, less than about 9%, less than about 8%, less than about 7%, less than about 6%, less than about 5%, less than about 4%, less than about 3%, less than about 2% or less than about 1%.
- An exemplary EPO sequence useful in conjunction with any of the above embodiments, is represented by SEQ ID NO:1, which may include at least one mutation (e.g., Arg139 to Ala139, Arg143 to Ala143 and Lys154 to Ala154). In another exemplary embodiment, the EPO conjugates of the invention may include at least one N-linked glycan residue. In one example, the N-linked glycan residue is covalently linked to an amino acid residue selected from Asn24, Asn38 and Asn83 of SEQ ID NO:1. The EPO conjugate may further include an O-linked glycan residue. In one example, the O-linked glycan residue is covalently linked to a serine (e.g., Ser 126) residue of SEQ ID NO:1. Any of the above described glycan residues can optionally be linked to a poly(alkylene oxide) moiety. In one example according to any of the above embodiments, EPO is covalently linked to three poly(alkylene oxide) moieties (e.g., three PEG moieties). In another example according to any of the above embodiments, EPO is covalently linked to three poly(alkylene oxide) moieties (e.g., PEG), wherein at least two of the three poly(alkylene oxide) moieties are covalently linked to the EPO polypeptide via N-linked glycans. In one example, at least one N-linked glycan is mono-antennary. In another example, all three N-linked glycans are mono-antennary (e.g., as shown in
FIG. 3A ). Exemplary tri-PEGylated EPO conjugates are shown inFIG. 3B . - In one embodiment, the EPO conjugate is formed by an enzymatically catalyzed glycomodification reaction, wherein a modified glycosyl moiety (e.g., a glycosyl moiety modified with at least one poly(alkylene oxide) moiety) is attached to the EPO polypeptide. Hence, in one example according to any of the above embodiments, the method of the invention may further include: contacting an EPO polypeptide and a modified glycosyl donor species (e.g., a modified sugar nucleotide) having a glycosyl moiety covalently linked to a polymer (e.g., a poly(alkylene oxide) moiety), in the presence of an enzyme (e.g., a glycosyltransferase), for which the modified glycosyl donor species is a substrate, under conditions sufficient for the enzyme to catalyze the formation of a covalent bond between the glycosyl moiety that is linked to the polymer and the EPO polypeptide. In one example, the modified glycosyl moiety is a sialic acid (SA) moiety. In another example, the enzyme is a sialyltransferase. The method may further include: recombinantly expressing the EPO polypeptide in a host cell, such as a bacterial (e.g., E. coli), an insect cell, a mammalian cell (e.g., CHO) cell or a fungal cell. In one example, the EPO polypeptide is expressed in an insect cell line (e.g., Sf9) and is optionally purified from insect cell culture, e.g., according to the methods outlined in WO 06/105426 to Kang et al.
- The EPO peptide may be further modified through glycan remodeling to include a substantially uniform (e.g., insect-specific) glycosylation pattern. Hence, in one embodiment, the method of the invention may further include: contacting (e.g., in a single reaction vessel) a glycosylated EPO polypeptide with a nucleotide-N-acetylglucosamine (GlcNAc) molecule and a nucleotide galactose (Gal) molecule in the presence of a N-acetylglucosamine transferase (e.g., GnT1 or GnT2), and a galactosyl transferase (e.g., GalT1), under conditions sufficient for said N-acetylglucosamine transferase and said galactosyl transferase to form a glycosylated EPO polypeptide having at least one glycan residue with a terminal -GlcNAc-Gal moiety. That glycan residue is preferably mono-antennary with respect to the newly added GlcNAc-Gal moiety. In one embodiment, the -GlcNAc-Gal moiety is added to a mannose residue, which is part of a tri-mannosyl motive.
- In one example according to any of the above embodiments, each poly(alkylene oxide) moiety is a member independently selected from poly(ethylene glycol) (e.g., m-PEG) and poly(propylene glycol) (e.g., m-PPG). Exemplary poly(ethylene glycol) moieties are described herein, below. In another example according to any of the above embodiments, each poly(alkylene oxide) moiety has an independently selected molecular weight between about 1 kDa and about 200 kDa. Additional molecular weight ranges for poly(alkylene oxide) moieties are given herein, below.
- In one example according to any of the above embodiments, the first polypeptide conjugate includes at least one poly(alkylene oxide) moiety that is covalently linked to the first polypeptide via a glycosyl linking group. In one example, the glycosyl linking group is covalently linked to an amino acid residue of the first polypeptide. In another example, the glycosyl linking group is covalently linked to a glycosyl moiety of said first polypeptide. In yet another example, the glycosyl linking group is an intact glycosyl linking group. Exemplary glycosyl linking groups are described herein and, for example, in WO 03/031464 to DeFrees et al., WO 04/99231, and PCT/U.S.07/74139 filed Jul. 23, 2007, the disclosures of which are incorporated herein by reference in their entirety. Exemplary intact glycosyl linking groups include sialic acid moieties, GlcNH and GlcNAc moieties, as well as Gal, GalNH and GalNAc moieties.
- Exemplary HIC media that are useful in any of the above described embodiments, include butyl and phenyl resins, such as
Phenyl 650S (e.g., ToyoPearl). Hydrophobic interaction chromatography and suitable HIC media are described herein below and, for example in Process Scale Bioseparations for the Biopharmaceutical Industry, Ed. Shukla A A, Etzel M R, Gadam S, CRC Press Taylor & Francis Group (2007), pages 197-206, the disclosure of which is incorporated herein by reference. - Those of skill in the art will appreciate that the methods of the invention can be practiced for polypeptide conjugates based on a wide variety of polypeptides. The methods are not limited to a particular polypeptide. Hence, any of the above described embodiments of the invention can be practiced with any of the below described polypeptide conjugates.
- The polypeptide conjugates isolated by the methods of the invention include a polypeptide and at least one modifying group covalently linked to the polypeptide, e.g., via a glycosyl linking group. Exemplary polypeptide conjugates are discussed herein below and, for example WO 03/031464 to DeFrees et al., WO 04/99231 to DeFrees et al., and WO 04/33651 to DeFrees et al., the disclosures of which are incorporated herein by reference in their entirety.
- The polypeptide that is part of polypeptide conjugates of the invention can be any glycosylated or non-glycosylated polypeptide. In one embodiment, the polypeptide is a recombinant polypeptide. In one example according to this embodiment, the polypeptide is expressed in a host cell selected from bacterial cells (e.g., E. coli), insect cells (e.g., Spodoptera frugiperda cells), fungal cells (e.g., yeast cells), mammalian cells (e.g., CHO cells) and bacterial cells (e.g., E. coli cells). Methods for the expression of polypeptides in insect cell lines are discussed herein below. In another embodiment, the polypeptide is chemically synthesized and optionally includes non-natural amino acids.
- The polypeptide can have any number of amino acids. In one embodiment, the peptide or glycopeptide has a molecular weight of about 5 kDa to about 500 kDa. In another embodiment, the peptide or glycopeptide has a molecular weight of about 10 kDa to about 100 kDa. In yet another embodiment, the polypeptide has a molecular weight of about 10 kDa to about 30 kDa. In a further embodiment, the polypeptide has a molecular weight of about 20 kDa to about 25 kDa.
- Exemplary polypeptides include wild-type polypeptides and fragments thereof as well as polypeptides, which are modified from their naturally occurring counterpart (e.g., by mutation or truncation). A polypeptide may also be a fusion protein. Exemplary fusion proteins include those, in which the polypeptide is fused to a fluorescent protein (e.g., GFP), a therapeutic polypeptide, an antibody, a receptor ligand, a proteinaceous toxin, MBP, a Histag and the like.
- In one embodiment, the polypeptide is a therapeutic polypeptide (i.e., authorized drug), such as those currently used as pharmaceutical agents. A non-limiting selection of polypeptides is shown in FIG. 28 of U.S. patent application Ser. No. 10/552,896 filed Jun. 8, 2006, which is incorporated herein by reference.
- Exemplary polypeptides include growth factors, such as fibroblast growth factors (e.g., FGF-1, FGF-2, FGF-3, FGF-4, FGF-5, FGF-6, FGF-7, FGF-8, FGF-9, FGF-10, FGF-11, FGF-12, FGF-13, FGF-14, FGF-15, FGF-16, FGF-17, FGF-18, FGF-19, FGF-20, FGF-21, FGF-22 and FGF-23), blood coagulation factors (e.g., Factor V, Factor VII, Factor VIII, B-domain deleted Factor VIII, partial B-domain deleted Factor VIII, vWF-Factor VIII fusion (e.g., with full-length or B-domain deleted Factor VIII), Factor IX, Factor X and Factor XIII), hormones, such as human growth hormone (hGH) and follicle stimulating hormone (FSH), as well as cytokines, such as interleukins (e.g., IL-1, IL-2, IL-12) and interferons (e.g., INF-alpha, INF-beta, INF-gamma).
- Other exemplary polypeptides include enzymes, such as glucocerebrosidase, alpha-galactosidase (e.g., Fabrazyme™), acid-alpha-glucosidase (acid maltase), alpha-L-iduronidase (e.g., Aldurazyme™), thyroid peroxidase (TPO), beta-glucosidase (see e.g., enzymes described in U.S. patent application Ser. No. 10/411,044), and alpha-galactosidase A (see e.g., enzymes described in U.S. Pat. No. 7,125,843).
- Other exemplary parent polypeptides include bone morphogenetic proteins (e.g., BMP-1, BMP-2, BMP-3, BMP-4, BMP-5, BMP-6, BMP-7, BMP-8, BMP-9, BMP-10, BMP-11, BMP-12, BMP-13, BMP-14, BMP-15), neurotrophins (e.g., NT-3, NT-4, NT-5), erythropoietins (EPO), growth differentiation factors (e.g., GDF-5), glial cell line-derived neurotrophic factor (GDNF), brain derived neurotrophic factor (BDNF), nerve growth factor (NGF), von Willebrand factor (vWF), vWF protease, granulocyte colony stimulating factor (G-CSF), granulocyte-macrophage colony stimulating factor (GM-CSF), α1-antitrypsin (ATT, or α-1 protease inhibitor), tissue-type plasminogen activator (TPA), hirudin, leptin, urokinase, human DNase, insulin, hepatitis B surface protein (HbsAg), human chorionic gonadotropin (hCG), chimeric diphtheria toxin-IL-2, glucagon-like peptides (e.g., GLP-1 and GLP-2), anti-thrombin III (AT-III), prokinetisin, CD4, α-CD20, tumor necrosis factor receptor (TNF-R), P-selectin glycoprotein ligand-1 (PSGL-1), complement, transferrin, glycosylation-dependent cell adhesion molecule (GlyCAM), neural-cell adhesion molecule (N-CAM), TNF receptor-IgG Fc region fusion protein and extendin-4. Exemplary amino acid sequences for some of the above listed polypeptides are described in U.S. Pat. No. 7,214,660, all of which are incorporated herein by reference.
- In an exemplary embodiment, the polypeptide is EPO comprising the amino acid sequence of (SEQ ID NO:1), which is shown below:
-
Ala Pro Pro Arg Leu Ile Cys Asp Ser Arg Val Leu Glu Arg Tyr Leu Leu Glu Ala Lys Glu Ala Glu Ile Thr Thr Gly Cys Ala Glu His Cys Ser Leu Asn Glu Asn 38 Ile Thr Val Pro Asp Thr Lys Val Asn Phe Tyr Ala Trp Lys Arg Met Glu Val Gly Gln Gln Ala Val Glu Val Trp Gln Gly Leu Ala Leu Leu Ser Glu Ala Val Leu Arg Gly Gln Ala Leu Leu Val Asn 83 Ser Ser Gln Pro Trp Glu Pro Leu Gln Leu His Val Asp Lys Ala Val Ser Gly Leu Arg Ser Leu Thr Thr Leu Leu Arg Ala Leu Gly Ala Gln Lys Glu Ala Ile Ser Pro Pro Asp Ala Ala Ala Ala Pro Leu Arg Thr Ile Thr Ala Asp Thr Phe Arg Lys Leu Phe Arg Val Tyr Ser Asn Phe Leu Arg Gly Lys Leu Lys Leu Tyr Thr Gly Glu Ala Cys Arg Thr Gly Asp - Also within the scope of the invention are polypeptides that are antibodies. The term antibody is meant to include antibody fragments (e.g., Fc domains), single chain antibodies, Lama antibodies, nano-bodies and the like. Also included in the term are antibody-fusion proteins, such as Ig chimeras. Preferred antibodies include humanized, monoclonal antibodies or fragments thereof. All known isotypes of such antibodies are within the scope of the invention. Exemplary antibodies include those to growth factors, such as endothelial growth factor (EGF), vascular endothelial growth factors (e.g., monoclonal antibody to VEGF-A, such as ranibizumab (Lucentis™)) and fibroblast growth factors, such as FGF-7, FGF-21 and FGF-23) and antibodies to their respective receptors. Other exemplary antibodies include anti-TNF-alpha monoclonal antibodies (see e.g., U.S. patent application Ser. No. 10/411,043), TNF receptor-IgG Fc region fusion protein (e.g., Enbrel™), anti-HER2 monoclonal antibodies (e.g., Herceptin™), monoclonal antibodies to protein F of respiratory syncytial virus (e.g., Synagis™), monoclonal antibodies to TNF-α (e.g., Remicade™), monoclonal antibodies to glycoproteins, such as IIb/IIIa (e.g., Reopro™), monoclonal antibodies to CD20 (e.g., Rituxan™), CD4 and alpha-CD3, monoclonal antibodies to PSGL-1 and CEA. Any modified (e.g., mutated) version of any of the above listed polypeptides is also within the scope of the invention.
- In one embodiment, the polypeptide is expressed in insect cells. Insect cells suitable for use in the present invention are from any order of the class Insecta which can be hosts to recombinant viruses (e.g. baculovirus) or wild-type viruses, and which can grow and produce recombinant peptide products upon infection with the virus in a medium composition of the invention. In an exemplary embodiment, the cells are from the Diptera or Lepidoptera orders. Preferred are insect cell lines that can be used to produce polypeptides having a substantially uniform, insect-specific glycosylation pattern. In one embodiment, the polypeptide is expressed by a stably transfected cell.
- About 300 insect species have been reported to have nuclear polyhedrosis virus (NPV) diseases, the majority (243) of which were isolated from Lepidoptera (see e.g., Weiss et al., Cell Culture Methods for Large-Scale Propagation of Baculoviruses, In Granados et al. (eds.), The Biology of Baculoviruses: Vol. II Practical Application for Insect Control, pp. 63-87 at p. 64 (1986)). Insect cell lines derived from the following insects are exemplary: Carpocapsa pomonella (preferably cell line CP-128); Trichoplusia ni (preferably cell line TN-368); Autographa californica; Spodoptera frugiperda (preferably cell line Sf9); Lymantria dispar; Mamestra brassicae; Aedes albopictus; Orgyia pseudotsugata; Neodiprion sertifer; Aedes aegypti; Antheraea eucalypti; Gnorimoschema opercullela; Galleria mellonella; Spodoptera littoralis; Drosophila melanogaster, Heliothis zea; Spodoptera exigua; Rachiplusia ou; Plodia interpunctella; Amsacta moorei; Agrotis c-nitrum, Adoxophyes orana, Agrotis segetum, Bombyx mori, Hyponomeuta malinellus, Colias eurytheme, Anticarsia gemmetalis, Apanteles melanoscelus, Arctia caja, and Lymantria dispar.
- In an exemplary embodiment, the insect cells are from Spodoptera frugiperda, and in another exemplary embodiment, the cell line is Sf9 (ATCC CRL 1711). Sf9, Sf21, and High-Five insect cells are commonly used for baculovirus expression. Sf9 and Sf21 are ovarian cell lines from Spodoptera frugiperda. High-Five cells are egg cells from Trichoplusia ni. Sf9, Sf21 and High-Five cell lines may be grown at room temperature (e.g. 25 to 27° C.), and do not require CO2 incubators. Their doubling time is between about 18 and 24 hours. The insect cell lines cultured to produce the peptides and glycopeptides of the invention are preferably those suitable for the reproduction of numerous insect-pathogenic viruses such as picornaviruses, parvoviruses, entomopox viruses, baculoviruses and rhabdoviruses. In an exemplary embodiment, nucleopolyhedrosis viruses (NPV) and granulosis viruses (GV) from the group of baculoviruses are preferred.
- Baculoviruses are characterized by rod-shaped virus particles which are generally occluded in occlusion bodies (also called polyhedra). The family Baculoviridae can be divided in two subfamilies: the Eubaculovirinae comprising two genera of occluded viruses; nuclear polyhedrosis virus (NPV) and granulosis virus (GV), and the subfamily Nudobaculovirinae comprising the nonoccluded viruses.
- Methods of preparing and using virus expression systems are generally known in the art. For example, with respect to baculovirus systems, representative references include U.S. Pat. No. 5,194,376, U.S. Pat. No. 5,147,788, U.S. Pat. No. 4,879,236 and Bedard C. et al. (1994) Cytotechnology 15:129-138; Hink W T et al., (1991) Biotechnology Progress 7:9-14; Licari P. et al., (1992) Biotechnology and Bioengineering 39:614-618, each of which is incorporated herein by reference in its entirety. The incorporation of a desired nucleic acid into a baculovirus expression vector may be accomplished using techniques that are well known in the art. For example, such techniques are described in, Sambrook et al. (Third Edition, 2001, Molecular Cloning: A Laboratory Manual, Cold Spring Harbor Laboratory, New York), and in Ausubel et al. (1997), Current Protocols in Molecular Biology, John Wiley & Sons, New York).
- In one embodiment, the polypeptide expressed in any suitable expression system, is isolated from cell culture before the polypeptide is modified with a modifying group. In one example, the polypeptide is first removed from the cell culture medium, cellular debris and other particles and is then further purified to remove contaminants, such as viral particles and unwanted proteins, using a variety of filtration and chromatographic purification devices. Polypeptide purification techniques are known. See, e.g., Protein Purification Methods, A Practical Approach, Ed. Harris E L V, Angal S, IRL Press Oxford, England (1989), Protein Purification, Ed. Janson J C, Ryden L, VCH-Verlag, Weinheim, Germany (1989), Process Scale Bioseparations for the Biopharmaceutical Industry, Ed. Shukla A A, Etzel M R, Gadam S, CRC Press Taylor & Francis Group (2007), and Protein Purification, Principles, High Resolution Methods and Applications (2nd Edition 1998), Ed. Janson J-C and Ryden L. Exemplary methods for the isolation of polypeptides expressed in insect cells are also disclosed in WO 06/105426 to Kang et al.
- The modifying group of the invention can be any chemical moiety. Exemplary modifying groups are discussed below.
- In one embodiment, the modifying group is a linear or branched polymeric modifying group (polymer). A polymeric modifying group includes at least one polymeric moiety, wherein each polymeric moiety is independently selected. In another embodiment, the polymeric modifying group is water-soluble. A water-soluble polymeric modifying group includes at least one polar group. Exemplary polar groups, include polyether groups, hydroxyl groups and carboxylic acid groups.
- Many water-soluble polymers are known to those of skill in the art and are useful in practicing the present invention. The term water-soluble polymer encompasses species such as saccharides (e.g., dextran, amylose, hyalouronic acid, poly(sialic acid), heparans, heparins, etc.); poly(amino acids), e.g., poly(aspartic acid) and poly(glutamic acid); nucleic acids; synthetic polymers (e.g., poly(acrylic acid), poly(alkylene oxides), peptides, proteins, and the like. In a preferred embodiment, the polymer is a poly(alkylene oxide), such as a poly(ethylene glycol) or a polypropylene glycol.
- In one example, the water-soluble polymer is polyethylene glycol (PEG) or a PEG analog, e.g., methoxy-poly(ethylene glycol) (m-PEG). In another example, the water-soluble polymer is polypropylene glycol (PPG), e.g., methoxy-polypropylene glycol (m-PPG). PEG is frequently used to modify the properties of polypeptides, such as therapeutic proteins. For example, the in vivo half-life of therapeutic glycopeptides can be enhanced with PEG moieties. Chemical modification of polypeptides with PEG (PEGylation) increases their molecular size and typically decreases surface- and functional group-accessibility, each of which are dependent on the number and size of the PEG moieties attached to the polypeptide. Frequently, this modification results in an improvement of plasma half-live and in proteolytic-stability, as well as a decrease in immunogenicity and hepatic uptake (Chaffee et al. J. Clin. Invest. 89: 1643-1651 (1992); Pyatak et al. Res. Commun. Chem. Pathol Pharmacol. 29: 113-127 (1980)). For example, PEGylation of interleukin-2 has been reported to increase its antitumor potency in vivo (Katre et al. Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA. 84: 1487-1491 (1987)) and PEGylation of a F(ab′)2 derived from the monoclonal antibody A7 has improved its tumor localization (Kitamura et al. Biochem. Biophys. Res. Commun. 28: 1387-1394 (1990)). Thus, in another embodiment, the in vivo half-life of a polypeptide derivatized with a PEG moiety by a method of the invention is increased relative to the in vivo half-life of the non-derivatized parent polypeptide.
- The poly(ethylene glycol) or poly(propylene glycol) is not restricted to any particular form or molecular weight range. The size of these modifying groups may, for example, depend on the nature and size of the polypeptide to which they are attached and the properties desired for the modified polypeptide. For unbranched poly(ethylene glycol) or poly(propylene glycol) molecules the molecular weight is preferably between about 0.5 kDa and about 500 kDa. Branched polymers may be larger than 500 kDa. In one embodiment, branched poly(ethylene glycol) or poly(propylene glycol) have a molecular weight from about 0.5 kDa to about 1000 kDa.
- In an exemplary embodiment, the PEG or PPG molecule of use in the invention (branched or unbranched) has a molecular weight selected from about 0.5 kDa, 1 kDa, about 2 kDa, about 5 kDa, about 10 kDa, about 15 kDa, about 20 kDa, about 25 kDa, about 30 kDa, about 35 kDa, about 40 kDa, about 45 kDa, about 50 kDa, about 55 kDa, about 60 kDa, about 65 kDa, about 70 kDa, about 75 kDa, about 80 kDa, about 85 kDa, about 90 kDa, about 95 kDa, about 100 kDa, about 105 kDa, about 110 kDa, about 115 kDa, about 120 kDa, about 125 kDa, about 130 kDa, about 135 kDa, about 140 kDa, about 145 kDa, about 150 kDa, about 155 kDa, about 160 kDa, about 165 kDa, about 170 kDa, about 175 kDa, about 180 kDa, about 185 kDa, about 190 kDa, about 195 kDa and about 400 kDa.
- In one embodiment, the polypeptide is EPO. In another embodiment, the EPO peptide has at least two, and preferably three poly(ethylene glycol) moieties covalently linked thereto. In one example according to this embodiment, each PEG molecule linked to the EPO peptide has a molecular weight from about 2 kDa to about 80 kDa, preferably from about 5 kDa to about 60 kDa and more preferably from about 10 kDa to about 40 kDa.
- Exemplary water-soluble polymers are those in which a substantial proportion of the polymer molecules in a sample of the polymer are of approximately the same molecular weight; such polymers are “homodisperse.”
- The following discussion of polymers including PEG moieties is for clarity of illustration. Those of skill will appreciate that the focus in the sections that follow and the various motifs set forth using PEG as an exemplary polymer are equally applicable to species in which a polymer other than PEG (e.g., another poly(alkylene oxide)) is utilized.
- Exemplary poly(ethylene glycol) molecules of use in the invention include, but are not limited to, those having the formula:
- in which R8 is H, OH, NH2, substituted or unsubstituted alkyl, substituted or unsubstituted aryl, substituted or unsubstituted heteroaryl, substituted or unsubstituted heterocycloalkyl, substituted or unsubstituted heteroalkyl, e.g., acetal, OHC—, H2N—(CH2)q—, HS—(CH2)q, or —(CH2)qC(Y)Z1. The index “e” represents an integer from 1 to 2500. The indices b, d, and q independently represent integers from 0 to 20. The symbols Z and Z1 independently represent OH, NH2, leaving groups, e.g., imidazole, p-nitrophenyl, HOBT, tetrazole, halide, S—R9, the alcohol portion of activated esters; —(CH2)pC(Y1)V, or —(CH2)pU(CH2)sC(Y1)v. The symbol Y represents H(2), ═O, ═S, ═N—R10. The symbols X, Y, Y1, A1, and U independently represent the moieties O, S, N—R″. The symbol V represents OH, NH2, halogen, S—R12, the alcohol component of activated esters, the amine component of activated amides, sugar-nucleotides, and proteins. The indices p, q, s and v are members independently selected from the integers from 0 to 20. The symbols R9, R10, R11 and R12 independently represent H, substituted or unsubstituted alkyl, substituted or unsubstituted heteroalkyl, substituted or unsubstituted aryl, substituted or unsubstituted heterocycloalkyl and substituted or unsubstituted heteroaryl.
- The poly(ethylene glycol) useful in forming the conjugate of the invention is either linear or branched. Branched poly(ethylene glycol) molecules suitable for use in the invention include, but are not limited to those described by the following formula:
- in which R8 and R8′ are members independently selected from the groups defined for R8, above. A1 and A2 are members independently selected from the groups defined for A1, above. The indices e, f, o, and q are as described above. Z and Y are as described above. X1 and X1′ are members independently selected from S, SC(O)NH, HNC(O)S, SC(O)O, O, NH, NHC(O), (O)CNH and NHC(O)O, OC(O)NH.
- In other exemplary embodiments, the branched PEG is based upon a cysteine, serine or di-lysine core. In another exemplary embodiments, the poly(ethylene glycol) molecule is selected from the following structures:
- In a further embodiment the poly(ethylene glycol) is a branched PEG having more than one PEG moiety attached. Examples of branched PEGs are described in U.S. Pat. No. 5,932,462; U.S. Pat. No. 5,342,940; U.S. Pat. No. 5,643,575; U.S. Pat. No. 5,919,455; U.S. Pat. No. 6,113,906; U.S. Pat. No. 5,183,660; WO 02/09766; Kodera Y., Bioconjugate Chemistry 5: 283-288 (1994); and Yamasaki et al., Agric. Biol. Chem., 52: 2125-2127, 1998. In a preferred embodiment the molecular weight of each poly(ethylene glycol) of the branched PEG is less than or equal to 40,000 daltons.
- Representative polymeric modifying moieties include structures that are based on side chain-containing amino acids, e.g., serine, cysteine, lysine, and small peptides, e.g., lys-lys. Exemplary structures include:
- Those of skill will appreciate that the free amine in the di-lysine structures can also be pegylated through an amide or urethane bond with a PEG moiety.
- In yet another embodiment, the polymeric modifying moiety is a branched PEG moiety that is based upon a tri-lysine peptide. The tri-lysine can be mono-, di-, tri-, or tetra-PEG-ylated. Exemplary species according to this embodiment have the formulae:
- in which the indices e, f and f′ are independently selected integers from 1 to 2500; and the indices q, q′ and q″ are independently selected integers from 1 to 20.
- As will be apparent to those of skill, the branched polymers of use in the invention include variations on the themes set forth above. For example the di-lysine-PEG conjugate shown above can include three polymeric subunits, the third bonded to the α-amine shown as unmodified in the structure above. Similarly, the use of a tri-lysine functionalized with three or four polymeric subunits labeled with the polymeric modifying moiety in a desired manner is within the scope of the invention.
- An exemplary branched modifying group including one or more polymeric moieties (e.g., PEG moieties) includes the formula:
- In one embodiment, the branched polymer species according to this formula are essentially pure water-soluble polymers. C is carbon. X5 is a non-reactive group. In one embodiment, X5 is selected from H, OH and C1-C6 alkyl (e.g., CH3, —CH2CH3) optionally substituted with OH. R16 and R17 are independently selected from non-reactive groups (e.g., H, unsubstituted alkyl, unsubstituted heteroalkyl) and polymeric arms (e.g., PEG). X2 and X4 are linkage fragments that are preferably essentially non-reactive under physiological conditions. X2 and X4 are independently selected. An exemplary linker includes neither aromatic nor ester moieties. Alternatively, these linkages can include one or more moiety that is designed to degrade under physiologically relevant conditions, e.g., esters, disulfides, etc. X2 and X4 join the polymeric arms R16 and R17 to C. Exemplary linkage fragments including X2 and X4 are independently selected and include S, SC(O)NH, HNC(O)S, SC(O)O, O, NH, NHC(O), (O)CNH and NHC(O)O, and OC(O)NH, CH2S, CH2O, CH2CH2O, CH2CH2S, (CH2)oO, (CH2)oS or (CH2)oY′-PEG wherein, Y′ is S, NH, NHC(O), C(O)NH, NHC(O)O, OC(O)NH, or O and o is an integer from 1 to 50. In an exemplary embodiment, the linkage fragments X2 and X4 are different linkage fragments.
- In an exemplary embodiment, the modifying group is derived from a natural or unnatural amino acid, amino acid analog or amino acid mimetic, or a small peptide formed from one or more such species. For example, certain branched polymers found in the polypeptide conjugates of the invention have the formula, wherein La is a linker moiety that links the modifying group to the remainder of the polypeptide conjugate.
- In an exemplary embodiment, La is a linking moiety having the structure:
- in which Xa and Xb are independently selected linkage fragments and L1 is selected from a bond, substituted or unsubstituted alkyl or substituted or unsubstituted heteroalkyl.
- Exemplary species for Xa and Xb include S, SC(O)NH, HNC(O)S, SC(O)O, O, NH, NHC(O), C(O)NH and NHC(O)O, and OC(O)NH.
- In another exemplary embodiment, X4 is a peptide bond to R17, which is an amino acid, di-peptide (e.g., Lys-Lys) or tri-peptide (e.g., Lys-Lys-Lys) in which the alpha-amine moiety(ies) and/or side chain heteroatom(s) are modified with a polymeric modifying moiety.
- In other exemplary embodiments, the polypeptide conjugate includes a moiety selected from the group:
- In each of the formulae above, the indices e and f are independently selected from the integers from 1 to 2500. In further exemplary embodiments, e and f are selected to provide a PEG moiety that is about 1 kDa, 2 kDa, 5 kDa, 10 kDa, 15 kDa, 20 kDa, 25 kDa, 30 kDa, 35 kDa, 40 kDa, 45 kDa, 50 kDa, 55 kDa, 60 kDa, 65 kDa, 70 kDa, 75 kDa and 80 kDa. The symbol Q represents substituted or unsubstituted alkyl (e.g., C1-C6 alkyl, e.g., methyl), substituted or unsubstituted heteroalkyl or H.
- Other branched polymers have structures based on di-lysine (Lys-Lys) peptides, e.g.:
- and tri-lysine peptides (Lys-Lys-Lys), e.g.:
- In each of the figures above, the indices e, f, f′ and f″ represent integers independently selected from 1 to 2500. The indices q, q′ and q″ represent integers independently selected from 1 to 20.
- In another exemplary embodiment, the conjugates of the invention include a formula which is a member selected from:
- wherein Q is a member selected from H and substituted or unsubstituted C1-C6 alkyl. The indices e and f are integers independently selected from 1 to 2500, and the index q is an integer selected from 0 to 20.
- In another exemplary embodiment, the conjugates of the invention include a formula which is a member selected from:
- wherein Q is a member selected from H and substituted or unsubstituted C1-C6 alkyl, preferably Me. The indices e, f and f' are integers independently selected from 1 to 2500, and q and q' are integers independently selected from 1 to 20.
- In another exemplary embodiment, the conjugate of the invention includes a structure according to the following formula:
- wherein the indices m and n are integers independently selected from 0 to 5000. The indices j and k are integers independently selected from 0 to 20. A1, A2, A3, A4, A5, A6, A7, A8, A9, A10 and A11 are members independently selected from H, substituted or unsubstituted alkyl, substituted or unsubstituted heteroalkyl, substituted or unsubstituted aryl, substituted or unsubstituted cycloalkyl, substituted or unsubstituted heterocycloalkyl, substituted or unsubstituted heteroaryl, —NA12A13, —OA12 and —SiA12A13. A12 and A13 are members independently selected from substituted or unsubstituted alkyl, substituted or unsubstituted heteroalkyl, substituted or unsubstituted cycloalkyl, substituted or unsubstituted heterocycloalkyl, substituted or unsubstituted aryl, and substituted or unsubstituted heteroaryl.
- In one embodiment according to the formula above, the branched polymer has a structure according to the following formula:
- In an exemplary embodiment, A1 and A2 are members independently selected from OCH3 and OH.
- In another exemplary embodiment, the linker La is a member selected from aminoglycine derivatives. Exemplary polymeric modifying groups according to this embodiment have a structure according to the following formulae:
- In one example, A1 and A2 are members independently selected from OCH3 and OH. Exemplary polymeric modifying groups according to this example include:
- In each of the above embodiment, wherein the modifying group includes a stereocenter, for example those including an amino acid linker or a glycerol-based linker, the stereocenter can be either racemic or defined. In one embodiment, in which such stereocenter is defined, it has (S) configuration. In another embodiment, the stereocenter has (R) configuration.
- Those of skill in the art will appreciate that one or more of the m-PEG arms of the branched polymer can be replaced by a PEG moiety with a different terminus, e.g., OH, COOH, NH2, C2-C10-alkyl, etc. Moreover, the structures above are readily modified by inserting alkyl linkers (or removing carbon atoms) between the α-carbon atom and the functional group of the side chain. Thus, “homo” derivatives and higher homologues, as well as lower homologues are within the scope of cores for branched PEGs of use in the present invention.
- The linear and branched PEG conjugates set forth herein may be prepared using art-recognized methods. Several reviews and monographs on the functionalization and conjugation of PEG are available. See, for example, Harris, Macronol. Chem. Phys. C25: 325-373 (1985); Scouten, Methods in Enzymology 135: 30-65 (1987); Wong et al., Enzyme Microb. Technol. 14: 866-874 (1992); Delgado et al., Critical Reviews in Therapeutic Drug Carrier Systems 9: 249-304 (1992); Zalipsky, Bioconjugate Chem. 6: 150-165 (1995); and Bhadra, et al., Pharmazie, 57:5-29 (2002). Routes for preparing reactive PEG molecules and forming conjugates using the reactive molecules are known in the art. For example, U.S. Pat. No. 5,672,662, U.S. Pat. No. 6,376,604, WO 99/45964, WO 96/21469, U.S. Pat. No. 5,932,462, U.S. Pat. No. 5,446,090, WO 99/34833, WO 99/14259, U.S. Pat. No. 6,348,558.
- The art-recognized methods of polymer activation set forth above are of use in the context of the present invention in the formation of the branched polymers set forth herein.
- In one embodiment, the modifying group is covalently linked to the polypeptide via a glycosyl linking group. The saccharide component of the modified sugar, when interposed between the polypeptide and a modifying group, becomes a “glycosyl linking group.” In an exemplary embodiment, the glycosyl linking group is formed from a mono- or oligosaccharide that, after modification with a modifying group, is a substrate for an appropriate enzyme, such as a glycosyltransferase. In another exemplary embodiment, the glycosyl linking group is formed from a glycosyl-mimetic moiety. The polypeptide conjugates of the invention can include glycosyl linking groups that are mono- or multi-valent (e.g., antennary structures). Thus, conjugates of the invention include both species in which a modifying group is attached to a polypeptide via a monovalent glycosyl linking group. Also included within the invention are conjugates in which more than one modifying group is attached to a polypeptide via a multivalent linking group. Exemplary linking groups are disclosed in PCT/U.S.07/74139 filed Jul. 23, 2007, the disclosure of which is incorporated by reference herein in its entirety.
- In an exemplary embodiment, the invention provides a method for the isolation of a glycopeptide that is conjugated to a polymeric modifying moiety through an intact glycosyl linking group having a formula that is selected from:
- In Formulae I, R2 is H, CH2OR7, COOR7 or OR7, in which R7 represents H, substituted or unsubstituted alkyl or substituted or unsubstituted heteroalkyl. When COOR7 is a carboxylic acid or carboxylate, both forms are represented by the designation of the single structure COO− or COOH. In Formulae I and II, the symbols R3, R4, R5, R6 and R6′ independently represent H, substituted or unsubstituted alkyl, OR8, NHC(O)R9. The index d is 0 or 1. R8 and R9 are independently selected from H, substituted or unsubstituted alkyl, substituted or unsubstituted heteroalkyl, sialic acid or polysialic acid. At least one of R3, R4, R5, R6 or R6′ includes the polymeric modifying moiety e.g., PEG, linked through a bond or a linking group. In an exemplary embodiment, R6 and R6′, together with the carbon to which they are attached are components of the pyruvyl side chain of sialic acid. In a further exemplary embodiment, this side chain is functionalized with the polymeric modifying moiety. In another exemplary embodiment, R6 and R6′, together with the carbon to which they are attached are components of the side chain of sialic acid and the polymeric modifying moiety is a component of R5.
- In a further exemplary embodiment, the polymeric modifying moiety is bound to the sugar core, generally through a heteroatom, e.g, nitrogen, on the core through a linker, L, as shown below:
- R1 is the polymeric moiety and L is selected from a bond and a linking group. The index w represents an integer selected from 1-6, preferably 1-3 and more preferably 1-2. Exemplary linking groups include substituted or unsubstituted alkyl, substituted or unsubstituted heteroalkyl moieties and sialic acid. An exemplary component of the linker is an acyl moiety.
- An exemplary compound according to the invention has a structure according to Formulae I or II, in which at least one of R2, R3, R4, R5, R6 or R6′ has the formula:
- In another example according to this embodiment at least one of R2, R3, R4, R5, R6 or R6′ has the formula:
- in which s is an integer from 0 to 20 and R1 is a linear polymeric modifying moiety.
- In an exemplary embodiment, the polymeric modifying moiety-linker construct is a branched structure that includes two or more polymeric chains attached to central moiety. In this embodiment, the construct has the formula:
- in which R1 and L are as discussed above and w' is an integer from 2 to 6, preferably from 2 to 4 and more preferably from 2 to 3.
- When L is a bond it is formed between a reactive functional group on a precursor of R1 and a reactive functional group of complementary reactivity on the saccharyl core. When L is a non-zero order linker, a precursor of L can be in place on the glycosyl moiety prior to reaction with the R1 precursor. Alternatively, the precursors of R1 and L can be incorporated into a preformed cassette that is subsequently attached to the glycosyl moiety. As set forth herein, the selection and preparation of precursors with appropriate reactive functional groups is within the ability of those skilled in the art. Moreover, coupling the precursors proceeds by chemistry that is well understood in the art.
- In an exemplary embodiment, L is a linking group that is formed from an amino acid, or small peptide (e.g., 1-4 amino acid residues) providing a modified sugar in which the polymeric modifying moiety is attached through a substituted alkyl linker. Exemplary linkers include glycine, lysine, serine and cysteine. The PEG moiety can be attached to the amine moiety of the linker through an amide or urethane bond. The PEG is linked to the sulfur or oxygen atoms of cysteine and serine through thioether or ether bonds, respectively.
- In an exemplary embodiment, R5 includes the polymeric modifying moiety. In another exemplary embodiment, R5 includes both the polymeric modifying moiety and a linker, L, joining the modifying moiety to the remainder of the molecule. As discussed above, L can be a linear or branched structure. Similarly, the polymeric modifying can be branched or linear.
- In one embodiment, the present invention provides methods for the isolation of an erythropoietin peptide conjugate comprising the moiety:
- wherein D is a member selected from —OH and R1-L-HN—; G is a member selected from H and R1-L- and —C(O)(C1-C6)alkyl; R1 is a moiety comprising a straight-chain or branched poly(ethylene glycol) residue; and L is a linker, e.g., a bond (“zero order”), substituted or unsubstituted alkyl and substituted or unsubstituted heteroalkyl. In exemplary embodiments, when D is OH, G is R1-L-, and when G is C(O)(C1-C6)alkyl, D is R1-L-NH—.
- In another exemplary embodiment, the invention provides a conjugate formed between a modified sugar of the invention and a substrate EPO peptide. In this embodiment, the sugar moiety of the modified sugar becomes a glycosyl linking group interposed between the peptide substrate and the modifying group. An exemplary glycosyl linking group is an intact glycosyl linking group, in which the glycosyl moiety or moieties forming the linking group are not degraded by chemical (e.g., sodium metaperiodate) or enzymatic (e.g., oxidase) processes. Selected conjugates of the invention include a modifying group that is attached to the amine moiety of an amino-saccharide, e.g., mannosamine, glucosamine, galactosamine, sialic acid etc. Exemplary modifying group-intact glycosyl linking group cassettes according to this motif are based on a sialic acid structure, such as those having the formulae:
- In the formulae above, R1 and L are as described above. Further detail about the structure of exemplary R1 groups is provided below.
- In still a further exemplary embodiment, the conjugate is formed between a substrate EPO and a saccharyl moiety in which the modifying group is attached through a linker at the 6-carbon position of the saccharyl moiety. Thus, illustrative conjugates according to this embodiment have the formula:
- in which the radicals are as discussed above. Such saccharyl moieties include, without limitation, glucose, glucosamine, N-acetyl-glucosamine, galactose, galactosamine, N-acetyl-galactosamine, mannose, mannosamine, N-acetyl-mannosamine, and the like.
- Due to the versatility of the methods available for modifying glycosyl residues on a therapeutic peptide such as EPO, the glycosyl structures on the peptide conjugates of the invention can have substantially any structure. Moreover, the glycans can be O-linked or N-linked. As exemplified in the discussion below, each of the pyranose and furanose derivatives discussed above can be a component of a glycosyl moiety of a peptide.
- The invention provides a modified EPO peptide that includes a glycosyl group having the formula:
- In other embodiments, the group has the formula:
- in which the index t is 0 or 1.
- In a still further exemplary embodiment, the group has the formula:
- in which the index t is 0 or 1.
- In yet another embodiment, the group has the formula:
- in which the index p represents and integer from 1 to 10; and a is either 0 or 1.
- In an exemplary embodiment, a glycoPEGylated EPO peptide of the invention includes at least one N-linked glycosyl residue selected from the glycosyl residues set forth below:
- In the formulae above, the index t is 0 or 1 and the index p is an integer from 1 to 10. The symbol R15′ represents H, OH (e.g., Gal-OH), a sialyl moiety, a polymer modified sialyl moiety (i.e., glycosyl linking group-polymeric modifying moiety (Sia-L-R1)) or a sialyl moiety to which is bound a polymer modified sialyl moiety (e.g., Sia-Sia-L-R1) (“Sia-Siap”). An exemplary EPO peptide of the invention will include at least one glycan having a R15′. The oxygen, with the open valence, of Formulae I and II is preferably attached through a glycosidic linkage to a carbon of a Gal or GalNAc moiety. In a further exemplary embodiment, the oxygen is attached to the carbon at
position 3 of a galactose residue. In an exemplary embodiment, the modified sialic acid is linked α2,3- to the galactose residue. In another exemplary embodiment, the sialic acid is linked α2,6- to the galactose residue. - The modified glycan is bound to one or more position selected from
Asn 24,Asn 38,Asn 83 and/orSer 126. In an exemplary embodiment, the EPO is derived from mammalian cells and the modifying group is only on the glycan atAsn 24. In one embodiment according to this motif, the glycosyl linking moiety is linked to a Sia residue through another Sia residue, e.g.: - An exemplary species according to this motif is prepared by conjugating Sia-L-R1 to a terminal sialic acid of the glycan at
Asn 24 using an enzyme that forms Sia-Sia bonds, e.g., CST-II, ST8Sia-II, ST8Sia-III and ST8Sia-IV. - In another exemplary embodiment, the glycans have a formula that is selected from the group:
- and a combination thereof.
- The glycans of this group generally correspond to those found on an EPO peptide that is produced by insect cells (e.g., Sf9), followed by remodeling of the glycan and glycoPEGylation according to the methods set forth herein. For example, insect-derived EPO that is expressed with a tri-mannosyl core is subsequently contacted with a GlcNAc donor and a GlcNAc transferase and a Gal donor and a Gal transferase. Appending GlcNAc and Gal to the tri-mannosyl core is accomplished in either two steps or a single step. A modified sialic acid is added to at least one branch of the glycosyl moiety as discussed herein. Those Gal moieties that are not functionalized with the modified sialic acid are optionally “capped” by reaction with a sialic acid donor in the presence of a sialyl transferase.
- In an exemplary embodiment, at least 60% of terminal Gal moieties in a population of peptides is capped with sialic acid, preferably at least 70%, more preferably, at least 80%, still more preferably at least 90% and even more preferably at least 95%, 96%, 97%, 98% or 99% are capped with sialic acid.
- In each of the formulae above, R15′ is as discussed above. Moreover, an exemplary modified EPO peptide of the invention will include at least one glycan with an R15′ moiety having a structure according to Formulae I or II.
- In another exemplary embodiment, the EPO is derived from insect cells, which are remodeled by adding GlcNAc and Gal to the mannose core. The remodeled peptide is glycopegylated using a sialic acid bearing a linear PEG moiety, affording an EPO peptide that comprises at least one moiety having the formula:
- in which s represents and integer from 1 to 10; and f represents and integer from 1 to 2500.
- In certain embodiments, the EPO peptide includes three such moieties, one attached at each of
Asn 24,Asn 38 andAsn 83. In another embodiment, the peptide includes two such moieties attached at a combination of two of these Asn moieties. There is also provided a composition that is a mixture of these two species (i.e., PEG3 and PEG2). The mixture preferably includes at least 75%, preferably at least 80%, more preferably at least 85%, still more preferably 90% and even more preferably 95%, 96%, 97% or 98% of the species that includes the three modified glycosyl residues. Unmodified terminal Gal residues are optionally capped with Sia as discussed above. In an exemplary embodiment, the peptide is expressed in insect cells, remodeled and glycopegylated. - The indices e and q are as discussed above. In an exemplary embodiment, e for each of the modified glycosyl moieties is an integer that provides as PEG moiety having a molecular weight of approximately 10 kDa.
- The membrane filtration and chromatographic techniques described below are useful steps within the methods of the invention and apply to the isolation of polypeptide conjugates, in which a polypeptide is linked to at least one modifying group, such as a poly(alkylene oxide) moiety. It is to be understood that unless the order of steps is explicitly recited, the exemplary steps can be performed in any desired order.
- In one embodiment, the methods of the invention includes one or more membrane filtration steps. Membrane filtration is a separation technique widely used for clarifying, concentrating, and purifying polypeptides.
- Ultrafiltration Using a Membrane with a Small MWCO
- In one exemplary embodiment, the polypeptide purification process of the present invention includes at least one diafiltration/ultrafiltration step, e.g., as the final process step to generate a composition suitable for storage. In one example, diafiltration/ultrafiltration is performed to condition a mixture for a chromatographic process step. For example, the eluate from a hydrophobic interaction chromatography step is concentrated and the buffer is exchanged to prepare the sample for the next purification step (e.g., cation exchange chromatography).
- In an exemplary embodiment, the diafiltration step is employed to concentrate the sample. In another exemplary embodiment the diafiltration step is employed to alter the buffer. In yet another exemplary embodiment, the new buffer is suitable for storage of the purified polypeptide conjugate. The diafiltration/ultrafiltration membrane can have any molecular weight cuttoff (MWCO) specification.
- In an exemplary embodiment, the feed is passed through an ultrafiltration membrane with a MWCO suitable to concentrate the purified polypeptide conjugate. The selected MWCO will depend on the combined size of the polypeptide and the modifying group, such as the size of a poly(alkylene oxide) moiety covalently linked to the polypeptide. To concentrate a sample, the membrane is chosen to have a MWCO that is substantially lower than the molecular weight of the purified peptide conjugate. In one example, the ultrafiltration membrane is selected to have a MWCO that is 3 to 6 times lower than the molecular weight of the peptide conjugate to be retained by the membrane. If the flow rate or the processing time is of major consideration, selection of a membrane with a MWCO toward the lower end of this range (e.g. 3×) will yield higher flow rates. If recovery of peptide conjugate is the primary concern, a tighter membrane (e.g. 6×) is selected (typically with a slower flow rate).
- In one exemplary embodiment, the diafiltration membrane has a MWCO of about 2 kDa to about 500 kDa. In another exemplary embodiment, the diafiltration membrane has a MWCO of about 5 kDa to about 400 kDa, about 5 kDa to about 300 kDa or about 5 kDa to about 200 kDa. In yet another exemplary embodiment, the diafiltration membrane has a MWCO of about 5 kDa to about 180 kDa, 5 kDa to about 160 kDa, 5 kDa to about 140 kDa, 5 kDa to about 130 kDa, 5 kDa to about 120 kDa, 5 kDa to about 110 kDa, or 5 kDa to 100 kDa. When the polypeptide conjugate is EPO-PEG, the diafiltration membrane has a MWCO of about 5 kDa to about 80 kDa, 5 kDa to about 60 kDa, 5 kDa to about 40 kDa or 5 kDa to about 20 kDa. In one embodiment, when the polypeptide conjugate is EPO-[PEG-10 kDa]3, the diafiltration membrane has a MWCO of about 8 kDa to about 12 kDa and preferably about 10 kDa.
- In another exemplary embodiment, filtration is effected using a transmembrane pressure between about 1 and about 30 psi and a filter membrane with a MWCO of between about 5 kDa to about 15 kDa, and preferably 10 kDa. The filtration step produces a retentate stream and a permeate stream. The retentate may be recycled to a reservoir for the peptide solution feed under conditions of essentially constant peptide concentration in the feed by adding a buffer solution to the retentate.
- The surface area of the filtration membrane used will generally depend on the amount of peptide conjugate to be purified. The membrane may be made of a low-binding material to minimize adsorptive losses and is preferably durable, cleanable, and chemically compatible with the buffers to be used. A number of suitable membranes are commercially available. In an exemplary embodiment, the ultrafiltration/diafiltration membrane is a member selected from cellulose acetate, regenerated cellulose and polyethersulfone. Suitable membranes include those, in which the membrane polymer is chemically modified. In a preferred embodiment, the membrane is regenerated cellulose.
- In one embodiment, the flow rate is adjusted to maintain a constant transmembrane pressure. Generally, filtration will proceed faster with higher pressures and higher flow rates, but higher flow rates may also result in damage to the peptide or loss of peptide due to passage through the membrane. In addition, various devices may have certain pressure limitations on their operation, and the pressure is adjusted according to the manufacturer's specification. In an exemplary embodiment, the pressure is between about 1 to about 30 psi, and in another exemplary embodiment the pressure is between about 8 psi to about 15 psi. Typically, the circulation pump is a peristaltic pump or diaphragm pump in the feed channel and the pressure is controlled by adjusting the retentate valve.
- Subsequent to a filtration step, the retentate is collected. Water or an aqueous buffer (e.g. diafiltration buffer) may be used to wash the membrane filter and recover any peptide retained by the membrane. The wash liquid may be combined with the original retentate containing the concentrated peptide. The retentate is optionally dialyzed against another buffer, such as TRIS or HEPES.
- The purified product is stored at a low temperature. In an exemplary embodiment the product is stored at about −20° C. at a polypeptide concentration of about 1 mg to about 10 mg of peptide conjugate per mL storage buffer. Before storage the product solution maybe sterile filtered, e.g., using a membrane filter having a pore size of about 2 μM (e.g., cellulose acetate filter).
- A variety of recognized chromatographic techniques, such as size exclusion chromatography (gel filtration), ion exchange chromatography, hydrophobic interaction chromatography (HIC), affinity chromatography, mixed-mode chromatography, hydroxyapatite and fluoroapatite chromatography are used for the isolation of polypeptides and proteins. These technologies can also be used to isolate polypeptide conjugates. In an exemplary embodiment, methods of the invention employ a combination of several chromatographic techniques. The order in which these steps are performed is dependent on the nature of the polypeptide conjugate being purified and the nature of the contaminants to be removed.
- Suitable techniques for the practice of the invention separate the polypeptide conjugate of interest from a variety of contaminants on the basis of charge, degree of hydrophobicity, and/or size. Different chromatographic resins and membranes are available for each of these techniques, allowing accurate tailoring of the purification scheme.
- In one chromatographic technique, the components in a mixture interact differently with the column material and move at different rates along the column length, achieving a physical separation that increases as the components pass through the column. In another chromatographic technique, components of the mixture, including the peptide conjugate of interest, adhere selectively to the separation medium, while other components are found in the flow-through. The initially retained components are then eluted differentially by varying the composition of the solvent or buffer system. In another approach, the desired components are found in the flow-through while impurities are retained on the column and thus removed from the mixture.
- In one embodiment, the methods of the invention employ at least one ion exchange chromatography step. Anion and cation exchange chromatography are known in the art. Ion exchange chromatography separates compounds based on their net charge. Ionic molecules are classified as either anions (having a negative charge) or cations (having a positive charge). Some molecules (e.g., proteins) may have both anionic and cationic groups. A positively charged support (anion exchanger) will bind a compound with an overall negative charge. Conversely, a negatively charged support (cation exchanger) will bind a compound with an overall positive charge. Ion exchange matrices can be further categorized as either strong or weak exchangers. Strong ion exchange matrices are charged (ionized) across a wide range of pH levels. Weak ion exchange matrices are ionized within a narrow pH range. The ionic groups of exchange columns are covalently bound to the gel matrix and are compensated by small concentrations of counter ions, which are present in the buffer. The most common ion exchange chemistries include: quaternary ammonium residues (Q) for strong anion exchange, diethylaminoethyl residues (DEAE) for weak anion exchange, sulfopropyl (SP) resins and sulfonic acid (S) resins for strong cation exchange and carboxymethyl residues (CM) for weak cation exchange.
- When adding a sample to the column, an exchange with the weakly bound counter ions takes place. The size of the sample volume in ion exchange chromatography is of secondary importance as long as the initial solvent is of low eluting strength, to not allow the sample components to proceed through the column. Under such conditions, the sample components are preferably collected at the top of the column. When the gradient is begun with the addition of a stronger eluting mobile phase, the sample components begin their separation. If poor separation is observed, it might be improved by a change in the gradient slope. If the polypeptide conjugate does not bind to the column under the selected conditions, the composition and/or the pH of the starting buffer should be changed. The buffer system can further be optimized by choosing different buffer salts since each buffer composition solvates the ion exchanger and the sample components uniquely.
- In one example, any conventional buffer system with a salt concentration of about 5 mM up to about 50 mM can be used for ion exchange chromatography. However, positively charged buffering ions are used for anion exchangers and negatively charged ones are used for cation exchangers. Phosphate buffers are generally used on both exchanger types. Typically, the highest salt concentration that permits binding of the peptide of interest is used as the starting condition. In one example, all buffers are prepared from MilliQ-water and filtered (0.45 or 0.22 μm filter).
- In an exemplary embodiment a sample containing the peptide conjugate of interest is loaded onto an anion exchanger in a loading buffer comprising a salt concentration below the concentration at which the peptide would elute from the column. The pH of the buffer is selected so that the purified peptide is retained on the anion exchange medium. Changing the pH of the buffer alters the charge of the peptide, and lowering the pH value shortens the retention time with anion exchangers. The isoelectric point (pI) of a protein is the pH at which the charge of a protein is zero. Typically, with anion exchangers the pH value of the buffer is kept 1.5 to 2 times higher than the pI value of the peptide of interest. Alternatively, the anion exchange conditions are selected to preferentially bind impurities, while the purified peptide is found in the flow-through.
- The column may be washed with several column volumes (CV) of buffer to remove unbound substances and/or those substances that bind weakly to the resin. Fractions are then eluted from the column using, for example, a saline gradient according to conventional methods. The salt in the solution competes with the protein in binding to the column and the protein is released. Components with weak ionic interactions elute at a lower salt concentration than components with a strong ionic interaction. Sample fractions are collected from the column. Fractions containing high levels of the desired peptide and low levels of impurities are pooled or processed separately.
- In one example, anion exchange used in the process of the current invention is employed to isolate the polypeptide conjugate from contaminants such as particulates, chemicals and proteins/peptides (e.g., enzymes used in a glycoPEGylation reaction).
- Anion exchange media are known to those of skill in the art. Exemplary anion exchange media are described, e.g., in Protein Purification Methods, A Practical Approach, Ed. Harris E L V, Angal S, IRL Press Oxford, England (1989); Protein Purification, Ed. Janson J C, Ryden L, VCH-Verlag, Weinheim, Germany (1989); Process Scale Bioseparations for the Biopharmaceutical Industry, Ed. Shukla A A, Etzel M R, Gadam S, CRC Press Taylor & Francis Group (2007), pages 188-196; Protein Purification Handbook, GE Healthcare 2007 (18-1132-29) and Protein Purification, Principles, High Resolution Methods and Applications (2nd Edition 1998), Ed. Janson J-C and Ryden L, the disclosures of which are incorporated herein by reference in their entirety. An exemplary anion exchanger of the invention is selected from quaternary ammonium filters and DEAE resins. In one embodiment, the anion exchanger is a quaternary ammonium resin (e.g. Mustang Q ion exchange membrane, Pall Corporation). In one example, the anion exchanger is Sartobind Q. Other useful resins include QXL, Capto and BigBeads resins.
- Exemplary anion exchange media are summarized below:
-
ANX Sepharose 4 FF (high sub) -
Poros HQ
Poros HQ - Mustang Q membrane absorber
- Sartobind Q membrane absorber
- In one embodiment, the method of the invention includes at least one cation exchange step. In an exemplary embodiment a sample containing the peptide conjugate of interest is loaded onto a cation exchange resin in a loading buffer comprising a salt concentration below the concentration at which the peptide would elute from the column.
- In one example, the pH of the loading buffer is selected so that the peptide conjugate of interest is retained on the cation exchange resin. Changing the pH of the buffer alters the charge of the peptide and increasing the pH of the buffer shortens the retention times with cation exchangers. Typically, cation exchanges are performed at 1.5 to 2 pH units below the peptide's pI. Alternatively, the cation exchange conditions are selected to preferentially bind impurities, while the purified peptide is found in the flow-through.
- In one embodiment, the column is washed with several column volumes of buffer to remove unbound substances and those substances that bind weakly to the resin. Fractions are then eluted from the column using a salt gradient according to conventional methods. Sample fractions are collected from the column. One or more fraction containing high levels of the desired peptide and low levels of impurities are collected, and optionally pooled.
- In an exemplary embodiment the cation exchangers used in the process of the current invention provide one of the primary purification steps of the purification process. In one embodiment, the cation exchanger removes undesired proteins from the mixture, which contains the peptide conjugate of interest. In another embodiment, the cation exchange step is useful to remove unwanted glycoforms of the purified polypeptide conjugate.
- Cation exchange media are known to those of skill in the art. Exemplary cation exchange media are described, e.g., in Protein Purification Methods, A Practical Approach, Ed. Harris E L V, Angal S, IRL Press Oxford, England (1989); Protein Purification, Ed. Janson J C, Ryden L, VCH-Verlag, Weinheim, Germany (1989); Process Scale Bioseparations for the Biopharmaceutical Industry, Ed. Shukla A A, Etzel M R, Gadam S, CRC Press Taylor & Francis Group (2007), pages 188-196; Protein Purification Handbook, GE Healthcare 2007 (18-1132-29) and Protein Purification, Principles, High Resolution Methods and Applications (2nd Edition 1998), Ed. Janson J-C and Ryden L, the disclosures of which are are incorporated herein by reference in their entirety. In an exemplary embodiment, cation exchange resins of use in the invention are selected from sulfonic acid (S) and carboxymethyl (CM) supports. In one embodiment, the cation exchanger is a sulfonic acid support (e.g. UNOsphereS, Bio-Rad Laboratories) or a sulphopropyl (SP) resin. In another embodiment, the cation exchange resin is selected from SPFF, SPHP sepharose, BigBeads SP, Capto S and the like. In one example, the cation exchanger is
Source 15S. - Exemplary commercial cation exchange media are summarized below:
- Sartobind S membrane absorber
- The ion exchangers used in the methods of the invention are optionally membrane adsorbers rather than chromatographic resins or supports. In an exemplary embodiment, the membrane adsorber is a cation exchanger. In another exemplary embodiment the membrane adsorber is a sulfonic acid (S) cation exchanger (e.g. Sartobind S, Sartorius AG). The membrane adsorber is optionally disposable.
- In one embodiment, the peptide conjugate purification process of the invention includes mixed-mode or pseudo-affinity chromatography.
- In one example, the process involves chromatography performed on ceramic or crystalline apatite media, such as hydroxyapatite (HA) chromatography and fluoroapatite (FA) chromatography. HA and FA chromatography are effective purification mechanisms, providing biomolecule selectivity, complementary to ion exchange and/or hydrophobic interaction techniques. Hydroxyapatite and fluoroapatite chromatography are known in the art. In one example, the apatite medium is Adhere MMC.
- Exemplary hydroxyapatite sorbents of type I and type II are selected from ceramic and crystalline materials. Hydroxyapatite sorbents are available in different particle sizes (
e.g. type 1, Bio-Rad Laboratories). In an exemplary embodiment, the particle size of the hydroxyapatite sorbent is between about 20 μm and about 180 μm, between about 20 μm and about 100 μm or between about 60 μm and about 100 μm. In a particular example, the particle size of the hydroxyapatite sorbent is about 80 μm. - In one embodiment, the hydroxyapatite sorbent is composed of cross-linked agarose beads with microcrystals of hydroxyapatite entrapped in the agarose mesh. Optionally, the agarose is chemically stabilized (e.g. with epichlorohydrin under strongly alkaline conditions). In one exemplary embodiment, the hydroxyapatite sorbent is HA Ultrogel (Pall Corporation).
- Exemplary type I and type II fluoroapatite sorbents are selected from ceramic (e.g., bead-like particles) and crystalline materials. Ceramic fluoroapatite sorbents are available in different particle sizes (
e.g. type 1 andtype 2, Bio-Rad Laboratories). In an exemplary embodiment the particle size of the ceramic fluoroapatite sorbent is from about 20 μm to about 180 μm, preferably about 20 to about 100 μm, more preferably about 20 μm to about 80 μm. In one example, the particle size of the ceramic fluoroapatite medium is about 40 μm (e.g.,type 1 ceramic fluoroapatite). In another example, the fluoroapatite medium includes hydroxyapatite in addition to fluoroapatite. In a particular example, the fluoroapatite medium is Bio-Rad's CFT™ Ceramic Fluoroapatite. - The selection of the flow velocity used for loading the sample onto the hydroxyapatite or fluoroapatite column, as well as the elution flow velocity depends on the type of hydroxyapatite or fluoroapatite sorbent and on the column geometry. In one exemplary embodiment, at process scale, the loading flow velocity is selected from about 30 to about 900 cm/h, from about 150 to about 900 cm/h, preferably from about 500 to about 900 cm/h and, more preferably, from about 600 to about 900 cm/h.
- In an exemplary embodiment, the pH of the elution buffer is selected from about pH 7 to about pH 9, and preferably from about pH 7.5 to about pH 8.0.
- In one aspect the present invention provides a method of purifying a recombinant peptide by hydroxyapatite or fluoroapatite chromatography. The method includes the following steps: (a) desalting a mixture containing the peptide, forming a desalted mixture (e.g. by gel filtration) that has a salt conductivity, which is sufficiently low to increase the peptide-binding capacity of the hydroxyapatite or fluoroapatite resin; (b) applying the desalted mixture to a hydroxyapatite or fluoroapatite resin; (c) washing the hydroxyapatite or fluoroapatite resin, thereby eluting unwanted components from the resin; (d) eluting the peptide from the resin with an elution buffer that optionally contains an amino acid; and (e) collecting one or more eluate fraction containing the peptide.
- In one embodiment, the mixture containing the peptide of interest is desalted prior to subjecting the mixture to HA or fluoroapatite chromatography. The desalting step increases the capacity of the apatite column to bind the peptide of interest. In one embodiment, the apatite column capacity (amount of peptide per liter of resin), increases with decreasing salt conductivity of the load, which contains the peptide.
- In an exemplary embodiment, in which the load is desalted, the mass loading of peptide per liter of HA resin is from about 1 to about 25 g/L, from about 1 to about 20 g/L, preferably from about 1 to about 15 g/L and more preferably from about 1 to about 10 g/L.
- In another exemplary embodiment, the conductivity of the load can be decreased using a method selected from desalting and diluting.
- In an exemplary embodiment, the conductivity of the loading buffer is lowered by desalting and preferred conductivities are from about 0.1 to about 4.0 mS/cm, preferably from about 0.1 to about 1.0 mS/cm, more preferably from about 0.1 to about 0.6 mS/cm and, still more preferably, from about 0.1 to about 0.4 mS/cm.
- In one example, desalting of peptide conjugate solutions is achieved using membrane filters wherein the membrane filter has a MWCO smaller than the peptide/protein of interest. The peptide/protein is found in the retentate and is reconstituted in a buffer of choice. However, when purifying peptides of relatively low molecular weight (e.g. EPO), the MWCO of the membrane used for desalting must be relatively small in order to avoid leaking of the peptide through the membrane pores. However, filtering a large volume of liquid through a small MWCO membrane (e.g. with a pore size of about 5 kDa), typically requires large membrane areas and the filtering process is time consuming.
- Therefore, in one embodiment, desalting of the HA or fluoroapatite chromatography load is accomplished using size-exclusion chromatography (e.g. gel filtration). The technique separates molecules on the basis of size. Typically, high molecular weight components can travel through the column more easily than smaller molecules, since their size prevents them from entering bead pores. Accordingly, low-molecular weight components take longer to pass through the column. Thus, low molecular weight materials, such as unwanted salts, can be separated from the peptide of interest.
- In an exemplary embodiment, the column material is selected from dextran, agarose, and polyacrylamide gels, in which the gels are characterized by different particle sizes. In another exemplary embodiment, the material is selected from rigid, aqueous-compatible size exclusion materials. An exemplary gel filtration resin of the invention is Sepharose G-25 resin (GE Healthcare).
- In an exemplary embodiment, desalting is performed subsequent to cation exchange chromatography (e.g. after
Source 15S chromatography). - In one embodiment, an amino acid is added to the elution buffer, which is used to elute the peptide of interest from the HA or fluoroapatite resin. In an exemplary embodiment the amino acid is added to the elution buffer at a final concentration of about 5 mM to about 50 mM, about 10 mM to about 40 mM, preferably about 15 mM to about 30 mM and, more preferably, about 20 mM.
- In one embodiment, the addition of an amino acid (e.g. glycine) to the elution buffer increases the step recovery of peptide from HA chromatography when compared to the recovery obtained without the addition of an amino acid. In an exemplary embodiment, the recovery of peptide is increased by addition of the amino acid at least about 1% to about 20%, by at least about 1% to about 15%, by at least about 1% to about 10%, preferably by at least about 1% to about 7% and, more preferably, by about 5%.
- In another exemplary embodiment, the addition of an amino acid (e.g. glycine) causes the elution peak of the purified peptide to be sharper. Thus, less peptide is recovered in the tail fractions of the peak and more peptide is recovered in the main peak. In another exemplary embodiment, the addition of an amino acid (e.g. glycine) does not decrease the purity of the product from HA chromatography.
- In an exemplary embodiment, the amino acid is glycine. In a preferred embodiment, glycine is added to the elution buffer at a final concentration of 20 mM.
- Hydrophobic interaction chromatography (HIC) is a liquid chromatography technique that separates biomolecules based on differences in their surface hydrophobicity. For example, hydrophobic amino acid side chains exposed on the surface of a polypeptide, can interact with hydrophobic moieties on the HIC matrix. The amount, of exposed hydrophobic amino acids differs between polypeptides and so does the ability of polypeptides to interact with HIC gels. Hydrophobic interaction between a biomolecule and the HIC matrix is typically enhanced by high ionic strength buffers, and of biomolecules is most often performed at high salt concentrations. The elution of the peptide of interest from the column is then initiated by decreasing salt gradients.
- In one embodiment, the HIC resin is selected for optimal resolution of different polypeptide glycoforms. Exemplary HIC resins useful in the methods of the invention are described, e.g., in Protein Purification Methods, A Practical Approach, Ed. Harris ELV, Angal S, IRL Press Oxford, England (1989) page 224, Protein Purification, Ed. Janson J C, Ryden L, VCH-Verlag, Weinheim, Germany (1989) pages 207-226, Process Scale Bioseparations for the Biopharmaceutical Industry, Ed. Shukla A A, Etzel M R, Gadam S, CRC Press Taylor & Francis Group (2007), pages 197-206, Hydrophobic Interaction and Reversed Phase Chromatography, Principles and Methods, GE Healthcare 2007 (11-0012-69), Protein Purification Handbook, GE Healthcare 2007 (18-1132-29) and Protein Purification, Principles, High Resolution Methods and Applications (2nd Edition 1998), Ed. Janson J-C and Ryden L, “Hydrophobic Interaction Chromatography, page 283, the disclosures of which are incorporated herein by reference in their entirety.
- HIC media are distinguished by the hydrophobic moiety that they carry, by the particle size (e.g. bead size), the pore size and the density of the hydrophobic moieties on the HIC matrix (e.g. low substitution or high substitution). In an exemplary embodiment, the hydrophobic moieties of the column matrix are members selected from alkyl groups, aromatic groups and ethers. Exemplary hydrophobic alkyl groups include lower alkyl groups, such as n-propyl, isopropyl, n-butyl, iso-butyl, and n-octyl. Exemplary aromatic groups include substituted and unsubstituted phenyl.
- In another exemplary embodiment the matrix of the HIC medium is a member selected from agarose, sepharose (GE Healthcare), polystyrene, divinylbenzene, and combinations thereof. Exemplary HIC resins include Butyl Fast Flow and Phenyl Fast Flow (e.g., GE Healthcare) in either low or high substituted versions. In a preferred embodiment, the HIC resin is a phenyl resin. In one particular example, the HIC resin is Phenyl650S or Phenyl650M (e.g., Tosohaas, Toyopearl).
- In one example, the HIC medium is selected from the following commercial resins:
- Capto Phenyl (prototype resin)
Capto Butyl (prototype resin) - YMC-Pack Octyl Columns-3, 5, 10P, 15 and 25 um with
pore sizes 120, 200, 300 A
YMC-Pack Phenyl Columns-3, 5, 10P, 15 and 25 um withpore sizes 120, 200 and 300 A
YMC-Pack Butyl Columns-3, 5, 10P, 15 and 25 um withpore sizes 120, 200 and 300 A - Macroprep t-Butyl
Macroprep methyl - In a further exemplary embodiment, the amount of polypeptide conjugate loaded onto the HIC medium is between about 0.05 and about 1.0 mg conjugate/mL resin. In one example, the loaded amount of polypeptide conjugate is selected between about 0.05 and 0.3 mg conjugate/mL resin. In another example, the HIC medium is loaded with between about 0.1 and about 0.2 mg conjugate/mL resin (e.g., 0.15-0.18 mg/mL). In another embodiment, the amount of polypeptide conjugate loaded onto the HIC column is optimized for recovery of peptide conjugate and resolution of glycoforms. In one embodiment, in which the polypeptide conjugate is EPO-PEG3, the HIC loading conditions are selected to create an HIC eluate that includes less than about 8%, preferably less than about 7%, more preferably less than about 6%, even more preferably less than about 5% and most preferably less than about 4% of EPO-PEG2.
- In one embodiment, the loading buffer (the buffer in which the purified polypeptide conjugate is applied to the HIC column) is selected to bind the purified polypeptide conjugate to the HIC medium. Unbound impurities are then washed off the column using a HIC wash buffer. Consequently, polypeptide conjugates are eluted using an HIC elution buffer.
- In an exemplary embodiment, the HIC loading buffer, the HIC wash buffer and the HIC elution buffer each contain one or more salts, such as sodium acetate (NaOAc), sodium chloride (NaCl), sodium sulfate (Na2SO4) and sodium phosphate. The concentration ranges for these and other salts are generally optimized for each type of HIC resin to affect optimal binding of the polypeptide conjugate being purified.
- In one embodiment, the HIC loading buffer includes sodium sulfate (Na2SO4) or ammonium sulfate, (NH4)2SO4. In an exemplary embodiment, the concentration of sodium- or ammonium sulfate in the loading buffer is about 100 mM to about 1200 mM. In another exemplary embodiment, the concentration of sodium sulfate in the HIC loading buffer is about 300 mM to about 1100 mM, about 300 mM to about 1000 mM, about 300 mM to about 900 mM, about 300 mM to about 800 mM, about 300 mM to about 700 mM, about 300 mM to about 600 mM or about 300 mM to about 500 mM. In yet another embodiment, the concentration of sodium sulfate in the HIC loading buffer is about 400 mM to about 800 mM. In a further exemplary embodiment, the concentration of sodium sulfate in the HIC loading buffer is about 500 mM to about 700 mM, and preferably about 600 mM.
- In one embodiment, the HIC loading buffer, HIC wash buffer and HIC elution buffer include sodium phosphate. In one example, the concentration of sodium phosphate in any of these buffers is selected between about 5 mM and about 70 mM. In another example, the concentration of sodium phosphate in the HIC wash buffer is selected between about 10 mM and about 50 mM, between about 10 mM and about 30 mM or between about 20 mM and about 30 mM. In one particular example, the sodium phosphate concentration in the HIC wash buffer and elution buffer is about 25 mM.
- In another exemplary embodiment, the HIC wash buffer has a pH of about 4.0 to about 8.0. In one example, the pH of the HIC wash buffer is selected from about 5.0 to about 8.0. In another example, the pH is selected from about 6 to about 8. In yet another example, the pH is selected from about 6.5 to about 8.0. In a further embodiment, the pH of the HIC wash buffer is selected from about 7.0 to about 8.0, from about 7.0 to about 7.9, from about 7.0 to about 7.8, from about 7.0 to about 7.7, from about 7.0 to about 7.6 or from about 7.0 to about 7.5. In one particular example, the pH of the HIC wash buffer is about 7.5.
- In one embodiment, the purified polypeptide conjugate is eluted from the HIC resin using a gradient of decreasing sodium sulfate concentration. Optionally, the elution buffer does not contain any sodium sulfate.
- In another embodiment, HIC is employed as a method to separate polypeptide glycoforms, each covalently linked to at least one poly(alkylene oxide) moiety. In one example, the elution gradient profile is selected to affect optimal resolution of different polypeptide glycoforms contained in the purified mixture. In one embodiment, the HIC elution buffer includes 25 mM sodium phosphate and a combination of gradient and hold periods spanning a range of about 600 mM sodium sulfate to no sodium sulfate in the phosphate buffer is employed to elute polypeptide conjugates from the HIC medium.
- In an exemplary embodiment, HIC is performed subsequent to anion exchange chromatography. In one example, the flow-through from the anion exchanger, which contains the partially purified polypeptide conjugate is conditioned for hydrophobic interaction chromatography. In one example, the anion exchange flow-through may be diluted with a buffer suitable as a loading buffer for HIC. For example, the anion exchange flow-through can be diluted with a buffer containing sodium sulfate to adjust the sodium sulfate concentration in the HIC load (e.g., a sodium sulfate concentration suitable to bind the polypeptide conjugate to the HIC medium, e.g., about 600 mM). Optionally, the anion exchange flow-through is concentrated before dilution. In another example, the anion exchange flow-through is subjected to diafiltration/ultrafiltration for concentration and/or buffer exchange.
- In one embodiment of the invention, the polypeptide conjugate of interest is purified from a mixture (e.g., a reaction mixture, such as a glycoPEGylation reaction) using the exemplary purification process outlined in
FIG. 1 . In a first step, the product of the glycoPEGylation reaction is subjected to anion exchange chromatography/filtration (e.g., using a Sartobind Q resin). In one example, impurities are bound by the anion exchange medium, while the purified polypeptide conjugate is found in the flow-through. In one embodiment, this anion exchange step is useful to remove catalytic enzymes used in a glycan remodeling and/or glycomodification (e.g., glycoPEGylation) reaction performed prior to the anion exchange procedure. In one example, the anion exchange step is useful to isolate the polypeptide conjugate from at least one glycosyltransferase contained in the glycoPEGylation reaction mixture. - In a second step, the flow-through of the anion exchange step containing the partially purified polypeptide conjugate is conditioned and then loaded onto a hydrophobic interaction chromatography resin. In one example, the HIC medium is
Phenyl 650S. - In one embodiment, the anion exchange flow-through is conditioned to generate a HIC loading sample that includes a sufficient salt concentration to affect binding of the polypeptide conjugate to the HIC medium. In one embodiment, the anion exchange flow-trough is diluted with a buffer containing sodium sulfate. In one embodiment, the dilution buffer contains sufficient sodium sulfate to generate a HIC loading sample having a sodium sulfate concentration between about 500 mM and about 700 mM. In one example, the anion exchange flow-through is diluted so that the HIC loading sample includes about 600 mM of sodium sulfate. After the sample is applied to the column, the HIC resin is washed with a wash buffer to elute unbound impurities. In one example the HIC wash buffer is a phosphate buffer. In another example, the HIC wash buffer contains about 25 mM sodium phosphate at a pH of about 7.5.
- Subsequent to washing, the polypeptide conjugate is eluted from the HIC medium using an elution buffer. In one example, the polypeptide conjugate is eluted from the HIC medium using a phosphate buffer (e.g., 25 mM sodium phosphate at pH 7.5) and a gradient of decreasing sodium sulfate in the phosphate buffer. In one example, the conjugate is eluted using a gradient from about 600 mM to about 0 mM sodium sulfate. Eluate fractions are collected and optionally analyzed for product content. Product containing fractions are pooled and the resulting HIC pool is optionally conditioned for loading onto a cation exchange medium.
- In one embodiment, the HIC pool is concentrated and the buffer is exchanged using diafiltration. In one example, the diafiltration membrane has a MWCO of 10 kDa. In another example, the volume of the HIC pool is reduced to between about 1/30 and about 1/10 of the original volume. In a particular example, the HIC pool volume is reduced to about 1/20 of the original volume. The buffer may then be exchanged, for example, by diluting the sample with the new buffer and subsequently re-concentrating the sample. The dilution and re-concentration steps may be repeated (e.g., 2-6 times) until the new buffer has the desired composition (e.g., the desired salt conductivity).
- The partially purified polypeptide conjugate may be transferred into the desired buffer using a two step buffer exchange. In the first buffer exchange step, the buffer may be changed to a phosphate buffer that does not include sodium sulfate. The pH of the resulting conjugate solution may optionally be adjusted (e.g., using sodium acetate. In a second buffer exchange step, the buffer may be changed to a buffer system suitable for loading onto a cation exchanger. For example, the second buffer may include about 10 mM sodium acetate at a pH of about 5.4. In another example, the loading buffer for the cation exchange step has a salt conductivity between about 1.0 and about 3.0 mS/cm (e.g., about 1.5 mS/cm).
- In a third step, the diafiltered HIC pool is subjected to cation exchange. In one embodiment, the cation exchanger is
Source 15S. In one example, the cation exchange medium is useful to further reduce the content of unwanted glycoforms of the purified polypeptide conjugate. - In one example, the partially purified polypeptide conjugate is applied to the cation exchange medium and unbound impurities are eluted using a cation exchange wash buffer (e.g., 10 mM sodium acetate, pH 5.4). The bound polypeptide conjugate is then eluted using a cation exchange elution buffer. In one embodiment, the conjugate is eluted using increasing NaCl concentrations in the above wash buffer. For example, the conjugate is eluted using a gradient of 0-0.5 M NaCl. In one embodiment, the gradient elution profile, which may include a combination of gradient and hold periods, is selected for optimized glycoform resolution. Eluate fractions are collected and optionally analyzed (e.g., for product content and purity). Selected product containing fractions are pooled to form a cation exchange pool.
- In one embodiment, the cation exchange pool is concentrated and diafiltered into a storage buffer. In one example, this diafiltration step also uses a 10 kDa MWCO membrane. In one embodiment, the volume of the cation exchange pool is reduced to about 1/100 to about 1/25 of its original volume (e.g., about 1/50 of the original volume). The concentrated cation exchange pool is then subjected to buffer exchange, for example, by diluting the sample with the new buffer and subsequently re-concentrating the sample. The dilution and re-concentration step may be repeated (e.g., 2-6 times) until the new buffer has the desired composition. The final retentate is reconstituted into a storage buffer. Exemplary storage buffers include those having a sodium chloride concentration that is in the physiological range. For example, the storage buffer may be a sodium acetate buffer including about 150 mM NaCl. The concentrated product pool is reconstituted in the storage buffer to reach a desired peptide concentration. In one embodiment, the final conjugate concentration is selected between about 0.5 and about 2 mg/mL. The final solution is optionally sterile filtered, for example through a cellulose acetate membrane.
- The purification process outlined in
FIG. 1 , may optionally include an additional chromatography step. In one embodiment, the process includes a hydroxyapatite (HA) or fluoroapatite chromatography step. In one example, the apatite chromatography is performed after anion exchange chromatography. In another example, the apatite chromatography is performed after HIC. In yet another example, the apatite chromatography is performed after cation exchange chromatography. The partially purified polypeptide conjugate solution may be desalted, for example, using a size exclusion column (e.g. G25) to lower the salt conductivity of the conjugate solution in preparation for apatite chromatography. - In an exemplary embodiment, the polypeptide conjugate purified by the above described process is an EPO-conjugate.
- In another aspect the invention provides a composition made by a method of the invention. In one embodiment, the invention provides a composition including a first polypeptide conjugate, said first polypeptide conjugate having a first number of poly(alkylene oxide) moieties, each of the poly(alkylene oxide) moieties covalently linked to the first polypeptide via an intact glycosyl linking group. The composition is made by a method including: (a) contacting a mixture comprising the first polypeptide conjugate with a hydrophobic interaction chromatography (HIC) medium; and (b) eluting the first polypeptide conjugate from the hydrophobic interaction chromatography medium.
- In another aspect, the invention provides an isolated first polypeptide conjugate made by a method comprising: separating the first polypeptide conjugate including a first number of poly(alkylene oxide) moieties covalently linked to a first polypeptide, from a second polypeptide conjugate comprising a second number of poly(alkylene oxide) moieties covalently linked to a second polypeptide. In one embodiment, the first number is selected from 1 to 20 and the second number is selected from 0-20. In another embodiment, the first number and the second number are different. The two polypeptide conjugates are separated by: (a) contacting a mixture comprising the first polypeptide conjugate and the second polypeptide conjugate with a hydrophobic interaction chromatography (HIC) medium; and (b) eluting the first polypeptide conjugate from the hydrophobic interaction chromatography medium.
- In one example, according to any of the above embodiments, the first polypeptide is a member selected from erythropoietin (EPO), bone morphogenetic protein 2 (BMP-2), bone morphogenetic protein 7 (BMP-7), bone morphogenetic protein 15 (BMP-15), neurotrophin-3 (NT-3), von Willebrand factor (vWF) protease, granulocyte colony stimulating factor (G-CSF), granulocyte-macrophage colony stimulating factor (GM-CSF), interferon alpha, interferon beta, interferon gamma, α1-antitrypsin (α-1 protease inhibitor), glucocerebrosidase, tissue-type plasminogen activator (TPA), interleukin-2 (IL-2), leptin, hirudin, urokinase, human DNase, insulin, hepatitis B surface protein (HbsAg), chimeric diphtheria toxin-IL-2, human growth hormone (hGH), human chorionic gonadotropin (hCG), thyroid peroxidase (TPO), alpha-galactosidase, alpha-L-iduronidase, beta-glucosidase, alpha-galactosidase A, acid α-glucosidase (acid maltase), anti-thrombin III (AT III), follicle stimulating hormone (FSH), glucagon-like peptide-1 (GLP-1), glucagon-like peptide-2 (GLP-2), fibroblast growth factor 7 (FGF-7), fibroblast growth factor 21 (FGF-21), fibroblast growth factor 23 (FGF-23), Factor X, Factor XIII, prokinetisin, extendin-4, CD4, tumor necrosis factor receptor (TNF-R), α-CD20, P-selectin glycoprotein ligand-1 (PSGL-1), complement, transferrin, glycosylation-dependent cell adhesion molecule (GlyCAM), neural-cell adhesion molecule (N-CAM), TNF receptor-IgG Fc region fusion protein, anti-HER2 monoclonal antibody, monoclonal antibody to respiratory syncytial virus, monoclonal antibody to protein F of respiratory syncytial virus, monoclonal antibody to TNF-α, monoclonal antibody to glycoprotein IIb/IIIa, monoclonal antibody to CD20, monoclonal antibody to VEGF-A, monoclonal antibody to PSGL-1, monoclonal antibody to CD4, monoclonal antibody to a-CD3, monoclonal antibody to EGF, monoclonal antibody to carcinoembryonic antigen (CEA) and monoclonal antibody to IL-2 receptor. Mutant forms of any of the above polypeptides are also within the scope of the invention.
- In yet another aspect, the invention provides a composition including a first erythropoietin (EPO) conjugate, the first EPO conjugate having a first number of poly(alkylene oxide) moieties covalently linked to an EPO polypeptide via a glycosyl linking group (e.g., an intact glycosyl linking group). The composition is made by a method including: (a) contacting a mixture including the first EPO conjugate with an anion exchange medium; (b) eluting the first EPO conjugate from the anion exchange medium, forming a first eluate comprising the first EPO conjugate; (c) contacting the first eluate with a hydrophobic interaction chromatography (HIC) medium; and (d) eluting the first EPO conjugate from the hydrophobic interaction chromatography medium.
- In a further aspect, the invention provides a pharmaceutical formulation including a composition made by a method of the invention and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier. In one embodiment, the pharmaceutical formulation includes an isolated polypeptide conjugate made by a method of the invention and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier. In one example according to this embodiment, the isolated polypeptide conjugate is an EPO-conjugate.
- In another aspect, the invention provides methods of treatment utilizing a composition (e.g., an isolated polypeptide conjugate) made by a method of the invention. In one embodiment, the invention provides a method of treating a condition in a subject in need thereof, the condition characterized by compromised red blood cell production in the subject, the method comprising: administering to the subject an amount of a composition of the invention, effective to ameliorate the condition in the subject. In one example, the subject is a mammal, such as a human. In another example, the composition includes an EPO conjugate made by a method of the invention.
- In another embodiment, the invention provides a method of treating a tissue injury in a subject in need thereof. In one example, the injury is caused by a member selected from ischemia, trauma, inflammation and contact with a toxic substance. The method includes: administering to a subject an amount of a composition made by a method of the invention (e.g., an isolated polypeptide conjugate) that is effective in ameliorating the damage associated with the tissue injury. In one example, the subject is a mammal, such as a human. In another example, the composition includes an EPO conjugate made by a method of the invention.
- In another embodiment, the invention provides a method of enhancing red blood cell production in a mammal, said method comprising administering to said mammal a composition made by a method of the invention. In one example, the subject is a mammal, such as a human. In another example, the composition includes an EPO conjugate made by a method of the invention.
- The following examples are provided to illustrate the methods of the present invention, but not to limit the claimed invention.
- The protein concentration was determined using either a UV method (280 nm) or was determined using BCA Protein Assay kit according to manufacture's instructions (Pierce).
- The conductivity of process samples and buffers was measured using a conductivity probe (VWR 2052) according to the manufacturer's instructions.
- The ratio of each EPO-PEG form [EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)1-4] was determined using C3 RP HPLC chromatography (Zorbax 300SB-C3, 150×2.1 mm, 5 micron, 45° C.). The HPLC was performed using the following solutions: A, 0.1% TFA in water, and B, 0.09% TFA in ACN. The mobile phase was performed as a gradient from 42-55% B over 14 min, 55-95% B over 2 min, a 2 min wash at 95% B and then 95-42% B over 2 min. The total time conduct the chromatography was 30 min using a flow rate of 0.6 mL/min.
Mixture 1 was used as a reference standard to test system suitability. The injection volume was varied to give a standard injection concentration of 5 to 10 μg of EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)3 based on protein. Protein absorbance was detected at 214 nm and the peak areas of the EPO species were used to determine the protein purity. All peaks were integrated using 32 karat software. The EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)4 peak could typically not be integrated accurately due to its small area. - The EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)3 isoform purity and aggregation were determined by SEC HPLC chromatography (TSK-gel G5000PW×L, 7.8×300 mm, 10 micron, 4° C.). The isocratic mobile phase (100 mM sodium phosphate, 150 mM sodium chloride, pH 7.0) was used to perform the method at a flow rate of 0.5 mL/min.
- This example describes the development of an isolation process for the isolation of EPO conjugates from a glycoPEGylation reaction mixture. The resulting process is characterized by high overall EPO conjugate recovery and produces the desired EPO conjugate [EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)3] in high purity. The composition produced by the process is essentially free of other EPO-PEG glycoforms, such as mono-, di- and tetra-PEGylated EPO conjugates.
- The desired EPO-PEG conjugate is a glycoPEGylated erythropoietin protein that contains three 10 kDa mPEG groups attached to each of the three monoantennary N-linked glycans. The EPO polypeptide is produced by expression of the protein from Sf9 cells using a Baculovirus infection protocol. The insect cell expression system produces EPO with three N-linked glycans, at Asn24, Asn38 and Asn83, each containing a trimannosyl core as the predominant species. A variety of other glycan structures are present in small amounts that vary with fermentation conditions. The other structures include trimannosyl core with an additional GlcNAc, higher mannose forms (Man4, Man5), missing glycans, and GlcNAc-(Fuc) stub arising as a result of an endoglycosidase-type (Endo-H) activity. A small percentage of the EPO molecules contain O-linked glycans at Ser126. A very low level (<1%) of phosphorylcholine-linked glycans (PC-glycan) has also been identified in the insect cell-derived EPO. Upon GlycoPEGylation with MBP-GnT1, MBP-GalT1, and MBP-ST3Gal3 or ST3Gal3 with CMP-SA-PEG-10 kDa, the predominant product is EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)3 which contains three PEGylated mono-antennary N-linked glycans. EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)1-2 are also present in lesser amounts, arising from the EPO forms missing one or more glycans or containing one or more GlcNAc-stub glycans. EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)4 (and higher) are produced at very low levels. These higher PEGylated species are thought to result from the GlycoPEGylation of the EPO glycoforms which contain the tri-mannosyl core with an additional GlcNAc on the Manα1,6 branch. Both branches of these glycans can be built out and PEGylated under the reaction conditions, resulting in biantennary PEGylated glycans on a tetra-PEG (or higher) EPO species. Exemplary EPO glycoforms are depicted in
FIG. 3 . - GlycoPEGylated EPO isolated using reversed-phase chromatography and cation exchange chromatography (e.g., on SP-Sepharose HP) provided a composition containing greater than or equal to about 85% EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)3, about 3-14% EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)2, about 1-8% EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)4-6 and less than or equal to about 1% EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)i. In the following, the above composition is referred to as
Mixture 1. - Efforts were undertaken to replace the reverse phase chromatography step with another chromatography step, which does not employ organic solvents but is capable of resolving EPO glycoforms. Large amounts of organic solvents are associated with environmental concerns and may not be used in certain facilities processing biologic drug products. In addition, the stability of EPO-PEG conjugates, such as EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)3 in solutions with a high concentration of organic solvents (e.g., acetonitrile) is a concern. Hydrophobic Interaction Chromatography (HIC) was investigated as a potential replacement for the reverse phase chromatography step.
- It was discovered that HIC was capable of separating different PEG states (glycoforms) contained in a mixture, which results from a glycoPEGylation process (e.g., fractionation of isoforms EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)1-4). The HIC purification method was optimized by evaluating a variety of HIC resins and process parameters. A process based on
Phenyl 650S resin (e.g., Tosohaas, Toyopearl) was selected for incorporation into the new isolation process. - Also incorporated into the new process was an anion exchange step, which is useful to remove enzyme components of the glycoPEGylation reaction. Enzymes are bound by the anion exchange medium, while the EPO-PEG conjugates EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)1-6 are found in the flow through.
- Initial HIC resin screening experiments were performed using Tricorn 5 columns packed to 5 cm bead heights. Selected hydrophobic interaction chromatography resins are summarized in Table 1, below.
-
TABLE 1 Summary of Evaluated HIC Resins and Elution Conditions Resin Buffer A Buffer B HIC Resins Set I: A Ether-5PW 30 mM Na phosphate, pH 6.5 Buffer A + 1 M NaCl, pH 6.5 B Butyl-S-FF 25 mM Na phosphate, pH 7.0 Buffer A + 1 M (NH4)2SO4, pH 7.0 C Butyl-FF 25 mM Na phosphate, pH 7.0 Buffer A + 1 M (NH4)2SO4, pH 7.0 D Octyl-FF 25 mM Na phosphate, pH 7.0 Buffer A + 1 M (NH4)2SO4, pH 7.0 E Phenyl-FF Low sub 25 mM Na phosphate, pH 7.0 Buffer A + 1 M (NH4)2SO4, pH 7.0 F Phenyl-FF High sub 25 mM Na phosphate, pH 7.0 Buffer A + 1 M (NH4)2SO4, pH 7.0 HIC Resin Set II: G Butyl 650M 25 mM Na phosphate, pH 7.0 Buffer A + 1 M (NH4)2SO4, pH 7.0 H Phenyl 650M 25 mM Na phosphate, pH 7.0 Buffer A + 4 M NaCl, pH 7.0 I Phenyl 650M 25 mM Na phosphate, pH 7.0 Buffer A + 1 M (NH4)2SO4, pH 7.0 J Phenyl-FF Low sub 25 mM Na phosphate, pH 7.0 Buffer A + 4 M NaCl, pH 7.0 K Phenyl-FF Low sub 25 mM Na phosphate, pH 7.0 Buffer A + 1 M (NH4)2SO4, pH 7.0 HIC Resin Set III: L Phenyl 650M 20 mM NaOAc, pH 5.0 Buffer A + 1 M Na2SO4 + 0.5 M NaCl, pH 5.0 M Phenyl 650M 20 mM NaOAc, pH 5.0 Buffer A + 1 M Na2SO4, pH 5.0 N Phenyl 650M 25 mM Na phosphate, pH 7.0 Buffer A + 1 M Na2SO4, pH 7.0 O Phenyl 650M 25 mM Na phosphate, 20% Buffer A + 4 M NaCl, pH 7.0 ethylene glycol, pH 7.0 P Phenyl 650M 25 mM Na phosphate, pH 7.0 Buffer A + 4 M NaCl, pH 7.0 Q Phenyl 650M 25 mM Na phosphate, pH 7.0 Buffer A + 1 M (NH4)2SO4, pH 7.0 - A Tricorn 5 column packed with 1 mL (0.5 cm×5 cm) of the appropriate resin (Table 1) or a prepacked HiTrap column (1 mL, 0.7 cm×2.5 cm) was attached to an AKTA FPLC system (GE Healthcare). Product elution was monitored by absorbance at 280 nm. Each column was equilibrated with 5 column volumes (CV) of Buffer B (as indicated in Table 1). Mixture 1 (100 mcg, 250 mcL) was diluted to 1.25 mL with 1 mL of Buffer B and injected using a 2 mL sample loop. The unbound material was washed with 5 CV of Buffer B. The EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)3 was eluted with the following gradient elution using Buffer A (as indicated in Table 1): 100-0% Buffer B over 20 CV followed by 0% Buffer B for 5 CV. All steps were performed at 0.64 mL/min (196 cm/hr). The resulting chromatograms were compared and selected fractions were analysed by SDS-PAGE. Resins were selected for their capability to retain the EPO-PEG conjugates, their capability to resolve different glycoforms and peak shapes.
- The following Hydrophobic Interaction Chromatography (HIC) resins; Butyl-FF, Butyl-S—FF, Octyl-FF, Phenyl-FF High sub and Phenyl-FF Low sub were initially tested by injecting
Mixture 1 in buffer B: 25 mM Na phosphate, 1 M ammonium Sulfate, pH 7.0. Under the conditions tested, the Phenyl-FF Low sub appeared to be the best resin for the binding and elution ofMixture 1.Mixture 1 was not bound by Butyl-S—FF. Butyl-FF, Octyl-FF, and Phenyl-FF High sub boundMixture 1 fairly tightly and the elution peaks were extremely broad (˜15 CV). - In a second round of HIC investigation, Phenyl-FF Low sub was compared to Phenyl 650M and Butyl 650M using either 25 mM Na phosphate, 1 M ammonium Sulfate, pH 7.0 or 25 mM Na phosphate, 4 M ammonium Sulfate, pH 7.0 as binding buffer (loading buffer). Butyl 650M was only tested with ammonium sulfate and resulted in a very wide and tailing elution peak. Both Phenyl 650M and Phenyl-FF low sub had a more symmetric peak shape when using sodium sulfate. The use of sodium chloride resulted in extremely broad elution peaks.
- A third round of HIC testing, compares the Phenyl 650M purification of
Mixture 1 with different buffers. Buffer B: 1 M Na Sulfate+0.5 M NaCl+20 mM NaOAc, pH 5.0 was tested as this condition had worked for purification of the EPO intermediate prior to PEGylation. This condition resulted in a broad elution peak with multiply bumps, as did the same buffer without 0.5M NaCl (1 M Na Sulfate+20 mM NaOAc, pH 5.0). Phenyl 650M was tested usingMixture 1 bound to the column using 4 M NaCl+buffer A, pH 7.0 and the elution was performed with 25 mM Na phosphate, 20% ethylene glycol, pH 7.0. The addition of ethylene glycol did not significantly improve the broad elution profile resulting from NaCl in buffer B. Hence, conditions N and Q were found to be superior to other tested conditions. Sodium sulfate, which is preferred in manufacturing gave an elution profile as good or better that the ammonium sulfate. - Elution of Glycosyltransferases from Tosohaas Phenyl 650 M Resin
- A Tricorn 5 column packed with a 1 mL (0.5 cm×5 cm) Phenyl 650M resin was attached to an AKTA FPLC system continuously monitoring absorbance at A280. The column was equilibrated with 5 column volumes (CV) of Buffer B (1 M sodium sulfate, 25 mM sodium phosphate, pH 7.0). Product elution was monitored by absorbance at 280 nm.
- Four separate sample injections of the following materials were applied to the column using a 2 mL sample loop: 1. Mixture 1 (100 mcg, 250 mcL) diluted to 1.25 mL with 1 mL of Buffer B. 2. MBP-SBD-ST3Gal3 (98 mcL, 98 mcg) diluted to 1.225 mL with 1.127 mL of Buffer B. 3. MBP-GnT1 (196 mcL, 57.4 mcg) diluted to 1.225 mL with 1.029 mL of Buffer B. 4. MBP-GalT1 (196 mcL, 186 mcg) diluted to 1.225 mL with 1.029 mL Buffer B.
- After each sample was injected, any unbound material was washed from the column using 5 CV of Buffer B. Any bound material was eluted from the column using a gradient using Buffer A (25 mM sodium phosphate, pH 7.0): 100-0% Buffer B over 20 CV followed by 0% Buffer B for 5 CV (Table 1, Set III, N). Chromatography operations were performed at a flow rate of 0.64 mL/min. Elution profiles were compared and selected fractions were analysed by SDS-PAGE.
- The glycoPEGylation enzymes were individually injected on Phenyl 650M to compare the elutio profiles to
Mixture 1 using the following condition: Buffer A: 25 mM Na phosphate, pH 7.0. Buffer B: 1 M Na Sulfate+buffer A, pH 7.0. Elution gradient: 100−0% B over 20 cv. The MBP-SBD-ST3Gal3, MBP-GnT1 and MBP-GalT1 all eluted in the same portion of the gradient.Mixture 1 elutes just prior to the enzymes. AlthoughMixture 1 and glycoPEGylation enzymes do not completely co-elute,Mixture 1 and the leading portion of the enzyme elution peaks seemed to overlap. - Optimization of the Sodium Sulfate Concentration using Phenyl 650M Chromatography
- The concentration of sodium sulfate required to bind
Mixture 1 bind Phenyl 650M was investigated. A Tricorn 5 column was packed with Phenyl 650M resin (1 mL, 0.5 cm 5 cm) as described above and attached to a Varian HPLC system. Each column was equilibrated with 5 column volumes (CV) of one of the buffers listed below. Product elution was monitored by absorbance at 280 nm. - Five separate injections of Mixture 1 (100 mcg, 250 mcL diluted to 1.25 mL with 1 mL Buffer B) were applied to the column using a 2 mL sample loop. Each chromatography used one of the following sodium sulfate concentrations in Buffer B: 1. 1.0 M sodium sulfate, 25 mM sodium phosphate, pH 7.5; 2. 0.8 M sodium sulfate, 25 mM sodium phosphate, pH 7.5; 3. 0.6 M sodium sulfate, 25 mM sodium phosphate, pH 7.5; 4. 0.4 M sodium sulfate, 25 mM sodium phosphate, pH 7.5; 5. 0.3 M sodium sulfate, 25 mM sodium phosphate, pH 7.5.
- Any unbound material was washed from the column with 5 CV of Buffer B. EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)3 was eluted using a gradient of Buffer A (25 mM sodium phosphate, pH 7.0): 100-0% Buffer B over 20 CV (gradient change 5% Buffer B/CV), and then 0% Buffer B for 5 CV. Chromatography operations were performed at a flow rate of 0.64 mL/min (196 cm/hr). EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)3 peak fractions were stored at 4° C. until analysis by SDS-PAGE.
- A minimum of 0.4 M sodium sulfate was required to bind
Mixture 1 to the column. As expected the higher the sodium sulfate concentration the greater the retention time on the column. The same gradient slope (change in % B per minute) was maintained for all five purification runs. As the initial concentration of buffer B was reduced, the actual gradient (change in salt concentration/minute) became more shallow. This results in the increase in elution peak width seen as the buffer B start concentration decreases. - Optimization of the Sodium Sulfate Elution
Gradient using Phenyl 650S Chromatography - A Tricorn 5 column was packed with
Phenyl 650S resin (1 mL, 0.5 cm×5 cm) as described above and attached to an AKTA FPLC system. Product elution was monitored by absorbance at 280 nm. Three separate purifications were performed each using a different elution gradient. The columns from each experiment were equilibrated with 5 column volumes (CV) of Buffer B (25 mM sodium phosphate, 0.6 M sodium sulfate, pH 7.5). - Mixture 1 (100 mcg, 250 mcL) was diluted to 1.25 mL with 1 mL Buffer B and injected onto the column using a 2 mL sample loop. Any unbound material was washed from the column using 5 CV of Buffer B. The EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)3 product was eluted from the column using one of the following gradients using Buffer A (25 mM sodium phosphate, pH 7.5). Gradient 1: 100-0% Buffer B over 20 CV (gradient change 5% Buffer B/CV) followed by 0% Buffer B for 5 CV. Gradient 2: 100-0% Buffer B over 12 CV (gradient change 8.33% Buffer B/CV) followed by 0% Buffer B for 5 CV. Gradient 3: 100-60% Buffer B over 2 CV, hold for 1 CV, 60-20% Buffer B over 20 CV (
gradient change 2% Buffer B/CV), 20-0% Buffer B over 2 CV and then 0% Buffer B for 5 CV. Chromatography operations were performed at a flow rate of 0.64 mL/min. Chromatography elution profiles were compared and selected fractions were analyzed by SDS PAGE. Out of the three gradient profiles tested,Gradient 3 provided the best separation of the EPO-PEG species. - The effect of pH on the ability of the
Phenyl 650S chromatography process to separate the PEG states of EPO-PEG was examined. ATricorn 10 column was packed with 15.7 mL (1.0 cm id×20 cm) ofPhenyl 650S. The column was equilibrated with 5 column volumes (CV) of buffer B (25 mM sodium phosphate, 0.6 M sodium sulfate, selected pH). In separate experiments, the process was repeated except the buffer pH was 6.5, 7.0, 7.5 or 8.0 in both Buffer A and B. The EPO-PEGx mixture (0.8 mg EPO protein conjugate; 1 mL) solution was adjusted to a sodium sulfate concentration of 0.6 M by addition of 0.4 mL of Buffer A (25 mM sodium phosphate, selected pH) and 0.6 mL of buffer (2 M sodium sulfate, 25 mM sodium phosphate, selected pH). This solution was then diluted with an equal volume of Buffer B and the entire sample (4 mL) was injected onto the column. The column was washed with 5 CV of Buffer B and the product eluted using a gradient using Buffer A. A gradient of 100-60% Buffer B over 2 CV, hold for 1 CV, 60-35% Buffer B over 13 CV, hold for 1 CV and then 0% Buffer B for 5 CV. The chromatography flow rate was 2.0 mL/min (150 cm/hr) and the column elution monitored by the absorbance at 280 nm. Fractions (1.6 mL) were collected in Nunc 96-well Microtiter plates. The chromatography elution profiles were compared and selected fractions were analyzed by SDS PAGE. Analysis of the product pool is summarized in Table 2, below: -
TABLE 2 Effect of pH on Separation and Recoveries of EPO- PEGs using Phenyl 650S1 Step MBP6 Buffer Yield3 EPO-PEG3 4 EPO-PEG2 5 [mcg/mg Aggregate7 pH2 [%] [%] [%] EPO] [%] pH 6.5 60.3 95.1 4.9 <0.085 0 pH 7.0 66.7 96.3 3.7 <0.077 0 pH 7.5 61.6 97.5 2.5 <0.083 0 pH 8.0 65.4 96.6 3.4 <0.078 0 1EPO-PEG (85.1% EPO-PEG3 and 14.9% EPO-PEG2 (Table 7). 2The pH of both, Buffer A and B. 3The step yield was calculated as the ratio of EPO-PEG protein recovered after HIC chromatography (combined fractions) versus the EPO-PEG injected onto the column 4The percent of EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)3 in the main product peak. 5The percent of EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)2 in the main product peak. 6The amount of MBP protein in the main product peak as determine by ELISA versus the amount of EPO-PEG protein. 7The amount of aggregate EPO-PEG in the product peak observed by SEC - Standard purification conditions (Buffer A: 25 mM sodium phosphate, pH 7.5. Buffer B: 25 mM sodium phosphate, 0.6M sodium sulfate, pH 7.5 (with 0.05 mg EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)1-4/mL resin loaded) were compared to purification runs with buffer A and B prepared at pH 6.5, 7.0 and 8.0. The elution peaks (A280) are shifted slightly to the left and right of the standard elution condition. The X-axis of these A280 traces were shifted to overlay the peaks. Comparison of the X-axis shifted peaks shows similar peak traces with respect to the elution of EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)2, EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)3, and EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)4. This is especially true for pH 7.0, 7.5 and 8.0. The pH 6.5 run had a slightly lower peak max and a little less resolution was noted between the EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)3 and EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)4 peaks.
- Table 2, above, compares EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)3 recovery, MBP-ELISA, RP-HPLC, and SEC analysis data. No significant difference was observed between the EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)3 purified within the 6.5 to 8.0 pH range. Recovery is between 60.3 and 66.7% (BCA analysis). MBP-ELISA indicates <0.077-0.085 mcg MBP/mg EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)3 remaining RP-HPLC analysis show that the amount of EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)2 remaining in the EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)3 peak is between 2.5 and 4.9%. Integration of EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)4 is difficult at low levels but is detected by silver stain SDS-PAGE. No aggregation of EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)3 is detected by SEC analysis. SDS-PAGE analysis shows that the purity of each EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)3 pool is similar. However, the pH 6.5 purified material contained a higher amount of a approximate 50 kDa proteolyses band. A minor amount of this proteolysis product was also detected for the pH 7.0 purified material.
- The effect of sodium phosphate concentration on the ability of the
Phenyl 650S chromatography process to separate the PEG states of EPO-PEG was examined. ATricorn 10 column was packed with 15.7 mL (1.0 cm id×20 cm) ofPhenyl 650S. The column was equilibrated with 5 column volumes (CV) of buffer B (various concentrations of sodium phosphate, 0.6 M sodium sulfate, pH 7.5). In separate experiments, the process was repeated except the sodium phosphate concentration was 15, 25 or 50 mM in both Buffer A and B. The EPO-PEGx mixture (0.8 mg EPO protein; 1 mL) solution was adjusted to a sodium sulfate concentration of 0.6 M by addition of 0.4 mL of Buffer A (various concentrations of sodium phosphate, pH 7.5) and 0.6 mL of buffer (2 M sodium sulfate, various concentrations of sodium phosphate, pH 7.5). This solution was then diluted with an equal volume of Buffer B and the entire sample (4 mL) was injected onto the column. The column was washed with 5 CV of Buffer B and the product eluted using a gradient using Buffer A. A gradient of 100-60% Buffer B over 2 CV, hold for 1 CV, 60-35% Buffer B over 13 CV, hold for 1 CV and then 0% Buffer B for 5 CV. The chromatography flow rate was 2.0 mL/min (150 cm/hr) and the column elution monitored by the absorbance at 280 nm. The chromatography elution profiles were compared and selected fractions were analyzed by SDS PAGE. The pooled fractions of the major product peak were analyzed. Results are summarized in Table 3, below: -
TABLE 3 Effect of Sodium Phosphate Concentration on Separation and Recovery of EPO- PEGs using Phenyl 650S.1Sodium Step EPO- EPO- MBP6 Phosphate Yield3 PEG3 4 PEG2 5 [mcg/mg Aggregate7 Concentration2 [%] [%] [%] EPO] [%] 15 mM 61.5 95.5 4.5 <0.083 0 25 mM 61.9 96.3 3.7 <0.085 0.22 50 mM 60.2 95.8 4.2 <0.085 0.34 1EPO-PEG (85.1% EPO-PEG3 and 14.9% EPO-PEG2 (Table 7). 2The sodium phosphate concentration of both, Buffer A and B. 3The step yield was calculated as the ratio of EPO-PEG protein recovered after HIC chromatography (combined fractions) versus the amount EPO-PEG injected onto the column 4The percent of EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)3 in the main product peak. 5The percent of EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)2 in the main product peak. 6The amount of MBP protein in the main product peak as determine by ELISA assay versus the amount of EPO-PEG protein. 7The amount of aggregate EPO-PEG in the product peak observed by SEC. - Standard purification conditions (Buffer A: 25 mM sodium phosphate, pH 7.5. Buffer B: 25 mM sodium phosphate, 0.6M sodium sulfate, pH 7.5 (0.05 mg EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)1-4/mL resin loaded) were compared to purification runs with buffer A and B prepared with 15 and 50 mM sodium phosphate. Resulting A280 elution profiles were compared. The 15 mM Na phosphate eluted material elutes earliest, followed by the 25 mM Na phosphate and finally 50 mM Na phosphate. The shift in elution profile is due to the relative changes in buffer conductivity (see table 3). The X-axis of these A280 traces were shifted to overlay the peaks. Comparison of the X-axis shifted peaks shows similar peak traces with respect to the elution of EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)2, EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)3, and EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)4.
- Table 3 compares EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)3 recovery, MBP-ELISA, RP-HPLC, and SEC analysis data. No significant difference was observed between the EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)3 purified within this 15 to 50 mM sodium phosphate concentration range. Recovery is between 60.2 and 61.9%. MBP-ELISA indicates <0.083-0.085 mcg MBP/mg EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)3 remaining RP-HPLC analysis showed that the amount of EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)2 remaining in the EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)3 peak is between 3.7 and 4.5%. Integration of the EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)4 peak was difficult at low levels but is detected by silver stain SDS-PAGE. SDS-PAGE analysis showed that the purity of each EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)3 pool is comparable as determined by colloidal blue and silver stained gels. No notable differences in purity were detected by SDS-PAGE.
- The robustness and the capability of the
Phenyl 650S chromatography step to separate the PEG states of EPO-PEG was examined with respect to variations in the Na sulfate concentrations in bufferB. A Tricorn 10 column was packed with 15.7 mL (1.0 cm id×20 cm) ofPhenyl 650S. The column was equilibrated with 5 column volumes (CV) of buffer B (25 mM sodium phosphate, various concentrations of sodium sulfate, pH 7.5). In separate experiments, the process was repeated except the buffer sodium sulfate concentrations of 0.5, 0.6 and 0.7 M of Buffer B were varied. The EPO-PEGx mixture (0.8 mg EPO protein; 1 mL) solution was adjusted to a sodium sulfate concentration by the addition of 0.3-0.5 mL of Buffer A (25 mM sodium phosphate, pH 7.5) and 0.5-0.7 mL of buffer (2 M sodium sulfate, 25 mM sodium phosphate, pH 7.5) depending on the sodium sulfate concentration used in the experiment. This solution was then diluted with an equal volume of Buffer B and the entire sample (4 mL) was injected onto the column. The column was washed with 5 CV of Buffer B and the product eluted using a gradient using Buffer A. A gradient of 100-60% Buffer B over 2 CV, hold for 1 CV, 60-35% Buffer B over 13 CV, hold for 1 CV and then 0% Buffer B for 5 CV. The chromatography flow rate was 2.0 mL/min (150 cm/hr) and the column elution monitored by the absorbance at 280 nm. The chromatography elution profiles were compared and selected fraction were analyzed by SDS PAGE. Analysis of the pooled fractions corresponding to the main product peak is summarized in Table 4, below: -
TABLE 4 Effect of Sodium Sulfate Concentration on Separation and Recovery of EPO- PEGs using Phenyl 650S.1Sodium Step EPO- EPO- MBP6 Sulfate Yield3 PEG3 4 PEG2 5 [mcg/mg Aggregate7 Concentration2 [%] [%] [%] EPO] [%] 0.5 M 61.5 96.6 3.4 <0.083 0 0.6 M 64.0 95.4 4.6 <0.04 0.22 0.7 M 64.2 95.4 4.6 <0.04 0.34 1EPO-PEG (85.1% EPO-PEG3 and 14.9% EPO-PEG2 (Table 7). 2The sodium sulfate concentration of Buffer B. 3The step yield was calculated as the ratio of EPO-PEG protein recovered after HIC chromatography (combined fractions) versus the amount of EPO-PEG injected onto the column. 4The percent of EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)3 in the main product peak. 5The percent of EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)2 in the main product peak. 6The amount of MBP protein in the main product peak as determine by the ELISA versus the amount of EPO-PEG protein. 7The amount of aggregate EPO-PEG in the product peak observed by SEC. - Standard purification conditions (Buffer A: 25 mM sodium phosphate, pH 7.5. Buffer B: 25 mM sodium phosphate, 0.6M sodium sulfate, pH 7.5. With 0.05 mg EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)1-4/mL resin loaded) were compared to purification runs with buffer B prepared with 0.5 and 0.7 M sodium sodium sulfate. Elution profiles (A280) were compared. The run with buffer B containing 0.5 M Na sulfate elutes earliest, followed by the 0.6 M Na sulfate and finally 0.7 M Na sulfate run. The X-axis of these A280 traces were shifted to overlay the peaks. Comparison of the X-axis shifted peaks shows similar peak traces with respect to the elution of EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)2, EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)3, and EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)4. A slight difference in peak width was noticed when comparing the elution peak profiles. Buffer B containing 0.7 M Na sulfate shows the sharpest peak shape, followed by the 0.6 M Na sulfate run and then 0.5 M Na sulfate run. The gradient programmed on the chromatography system was kept constant for each run. However, the increase or decrease of sodium sulfate in buffer B will decrease or increase the actual slope of the elution gradient respectively.
- Table 4 compares EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)3 recovery, MBP-ELISA, RP-HPLC, and SEC analysis data. No significant difference was noted between the EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)3 purified within the 0.5 to 0.7 M sodium sulfate concentration range. Recovery is between 61.5 and 64.2%. ELISA indicates <0.04-0.083 mcg MBP/mg EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)3 remaining RP-HPLC analysis showed that the amount of EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)2 remaining in the EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)3 peak is between 3.4 and 4.6%. Integration of the EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)4 peak was difficult at low levels but the glycoform was detected by silver stain SDS-PAGE. SDS-PAGE analysis showed that the purity of each EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)3 pool is similar as determined by colloidal blue as well as silver stained gels.
- The resin capacity for EPO-PEG and the ability of the
Phenyl 650S chromatography process to separate the PEG states of EPO-PEG was examined. ATricorn 10 column was packed with 15.7 mL (1.0 cm id×20 cm) ofPhenyl 650S. The column was equilibrated with 5 column volumes (CV) of buffer B (25 mM sodium phosphate, 0.6 M sodium sulfate, pH 7.5). In separate experiments, the amount of EPO-PEG used in the process was varied (0.05, 0.1, 0.2, 0.5 mg EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)1-4 protein/mL resin). The EPO-PEGx mixture was adjusted to a sodium sulfate concentration of 0.6 M and a final volume of 4 mL. This solution was injected onto the column. The column was washed with 5 CV of Buffer B and the product eluted using a gradient using Buffer A. A gradient of 100-60% Buffer B over 2 CV, hold for 1 CV, 60-35% Buffer B over 13 CV, hold for 1 CV and then 0% Buffer B for 5 CV. The chromatography flow rate was 2.0 mL/min (150 cm/hr) and the column elution monitored by the absorbance at 280 nm. The chromatography elution profiles were compared. Fractions were pooled and analyzed by SDS-PAGE. Analysis of the main product peak is summarized in Table 5, below: -
TABLE 5 Effect of Phenyl 650S Column Capacity on Separation andRecovery of EPO-PEGs.1 MBP6 Step EPO- EPO- [mcg/ Injected Amount of Yield3 PEG3 4 PEG2 5 mg Aggregate7 EPO-PEG2 [%] [%] [%] EPO] [%] 0.05 mg/mL resin 61.9 96.3 3.7 0.085 0.22 0.1 mg/mL resin 67.6 95.8 4.2 <0.024 0 0.2 mg/mL resin 70.2 94.9 5.1 <0.024 0 0.5 mg/mL resin 70.2 92.5 7.5 <0.019 0 1EPO-PEG (85.1% EPO-PEG3 and 14.9% EPO-PEG2 (Table 7). 2The ratio of EPO-PEG protein injected per mL of HIC resin packed in the column (mg EPO/mL resin). 3The step yield was calculated as the ratio of total EPO-PEG conjugate recovered after HIC chromatography versus the amount of EPO-PEG injected onto the column. 4The percent of EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)3 in the main product peak. 5The percent of EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)2 in the main product peak. 6The amount of MBP-protein contained in the main product peak as determine by ELISA assay versus the amount of EPO-PEG protein. 7The amount of aggregate EPO-PEG in the product peak observed by SEC. - The robustness of the
Phenyl 650S chromatography step was tested with respect to variations in the quantity of EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)1-4 loaded permL Phenyl 650S resin. Standard purification conditions (Buffer A: 25 mM sodium phosphate, pH 7.5. Buffer B: 25 mM sodium phosphate, 0.6M sodium sulfate, pH 7.5 (0.05 mg EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)1-4/mL resin loaded) were compared to purification runs where the column was loaded with 0.1, 0.2 and 0.5 mg EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)1-4/mL resin. Comparison of the resulting elution profiles (A280) shows a decrease in resolution between the EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)2 and EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)3 peaks as the amount of protein loaded onto the column is increased. RP-HPLC analysis was used to compare the amount of EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)2 remaining in the EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)3 pooled peak. Table 5 compares EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)3 recovery, MBP-ELISA, RP-HPLC, and SEC analysis data. No significant difference was noted between the EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)3 purified within the investigated column loading range. Recovery was between 61.9 and 70.2% (BCA analysis). As the quantity of material loaded onto the column is increased the recovery increased. However, this increase is also correlated with an increase in the amount of EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)2 remaining MBP-ELISA indicates <0.019-0.085 mcg MBP/mg EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)3 remaining RP-HPLC analysis resulted in a % EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)3 to % EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)2 ratio of 96.3:3.7, 95.8:4.2, 94.9:5.1, 92.5:7.5 for the 0.05 mg, 0.1 mg, 0.2 mg and 0.5 mg EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)1-4/mL resin loads, respectively. - Increasing the quantity of the protein loaded onto the column increases the amount of EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)2 in the EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)3 peak since the peaks were pooled in the same manner. Integration of the EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)4 was difficult at low levels but the glycoform was detected by silver stain SDS-PAGE. No aggregation of EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)3 was detected by SEC analysis. Minor aggregation (0.22%) of EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)3 was detected by SEC analysis in the 0.05 mg EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)1-4/mL resin load (this is the same sample described in the sodium phosphate buffer concentration experiment). SDS-PAGE analysis showed that the purity of each EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)3 pool is similar when determined by colloidal blue and silver stained gels.
- The ability of Phenyl 650M and
Phenyl 650S chromatography resins to separate the PEG states of EPO-PEG was examined. ATricorn 10 column was packed with 15.7 mL (1.0 cm id×20 cm) of eitherPhenyl 650S or Phenyl 650M. Each column was equilibrated with 5 column volumes (CV) of buffer B (25 mM sodium phosphate, 0.6 M sodium sulfate, pH 7.5). The EPO-PEGx (0.8 mg EPO protein; 1 mL) solution was adjusted to a sodium sulfate concentration of 0.6 M by the addition of 0.4 mL of Buffer A (25 mM sodium phosphate, pH 7.5) and 0.6 mL of buffer (2 M sodium sulfate, 25 mM sodium phosphate, pH 7.5). This solution was then diluted with an equal volume of Buffer B and the entire sample (4 mL) was injected onto the column. The column was washed with 5 CV of Buffer B and the product eluted using a gradient using Buffer A. A gradient of 100-60% Buffer B over 2 CV, hold for 1 CV, 60-35% Buffer B over 13 CV, hold for 1 CV and then 0% Buffer B for 5 CV. The chromatography flow rate was 2.0 mL/min (150 cm/hr) and the column elution monitored by the absorbance at 280 nm. The chromatography elution profiles were compared and selected fractions were analyzed by SDS PAGE. Analysis of the main product peak is summarized in Table 6, below: -
TABLE 6 Comparison of Phenyl 650S and 650M Resins and the Effect onSeparation and Recovery of EPO-PEGs.1 Step EPO- EPO- MBP6 Yield3 PEG3 4 PEG2 5 [mcg/mg Aggregate7 Resin2 [%] [%] [%] EPO] [%] Phenyl 650S61.6 97.5 2.5 0.083 0 Phenyl 650M 65.1 93.6 6.4 0 1EPO-PEG (85.1% EPO-PEG3 and 14.9% EPO-PEG2 (Table 7). 2Tosohaas Phenyl chromatography resins. 3The step yield was calculated as the ratio of EPO-PEG protein recovered after HIC chromatography (combined fractions) versus the amount of EPO-PEG injected onto the column. 4The percent of EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)3 in the main product peak. 5The percent of EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)2 in the main product peak. 6The amount of MBP protein contained in the main product peak as determine by ELISA versus the amount of EPO-PEG protein. 7The amount of aggregate EPO-PEG in the product peak observed by SEC. - The
Phenyl 650S (35 micron bead size) chromatography step was compared with Phenyl 650M (65 micron bead size) using standard purification conditions (Buffer A: 25 mM sodium phosphate, pH 7.5. Buffer B: 25 mM sodium phosphate, 0.6M sodium sulfate, pH 7.5 (0.05 mg EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)1-4/mL resin loaded). Comparison of the resulting elution profiles showed thatPhenyl 650S has a better resolution between EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)2 and EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)3. Comparison of the respective EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)3 peak pools by SDS-PAGE showed similar purity except that thePhenyl 650S purified material appears to have less EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)4. Analysis by RP-HPLC showed a EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)3 to EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)2 ratio of 96.3:3.7 forPhenyl 650S and a ratio of 93.6:6.4 for the Phenyl 650M purification. - The total system and column pressure measurements show the average pressure throughout the Phenyl 650M purification was approximately 0.12 mPa, while the
Phenyl 650S pressure was approximately 0.29 mPa. - EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)3 purification using Phenyl Sepharose HP (34 micron beads size) was performed using standard purification conditions (Buffer A: 25 mM sodium phosphate, pH 7.5. Buffer B: 25 mM sodium phosphate, 0.6M sodium sulfate, pH 7.5, with 0.05 mg EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)1-4/mL resin loaded. The elution profile showed no actual resolution between EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)i, EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)2, EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)3 and EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)4 (chromatogram not shown). Since there was no resolution between the various PEG states no analysis was performed on the eluted material.
- In order to further purify glycoPEGylated EPO from a glycoPEGylation reaction mixture, and to separate the trifunctionalized EPO species [EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)3] from other PEGylated species (e.g., mono-, di- and tetra-PEGylated EPO species), the mixture (e.g., flowthrough from an anion chromatography medium) is subjected to hydrophobic interaction chromatography (HIC). An exemplary HIC procedure is outlined below: An XK26 column was packed with
Phenyl 650S resin (106 mL, 2.6 cm×20 cm) and attached to anAKTA Explorer 100 system. Product elution was monitored by absorbance at 214, 254 and 280 nm. The column was equilibrated with 5 column volumes (CV) of Buffer B (25 mM sodium phosphate, 0.6 M sodium sulfate, pH 7.5). - The solution of Sartobind Q purified EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)1-4 (62 mL, pH 6.94, 2.59 mS/cm) was adjusted to 0.6 M sodium sulfate by dilution with 62 mL of 1.2 M of buffer (1.2 M sodium sulfate, 25 mM sodium phosphate, pH 7.5). This solution (124 mL) was injected on the column. The ratio of EPO-PEG to resin upon injection onto the column was 0.18 mg EPO protein per mL of resin in the column. Any unbound material was washed from the column using 5 CV of Buffer B (25 mM sodium phosphate, 0.6 M sodium sulfate, pH 7.5). The EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)3 was eluted from the column using the following gradient elution procedure using Buffer A (25 mM sodium phosphate, pH 7.5). Gradient: 100-60% Buffer B over 2 CV, hold for 1 CV, 60-35% Buffer B over 13 CV (gradient change 1.92% Buffer B/CV), hold 1 CV and then 0% Buffer B for 5 CV. The equilibration, load and wash steps were performed at a flow rate of 8 mL/min (90 cm/hr).
- Flow through and wash fractions were collected in a 1 L Nalgene container and individual elution fractions (12 mL) were collected in 14 mL Falcon tubes. The elution profile and fraction indicators are shown in
FIGS. 2A and 2B . Fractions were combined, the buffer was exchanged and the pool was concentrated using Pellicon-2XL 50 cm2. The pooled fractions containing the EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)3 (pool F) were analyzed for protein content (BCA, UV), identity (SDS-PAGE), glycosyltransferases (MBP-ELISA), purity and EPO-PEG forms (RP-HPLC), aggregation and purity (SEC) and endotoxin. Results are summarized in Table 7, below: -
TABLE 7 Results from the Large Scale Purification of EPO- PEG using Phenyl 650S Chromatography Step EPO- EPO- MBP6 Amount Yield3 PEG3 4 PEG2 5 [mcg/mg Process Step Injected2 [%[ [%[ [%[ EPO] Sartobind Q FT8 NA9 94.2 86.6 13.4 0.69 EPO-PEG3 18 mg 79.3 96.4 3.6 <0.0196 Phenyl 650SFraction10 2Amount of EPO protein determined by A280. 3The step yield was calculated as the ratio of EPO-PEG protein recovered after HIC chromatography (combined fractions) versus the EPO-PEG injected onto the column. 4The percent of EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)3 in the main product peak. 5The percent of EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)2 in the main product peak. 6The amount of MBP protein contained in the main product peak as determine by ELISA versus the amount of EPO-PEG protein. 7The amount of aggregate EPO-PEG in the product peak observed by SEC. 8EPO-PEG filtered through a Sartobind Q resin. 9Not available. 10Combined fractions of the main product peak after chromatography using optimized conditions on a Phenyl 650S resin. -
Phenyl 650S Chromatography was scaled up from a 0.8 mg EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)1-4 load (15.7 mL column) to a 22.4 mg load (106 mL column). The standard conditions were used except the amount of material loaded on the column was increased from 0.05 to 0.2 mg EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)1-4/mL resin. The EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)3 peak was pooled as shown inFIG. 2B resulting in a 408 mL peak pool (3.85 CV). Prior to concentration 16.1 mg EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)3 was recovered (72%) with 5.7% EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)2 remaining from the original 14.9% EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)2 in the load material. Concentration and diafiltration into 10 mM sodium acetate, 150 mM NaCl, pH 5.4 using a Pellicon-2XL 50 cm2 yielded a 95% recovery. - This example summarizes the results obtained with a 3 chromatography step (and two ultrafiltration/diafilatration (UF/DF) steps) purification process for the isolation of baculoviral derived, glycoPEGylated human erythropoietin EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)3 (see, description of EPO-PEG conjugates in Example 1, above) at a 20 mg scale. Overall process efficiency and product quality were assessed.
- The purification process (see e.g.,
FIG. 1 ) began with a Sartobind Q membrane used in a negative binding mode which allowed the PEG-EPO conjugates to flow through while capturing glycoPEGylation enzymes, such as MBP-GnT1, MBP-GalT1, MBP-SBD-ST3Gal3 and other enzyme contaminants. The various PEG species generated in the glycoPEGylation reaction were then fractionated using HIC on aPhenyl 650S resin (also compare Example 1), which enriched the EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)3 to a concentration of >96% (step yield approximately 75%). Tangential flow filtration (TFF, ultrafiltration/diafiltration) employing regenerated cellulose (10 kDa MWCO) membranes, was used to concentrate and reduce the conductivity of the HIC elution pool. Cation exchangechromatography using Source 15S was then employed to remove remaining host cell proteins and to further enrich the EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)3 to a concentration of greater than 97% (80% step yield). Finally, TFF with regenerated cellulose, 10 kDa MWCO membranes was used to concentrate and change the buffer for storage of the bulk product. 6.7 mg of purified EPO-PEG conjugate was obtained, which corresponds to an overall yield of 56% for the purification process (after correction for sampling and small-scale side experiments). Process parameters are summarized in Table 8, below: -
TABLE 8 Summary of Process Steps and Analytical Results Total Total Protein RP-HPLC mcg MBP/mg Process Step Protein Load Recovery Step Recovery (% Tri/Di PEG) PEG-EPO PEGylation ~25 mg1 21.7 mg 2100% 83/17 138.58 Reaction Mixture Sartobind Q 20.9 mg2 19.7 mg2 94% 86.6/13.43 0.69 Phenyl 650S15.25 mg2 11.1 mg4 73%5 — — TFF 11.02 mg4 12.1 mg4 110% 96.4/3.6 <0.0196 Source 15S10 mg4 7.93 mg3 79% 97.1/2.9 — TFF 7.89 mg4 7.75 mg4 98% — — 0.2um syringe 6.95 mg4 6.69 mg4 96% — <0.0196 Filtration6 Total Process 56% Recovery The overall process pool was reduced by sampling and/or for side experiments at each step. 1Protein concentration was determined by BCA relative to BSA standard prior to initial buffer exchange. 2Protein concentration determined by RP-HPLC. 3GlycoPEGylation reaction continued slightly after the original RP-HPLC analysis while the sample was awaiting purification of Sartoind Q (<1 hour) 4Protein concentration determined by A280 (extinction coefficient 1.24) 5Actual protein concentration is too low for accurate measurement by A280 (0.025 mg/mL). Two step recovery ( Phenyl 650S + TFF) = 79%6A small percentage (2.2%) of the final filtration volume was held up in the sterile filter. - At each chromatography step the PEG-EPO product pool was analyzed by SDS-PAGE, RP-HPLC for PEG-state and MBP ELISA to track the removal of enzyme related contaminants. The resulting EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)3 product was subjected to available drug product release tests. The purity was found to be greater than 99% by HPLC (combined glycoforms). The concentration of EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)3 in the final composition was 96.9%. The concentration of EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)2 was 2.5% and the concentration of EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)4 was 0.6%. Other EPO-PEG glycoforms were not detected in the final composition. There was less than 1% aggregate by SEC.
- Human EPO intermediate protein (produced by Baculovirus fermentation and purified) was stored frozen in 20 mM HEPES, pH 7.5 at −20° C. at a concentration of 1.29 mg/mL as determined by BCA assay. MBP-GnT1 was stored frozen in 50 mM Tris, pH 7.0, 138 mM NaCl at −20° C. The reported activity assay value of 0.5 U/mL was used. RP-HPLC analysis determined the protein concentration to be 0.3 mg/mL. MBP-GalT1 was stored frozen in 20 mM HEPES, pH 7.5, 200 mM NaCl at −20° C. The activity was reported to be 15 U/mL, with a protein concentration of 1.0 mg/mL as determined by RP-HPLC. MBP-SBD-ST3Gal3 was stored frozen in 20 mM HEPES, pH 7.0 at −20° C. The reported activity was 2.05 U/mL and the protein concentration was measured to be 1.06 mg/mL by BCA assay. UDP-GlcNAc and UDP-Gal were prepared as 60 mg/mL stock solutions in 100 mM HEPES, pH 7.0, 20 mM NaCl, 0.02% NaN3 immediately prior to use. CMP-SA-PEG-10 kDa was prepared as a 200 mg/mL stock solution in 100 mM HEPES, pH 7.0, 20 mM NaCl, 0.02% NaN3 immediately prior to use.
- Preparation and Analysis of 25 mg EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)3 Reaction
- EPO intermediate protein (25 mg, 19.4 mL, 1.25 micromoles by BCA assay) was concentrated to a volume of 1.0 mL in a Centricon Plus-20 centrifugal filter (5 kDa MWCO) and then diluted with 15 mL of 100 mM HEPES, pH 7.0, 20 mM NaCl, 0.02% NaN3. The EPO solution was concentrated to 0.94 mL (26.7 mg/mL). MBP-SBD-ST3Gal3 (3.05 mL, 6.25 U) was diluted with 13 mL of 100 mM HEPES, pH 7.0, 20 mM NaCl, 0.02% NaN3 in another Centricon Plus-20 centrifugal filter (5 kDa MWCO) and was concentrated to 0.51 mL (12.3 U/mL). The UDP-GlcNAc (25 micromoles, 0.27 mL) and UDP-Gal (25 micromoles, 0.25 mL) stock solutions (both at 60 mg/mL in 100 mM HEPES, pH 7.0, 20 mM NaCl, 0.02% NaN3), MBP-GnT1 (0.5 mL, 0.25 U), MBP-GalT1 (0.33 mL, 5 U), the concentrated MBP-SBD-ST3Gal3 (0.51 mL of 12.3 U/mL, 6.25 U, from above), CMP-SA-PEG-10 kDa (25 micromole, 1.25 mL of 200 mg/mL solution in 100 mM HEPES, pH 7.0, 20 mM NaCl, 0.02% NaN3) and MnCl2 (5 mM, 0.104 mL of 200 mM solution in water) were combined. Additional 100 mM HEPES, pH 7.0, 20 mM NaCl, 0.02% NaN3 buffer was added (1.0 mL) to bring the total volume to 4.17 mL. The reaction was incubated at 32° C. for 2 hrs without shaking The conversion yield of EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)3 was determined by SDS-PAGE and C3 RP-HPLC (compare
FIG. 4A ). The reaction mixture was immediately purified on a Sartobind Q cartridge as described below. - A Sartobind Q SingleSep Nano (1 mL) cartridge was attached to an AKTA
-
Explorer 100 system continuously monitoring absorbance at 214, 254 and 280 nm. The cartridge was flushed with 20 mM HEPES, 1 M NaCl, pH 7.0 (approximately 100 mL), followed by 20 mM HEPES, 20 mM NaCl, pH 7.0 (approximately 100 mL) both at a flow rate of 15 mL/min. The PEG-EPO reaction mixture (approximately 25 mg, 6 mg/mL, 4.2 mL) was diluted with 20 mM HEPES, 20 mM NaCl, pH 7.0 (22.8 mL) to a final volume of 27 mL. A 1 mL aliquot was retained for analysis and the concentration was determined to be 0.804 mg/mL by RP-HPLC. The remaining diluted sample (26 mL, 20.9 mg by RP-HPLC) was loaded on to the capsule and washed with 20 mM HEPES, 20 mM NaCl, pH 7.0 (70 mL) at a flow rate of 15 mL/min. - Fractions were combined into a PEG-EPO product pool (80 mL). Samples of the pools and selected individual fractions across the flow through/wash product peak were analyzed by SDS-PAGE with iodine and nd silver stain. The conjugate recovery for this step (94%) was determined by RP-HPLC (Table 8).
- The PEG-EPO pool was analyzed by MBP-ELISA for residual enzyme contaminants (Table 8) and then divided into two portions: The majority fraction (62 mL, 15.25 mg) was purified by HIC chromatography on
Phenyl 650S resin as described below. A small sample (18 mL, 4.4 mg) was purified by an alternate process including Fluoroapatite chromatography. - Bound impurities were eluted from the column with 20 mM HEPES, 1 M NaCl, pH 7.0 (13 mL) at a flow rate of 15 mL/min.
- Isolation of EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)3 from the Sartobind Q Flow Through/Wash Pool using HIC (
Phenyl 650S) - An XK26 column was packed with
Phenyl 650S resin (106 mL, 2.6 cm×20 cm) as described herein above and was attached to anAKTA Explorer 100 system continuously monitoring absorbance at 214, 254 and 280 nm. The column was equilibrated with 5 column volumes (CV) 25 mM sodium phosphate, 0.6M sodium sulfate, pH 7.5 (212 mL). The Sartobind Q PEG-EPO product pool (62 mL, 18 mg, 0.17 mg PEG-EPO/mL resin, pH 6.94, 2.59 mS/cm) was diluted 1:1 with 1.2 M sodium sulfate, 25 mM sodium phosphate pH 7.5 (62 mL) to adjust the sodium sulfate concentration to 0.6 M. The conditioned sample (124 mL) was applied to the column. Unbound material was washed from the column using 5 CV of 25 mM sodium phosphate, 0.6M sodium sulfate, pH 7.5 (212 mL) at a flow rate of 8 mL/min (90 cm/hr). The PEG-EPO species were fractionated and eluted with the following gradient using Buffer A (25 mM sodium phosphate, pH 7.5) and Buffer B (25 mM sodium phosphate, 0.6M sodium sulfate, pH 7.5) at 8 mL/min (90 cm/hr): 100-60% B over 2 CV, isocratic hold at 60% B for 1 CV, 60-35% B over 13 CV (gradient change 1.92% B/CV), isocratic hold at 35% B for 1 CV, 35-0% B over 1 CV and 0% B for 5 CV. The flow through and wash fraction were collected in the bottle from a 1 L Nalgene filter unit and 12 mL elution fractions were collected in 14 mL Falcon tubes. Individual fractions were analyzed by SDS-PAGE. Fractions enriched in EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)3 were combined (after storage at 4° C. for about 36 hours). Fractions from other PEG-EPO species and elution peaks were also pooled. The fraction pools were analyzed by SDS-PAGE. The dilute EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)3 Pool (444 mL) was analyzed by A280 (0.025 mg/mL, 11.1 mg) and the step recovery was determined to be 73% (Table 1). This product pool was buffer exchanged and concentrated using Pellicon-2 XL regenerated cellulose membranes. The remaining 10 mg of material (19.44 mL) was held on ice prior to further purification by cation exchange chromatography on aSource 15S resin later the same day as described below. - Purification of the Concentrated and
Diafiltered Phenyl 650S EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)3 Pool onSource 15S Chromatography - A
Tricorn 10 column was packed withSource 15S (15.7 mL, 1 cm×20 cm) and attached to anAKTA Explorer 100 system continuously monitoring absorbance at 214, 254 and 280 nm. The column was equilibrated with 5 column volumes (CV) 10 mM Na acetate, pH 5.4 (Buffer A). The concentrated anddiafiltered Phenyl 650S EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)3 pool (10 mg PEG-EPO, 19.44 mL, pH 5.4, conductivity: 1.54 mS/cm) was divided into two equal portions which were purified on the prepared column in two separate but identical injections. Half of thediafiltered Phenyl 650S EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)3 product pool (5 mg PEG-EPO, 9.72 mL each, 0.32 mg PEG-EPO/mL resin) was applied to the column at a flow rate of 300 cm/h (1.96 mL/min). Unbound material was washed from the column using 5 CV of 10 mM Na acetate, pH 5.4 (Buffer A). The EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)3 was eluted with the following gradient with Buffer B (0.5 M NaCl, 10 mM Na acetate, pH 5.4): 0-30% B over 24 CV, isocratic hold at 30% B for 1 CV, step to 100% B for 5 CV. All steps were performed at 300 cm/h (1.96 mL/min). Fractions (1.6 mL) were collected in 96-deep well microtiter plates and stored at 4° C. Fractions from both injections were pooled. Protein content analysis (A280) of the EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)3 pool indicated that the step recovery over theSource 15S chromatography step was 79% (Table 8). RP-HPLC analysis of the product pool indicated that the EPO-(SA-PEG-10 kDa)2 impurity had been reduced to 2.9% (Table 8). The product pool had an estimated sodium chloride concentration of approximately 70 mM and was concentrated and buffer exchanged. TheSource 15S Flow Through/Wash pool was electroblotted onto PVDF membranes and subjected to Edman amino-terminal sequencing as described herein to determine the identity of the major band in the pool. The amino-terminal sequence obtained was determined to be EPO. - It is understood that the examples and embodiments described herein are for illustrative purposes only and that various modifications or changes in light thereof will be suggested to persons skilled in the art and are to be included within the spirit and purview of this application and scope of the appended claims. All publications, patents, and patent applications cited herein are hereby incorporated by reference in their entirety for all purposes.
Claims (28)
Priority Applications (1)
Application Number | Priority Date | Filing Date | Title |
---|---|---|---|
US12/444,380 US20100075375A1 (en) | 2006-10-03 | 2007-10-03 | Methods for the purification of polypeptide conjugates |
Applications Claiming Priority (9)
Application Number | Priority Date | Filing Date | Title |
---|---|---|---|
US84896906P | 2006-10-03 | 2006-10-03 | |
US86411706P | 2006-11-02 | 2006-11-02 | |
US86805706P | 2006-11-30 | 2006-11-30 | |
US88751707P | 2007-01-31 | 2007-01-31 | |
US95115907P | 2007-07-20 | 2007-07-20 | |
US95500107P | 2007-08-09 | 2007-08-09 | |
US95646807P | 2007-08-17 | 2007-08-17 | |
PCT/US2007/080353 WO2008057683A2 (en) | 2006-10-03 | 2007-10-03 | Methods for the purification of polypeptide conjugates |
US12/444,380 US20100075375A1 (en) | 2006-10-03 | 2007-10-03 | Methods for the purification of polypeptide conjugates |
Related Parent Applications (1)
Application Number | Title | Priority Date | Filing Date |
---|---|---|---|
PCT/US2007/080353 A-371-Of-International WO2008057683A2 (en) | 2006-10-03 | 2007-10-03 | Methods for the purification of polypeptide conjugates |
Related Child Applications (1)
Application Number | Title | Priority Date | Filing Date |
---|---|---|---|
US12/418,530 Continuation US20100035299A1 (en) | 2006-10-03 | 2009-04-03 | Methods for the purification of polypeptide conjugates |
Publications (1)
Publication Number | Publication Date |
---|---|
US20100075375A1 true US20100075375A1 (en) | 2010-03-25 |
Family
ID=39365174
Family Applications (3)
Application Number | Title | Priority Date | Filing Date |
---|---|---|---|
US12/444,380 Abandoned US20100075375A1 (en) | 2006-10-03 | 2007-10-03 | Methods for the purification of polypeptide conjugates |
US11/866,969 Expired - Fee Related US8969532B2 (en) | 2006-10-03 | 2007-10-03 | Methods for the purification of polypeptide conjugates comprising polyalkylene oxide using hydrophobic interaction chromatography |
US12/418,530 Abandoned US20100035299A1 (en) | 2006-10-03 | 2009-04-03 | Methods for the purification of polypeptide conjugates |
Family Applications After (2)
Application Number | Title | Priority Date | Filing Date |
---|---|---|---|
US11/866,969 Expired - Fee Related US8969532B2 (en) | 2006-10-03 | 2007-10-03 | Methods for the purification of polypeptide conjugates comprising polyalkylene oxide using hydrophobic interaction chromatography |
US12/418,530 Abandoned US20100035299A1 (en) | 2006-10-03 | 2009-04-03 | Methods for the purification of polypeptide conjugates |
Country Status (5)
Country | Link |
---|---|
US (3) | US20100075375A1 (en) |
EP (1) | EP2054521A4 (en) |
JP (1) | JP2010505874A (en) |
IL (1) | IL197765A0 (en) |
WO (1) | WO2008057683A2 (en) |
Cited By (44)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
US20040063911A1 (en) * | 2001-10-10 | 2004-04-01 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Protein remodeling methods and proteins/peptides produced by the methods |
US20060287224A1 (en) * | 2003-11-24 | 2006-12-21 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Glycopegylated erythropoietin formulations |
US20070032405A1 (en) * | 2003-03-14 | 2007-02-08 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Branched water-soluble polymers and their conjugates |
US20070059275A1 (en) * | 2003-07-25 | 2007-03-15 | Defrees Shawn | Antibody toxin conjugates |
US20070254836A1 (en) * | 2003-12-03 | 2007-11-01 | Defrees Shawn | Glycopegylated Granulocyte Colony Stimulating Factor |
US20080050772A1 (en) * | 2001-10-10 | 2008-02-28 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Granulocyte colony stimulating factor: remodeling and glycoconjugation of G-CSF |
US20080102083A1 (en) * | 2003-05-09 | 2008-05-01 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Compositions and Methods for the Preparation of Human Growth Hormone Glycosylation Mutants |
US20080146782A1 (en) * | 2006-10-04 | 2008-06-19 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Glycerol linked pegylated sugars and glycopeptides |
US20080176790A1 (en) * | 2004-10-29 | 2008-07-24 | Defrees Shawn | Remodeling and Glycopegylation of Fibroblast Growth Factor (Fgf) |
US20080242846A1 (en) * | 2004-01-08 | 2008-10-02 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | O-linked glycosylation of peptides |
US20080255040A1 (en) * | 2006-07-21 | 2008-10-16 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Glycosylation of peptides via o-linked glycosylation sequences |
US20080300175A1 (en) * | 2003-11-24 | 2008-12-04 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Glycopegylated erythropoietin |
US20080305992A1 (en) * | 2003-11-24 | 2008-12-11 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Glycopegylated erythropoietin |
US20090000924A1 (en) * | 2007-06-29 | 2009-01-01 | Harley-Davidson Motor Company Group, Inc. | Integrated ignition and key switch |
US20090028822A1 (en) * | 2004-09-10 | 2009-01-29 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Glycopegylated Interferon Alpha |
US20090048440A1 (en) * | 2005-11-03 | 2009-02-19 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Nucleotide Sugar Purification Using Membranes |
US20090143292A1 (en) * | 2007-08-29 | 2009-06-04 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Liquid Formulation of G-CSF Conjugate |
US20090203579A1 (en) * | 2005-01-10 | 2009-08-13 | Defrees Shawn | Glycopegylated Granulocyte Colony Stimulating Factor |
US20090227504A1 (en) * | 2002-06-21 | 2009-09-10 | Novo Nordisk A/S | Pegylated Factor VII Glycoforms |
US20090292110A1 (en) * | 2004-07-23 | 2009-11-26 | Defrees Shawn | Enzymatic modification of glycopeptides |
US20100009902A1 (en) * | 2005-01-06 | 2010-01-14 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Glycoconjugation Using Saccharyl Fragments |
US20100120666A1 (en) * | 2007-04-03 | 2010-05-13 | Biogenerix Ag | Methods of treatment using glycopegylated g-csf |
US20100261872A1 (en) * | 2001-10-10 | 2010-10-14 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Factor VIII: remodeling and glycoconjugation of factor VIII |
US20100286067A1 (en) * | 2008-01-08 | 2010-11-11 | Biogenerix Ag | Glycoconjugation of polypeptides using oligosaccharyltransferases |
US20110003744A1 (en) * | 2005-05-25 | 2011-01-06 | Novo Nordisk A/S | Glycopegylated Erythropoietin Formulations |
US7956032B2 (en) | 2003-12-03 | 2011-06-07 | Novo Nordisk A/S | Glycopegylated granulocyte colony stimulating factor |
US20110166332A1 (en) * | 2008-09-12 | 2011-07-07 | Ge Healthcare Bio-Sciences Ab | Enhanced antibody aggregate removal with capto adhere in the presence of protein-excluded zwitterions |
US20110177029A1 (en) * | 2007-06-04 | 2011-07-21 | Novo Nordisk A/S | O-linked glycosylation using n-acetylglucosaminyl transferases |
US8008252B2 (en) | 2001-10-10 | 2011-08-30 | Novo Nordisk A/S | Factor VII: remodeling and glycoconjugation of Factor VII |
US8063015B2 (en) | 2003-04-09 | 2011-11-22 | Novo Nordisk A/S | Glycopegylation methods and proteins/peptides produced by the methods |
US8404809B2 (en) | 2005-05-25 | 2013-03-26 | Novo Nordisk A/S | Glycopegylated factor IX |
US8633157B2 (en) | 2003-11-24 | 2014-01-21 | Novo Nordisk A/S | Glycopegylated erythropoietin |
US8632770B2 (en) | 2003-12-03 | 2014-01-21 | Novo Nordisk A/S | Glycopegylated factor IX |
US8716240B2 (en) | 2001-10-10 | 2014-05-06 | Novo Nordisk A/S | Erythropoietin: remodeling and glycoconjugation of erythropoietin |
US8791066B2 (en) | 2004-07-13 | 2014-07-29 | Novo Nordisk A/S | Branched PEG remodeling and glycosylation of glucagon-like peptide-1 [GLP-1] |
US8791070B2 (en) | 2003-04-09 | 2014-07-29 | Novo Nordisk A/S | Glycopegylated factor IX |
US8911967B2 (en) | 2005-08-19 | 2014-12-16 | Novo Nordisk A/S | One pot desialylation and glycopegylation of therapeutic peptides |
US8969532B2 (en) | 2006-10-03 | 2015-03-03 | Novo Nordisk A/S | Methods for the purification of polypeptide conjugates comprising polyalkylene oxide using hydrophobic interaction chromatography |
US9150848B2 (en) | 2008-02-27 | 2015-10-06 | Novo Nordisk A/S | Conjugated factor VIII molecules |
US9169331B2 (en) | 2012-12-21 | 2015-10-27 | Dionex Corporation | Separation of glycans by mixed-mode liquid chromatography |
US9187546B2 (en) | 2005-04-08 | 2015-11-17 | Novo Nordisk A/S | Compositions and methods for the preparation of protease resistant human growth hormone glycosylation mutants |
US9310344B2 (en) | 2013-06-14 | 2016-04-12 | Dionex Corporation | HILIC/anion-exchange/cation-exchange multimodal media |
US9488625B2 (en) | 2010-12-15 | 2016-11-08 | Baxalta GmbH | Purification of factor VIII using a conductivity gradient |
US9493499B2 (en) | 2007-06-12 | 2016-11-15 | Novo Nordisk A/S | Process for the production of purified cytidinemonophosphate-sialic acid-polyalkylene oxide (CMP-SA-PEG) as modified nucleotide sugars via anion exchange chromatography |
Families Citing this family (57)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
DE60142239D1 (en) | 2000-08-11 | 2010-07-08 | Kyowa Hakko Kirin Co Ltd | PHOSPHORIC ACID METABOLISM, CALZIUM METABOLISM, CALIBRATION, AND VITAMIN D-METABOLISM CONTROLLING POLYPEPTIDES, AND FOR THESE ENCODING DNA MOLECULES |
DE602005023429D1 (en) | 2004-10-19 | 2010-10-21 | Lonza Ag | PROCESS FOR SOLID PHASE PEPTIDE SYNTHESIS |
SI1928503T1 (en) | 2005-08-24 | 2012-11-30 | Immunogen Inc | Process for preparing maytansinoid antibody conjugates |
ES2521490T3 (en) | 2006-12-15 | 2014-11-12 | Baxter International Inc. | Conjugate of factor VIIa - (poly) sialic acid with a prolonged half-life in vivo. |
US7883705B2 (en) | 2007-02-14 | 2011-02-08 | Kyowa Hakko Kirin Co., Ltd. | Anti FGF23 antibody and a pharmaceutical composition comprising the same |
FR2920429B1 (en) * | 2007-08-30 | 2012-10-05 | Lfb Biotechnologies | PROCESS FOR PURIFYING FACTOR VIII AND VON WILLEBRAND FACTOR |
JOP20190083A1 (en) | 2008-06-04 | 2017-06-16 | Amgen Inc | Fgf21 mutant fusion polypeptides and uses thereof |
RS59232B1 (en) | 2008-08-14 | 2019-10-31 | Genentech Inc | Methods for removing a contaminant using indigenous protein displacement ion exchange membrane chromatography |
EA201990619A1 (en) | 2008-10-10 | 2019-07-31 | Амген Инк. | FGF21 MUTANTS AND THEIR APPLICATION |
RU2526391C2 (en) * | 2009-02-19 | 2014-08-20 | Кселлия Фармасьютикалз Апс | Lipopeptide purification method |
UY32607A (en) | 2009-05-05 | 2010-12-31 | Amgen Inc | MUTANTS OF FGF21 AND USES OF THE SAME |
EP2427207B1 (en) | 2009-05-05 | 2017-08-16 | Amgen, Inc | Fgf21 mutants and uses thereof |
CN104984360A (en) | 2009-06-03 | 2015-10-21 | 伊缪诺金公司 | Conjugation methods |
JP2012530493A (en) * | 2009-06-17 | 2012-12-06 | アムジエン・インコーポレーテツド | Chimeric polypeptides and uses thereof |
US8642737B2 (en) | 2010-07-26 | 2014-02-04 | Baxter International Inc. | Nucleophilic catalysts for oxime linkage |
KR101832937B1 (en) | 2009-07-27 | 2018-02-28 | 박스알타 인코퍼레이티드 | Blood coagulation protein conjugates |
US8809501B2 (en) | 2009-07-27 | 2014-08-19 | Baxter International Inc. | Nucleophilic catalysts for oxime linkage |
SG10201401194VA (en) | 2009-07-27 | 2014-07-30 | Lipoxen Technologies Ltd | Glycopolysialylation of non-blood coagulation proteins |
ES2590679T3 (en) | 2009-07-27 | 2016-11-23 | Lipoxen Technologies Limited | Glycopolyallylation of proteins other than blood coagulation proteins |
TWI532495B (en) * | 2009-10-05 | 2016-05-11 | 菲瑞茵國際中心股份有限公司 | Pharmaceutical preparation |
MX2012006397A (en) * | 2009-12-02 | 2012-11-30 | Amgen Inc | Binding proteins that bind to human fgfr1c, human î²-klotho and both human fgfr1c and humanî²-klotho. |
UA109888C2 (en) | 2009-12-07 | 2015-10-26 | ANTIBODY OR ANTIBODILITY ANTIBODY OR ITS BINDING TO THE β-CLOTE, FGF RECEPTORS AND THEIR COMPLEXES | |
CA2796055A1 (en) | 2010-04-15 | 2011-10-20 | Amgen Inc. | Human fgf receptor and .beta.-klotho binding proteins |
ES2534936T3 (en) * | 2010-08-02 | 2015-04-30 | Ratiopharm Gmbh | Method for producing and purifying an active soluble sialyltransferase |
EA032056B1 (en) | 2010-12-22 | 2019-04-30 | Баксалта Инкорпорейтид | Conjugate of a therapeutic protein and a fatty acid derivative, methods of preparing a conjugate of a therapeutic protein and a fatty acid derivative (embodiments) |
KR102272828B1 (en) | 2011-03-29 | 2021-07-05 | 이뮤노젠 아이엔씨 | Preparation of maytansinoid antibody conjugates by a one-step process |
DE102011101995A1 (en) | 2011-05-19 | 2012-11-22 | Sartorius Stedim Biotech Gmbh | Process for separating a mixture of a protein and its reaction product with a polyalkylene glycol |
CN103827134A (en) * | 2011-07-20 | 2014-05-28 | 泽普泰恩股份有限公司 | Polypeptide separation methods |
LT2804623T (en) | 2012-01-12 | 2019-12-10 | Bioverativ Therapeutics Inc | Chimeric factor viii polypeptides and uses thereof |
WO2013123457A1 (en) | 2012-02-15 | 2013-08-22 | Biogen Idec Ma Inc. | Recombinant factor viii proteins |
RS63870B1 (en) | 2012-02-15 | 2023-01-31 | Bioverativ Therapeutics Inc | Factor viii compositions and methods of making and using same |
ES2770501T3 (en) * | 2012-07-11 | 2020-07-01 | Bioverativ Therapeutics Inc | Factor VIII complex with XTEN and Von Willebrand factor protein and its uses |
AU2013326881B2 (en) * | 2012-10-04 | 2018-08-02 | Immunogen, Inc. | Use of a PVDF membrane to purify cell-binding agent cytotoxic agent conjugates |
KR20140106448A (en) * | 2013-02-25 | 2014-09-03 | 에스케이케미칼주식회사 | Method for isolating and purifying a fusion protein comprising Factor VII |
US11229789B2 (en) | 2013-05-30 | 2022-01-25 | Neurostim Oab, Inc. | Neuro activator with controller |
CA2913074C (en) | 2013-05-30 | 2023-09-12 | Graham H. Creasey | Topical neurological stimulation |
EP3013365B1 (en) * | 2013-06-26 | 2019-06-05 | Academia Sinica | Rm2 antigens and use thereof |
TWI667255B (en) | 2013-08-14 | 2019-08-01 | 美商生物化學醫療公司 | Factor viii-xten fusions and uses thereof |
SG11201605242YA (en) | 2014-01-10 | 2016-07-28 | Biogen Ma Inc | Factor viii chimeric proteins and uses thereof |
TW201628649A (en) | 2014-10-09 | 2016-08-16 | 再生元醫藥公司 | Process for reducing subvisible particles in a pharmaceutical formulation |
US11077301B2 (en) | 2015-02-21 | 2021-08-03 | NeurostimOAB, Inc. | Topical nerve stimulator and sensor for bladder control |
EP3347049B1 (en) * | 2015-09-08 | 2024-07-03 | Waters Technologies Corporation | Multidimensional chromatography method for analysis of antibody-drug conjugates |
IL264631B2 (en) | 2016-08-16 | 2024-05-01 | Regeneron Pharma | Methods for quantitating individual antibodies from a mixture |
SG11201902667UA (en) | 2016-10-25 | 2019-05-30 | Regeneron Pharma | Methods and systems for chromatography data analysis |
JP2020511499A (en) | 2017-03-20 | 2020-04-16 | エフ.ホフマン−ラ ロシュ アーゲーF. Hoffmann−La Roche Aktiengesellschaft | Method for in vitro glycosylation of erythropoiesis stimulating proteins |
SG11202001564QA (en) | 2017-09-19 | 2020-04-29 | Regeneron Pharma | Methods of reducing particle formation and compositions formed thereby |
US10953225B2 (en) | 2017-11-07 | 2021-03-23 | Neurostim Oab, Inc. | Non-invasive nerve activator with adaptive circuit |
EP3731873B1 (en) * | 2017-12-29 | 2022-01-26 | F. Hoffmann-La Roche AG | Process for providing pegylated protein composition |
EP3731871B1 (en) * | 2017-12-29 | 2023-10-04 | F. Hoffmann-La Roche AG | Process for providing pegylated protein composition |
EP3731872B1 (en) * | 2017-12-29 | 2021-11-24 | F. Hoffmann-La Roche AG | Process for providing pegylated protein composition |
TW202015723A (en) | 2018-05-18 | 2020-05-01 | 美商百歐維拉提夫治療公司 | Methods of treating hemophilia a |
US11884698B2 (en) | 2018-07-02 | 2024-01-30 | Regeneron Pharmaceuticals, Inc. | Systems and methods for preparing a polypeptide from a mixture |
KR20220025834A (en) | 2019-06-26 | 2022-03-03 | 뉴로스팀 테크놀로지스 엘엘씨 | Non-invasive neural activators with adaptive circuits |
EP3996828A4 (en) * | 2019-07-09 | 2023-09-06 | Tanvex Biopharma Usa, Inc. | Temperature-controlled purification of granulocyte-colony stimulating factor |
KR20220115802A (en) | 2019-12-16 | 2022-08-18 | 뉴로스팀 테크놀로지스 엘엘씨 | Non-invasive neural activator with boost charge transfer function |
EP4267592A1 (en) * | 2020-12-23 | 2023-11-01 | Jazz Pharmaceuticals Ireland Ltd. | Methods of purifying charge-shielded fusion proteins |
WO2024145232A1 (en) * | 2022-12-30 | 2024-07-04 | Eli Lilly And Company | Methods of dulaglutide purification using hydrophobic interaction chromatography |
Citations (92)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
US4088538A (en) * | 1975-05-30 | 1978-05-09 | Battelle Memorial Institute | Reversibly precipitable immobilized enzyme complex and a method for its use |
US4385260A (en) * | 1975-09-09 | 1983-05-24 | Beckman Instruments, Inc. | Bargraph display |
US4438253A (en) * | 1982-11-12 | 1984-03-20 | American Cyanamid Company | Poly(glycolic acid)/poly(alkylene glycol) block copolymers and method of manufacturing the same |
US4496689A (en) * | 1983-12-27 | 1985-01-29 | Miles Laboratories, Inc. | Covalently attached complex of alpha-1-proteinase inhibitor with a water soluble polymer |
US4565653A (en) * | 1984-03-30 | 1986-01-21 | Pfizer Inc. | Acyltripeptide immunostimulants |
US4806595A (en) * | 1985-08-12 | 1989-02-21 | Koken Co., Ltd. | Method of preparing antithrombogenic medical materials |
US4826945A (en) * | 1987-06-09 | 1989-05-02 | Yissum Research Development Company | Biodegradable polymeric materials based on polyether glycols, processes for the preparation thereof and surgical articles made therefrom |
US4925796A (en) * | 1986-03-07 | 1990-05-15 | Massachusetts Institute Of Technology | Method for enhancing glycoprotein stability |
US5122614A (en) * | 1989-04-19 | 1992-06-16 | Enzon, Inc. | Active carbonates of polyalkylene oxides for modification of polypeptides |
US5182107A (en) * | 1989-09-07 | 1993-01-26 | Alkermes, Inc. | Transferrin receptor specific antibody-neuropharmaceutical or diagnostic agent conjugates |
US5194376A (en) * | 1989-02-28 | 1993-03-16 | University Of Ottawa | Baculovirus expression system capable of producing foreign gene proteins at high levels |
US5202413A (en) * | 1993-02-16 | 1993-04-13 | E. I. Du Pont De Nemours And Company | Alternating (ABA)N polylactide block copolymers |
US5219564A (en) * | 1990-07-06 | 1993-06-15 | Enzon, Inc. | Poly(alkylene oxide) amino acid copolymers and drug carriers and charged copolymers based thereon |
US5281698A (en) * | 1991-07-23 | 1994-01-25 | Cetus Oncology Corporation | Preparation of an activated polymer ester for protein conjugation |
US5324844A (en) * | 1989-04-19 | 1994-06-28 | Enzon, Inc. | Active carbonates of polyalkylene oxides for modification of polypeptides |
US5405753A (en) * | 1990-03-26 | 1995-04-11 | Brossmer; Reinhard | CMP-activated, fluorescing sialic acids, as well as processes for their preparation |
US5410016A (en) * | 1990-10-15 | 1995-04-25 | Board Of Regents, The University Of Texas System | Photopolymerizable biodegradable hydrogels as tissue contacting materials and controlled-release carriers |
US5492841A (en) * | 1994-02-18 | 1996-02-20 | E. I. Du Pont De Nemours And Company | Quaternary ammonium immunogenic conjugates and immunoassay reagents |
US5527527A (en) * | 1989-09-07 | 1996-06-18 | Alkermes, Inc. | Transferrin receptor specific antibody-neuropharmaceutical agent conjugates |
US5529914A (en) * | 1990-10-15 | 1996-06-25 | The Board Of Regents The Univeristy Of Texas System | Gels for encapsulation of biological materials |
US5605793A (en) * | 1994-02-17 | 1997-02-25 | Affymax Technologies N.V. | Methods for in vitro recombination |
US5614184A (en) * | 1992-07-28 | 1997-03-25 | New England Deaconess Hospital | Recombinant human erythropoietin mutants and therapeutic methods employing them |
US5621039A (en) * | 1993-06-08 | 1997-04-15 | Hallahan; Terrence W. | Factor IX- polymeric conjugates |
US5629384A (en) * | 1994-05-17 | 1997-05-13 | Consiglio Nazionale Delle Ricerche | Polymers of N-acryloylmorpholine activated at one end and conjugates with bioactive materials and surfaces |
US5635603A (en) * | 1993-12-08 | 1997-06-03 | Immunomedics, Inc. | Preparation and use of immunoconjugates |
US5705367A (en) * | 1994-09-26 | 1998-01-06 | The Rockefeller University | Glycosyltransferases for biosynthesis of oligosaccharides, and genes encoding them |
US5716812A (en) * | 1995-12-12 | 1998-02-10 | The University Of British Columbia | Methods and compositions for synthesis of oligosaccharides, and the products formed thereby |
US5728554A (en) * | 1995-04-11 | 1998-03-17 | Cytel Corporation | Enzymatic synthesis of glycosidic linkages |
US5770420A (en) * | 1995-09-08 | 1998-06-23 | The Regents Of The University Of Michigan | Methods and products for the synthesis of oligosaccharide structures on glycoproteins, glycolipids, or as free molecules, and for the isolation of cloned genetic sequences that determine these structures |
US5858751A (en) * | 1992-03-09 | 1999-01-12 | The Regents Of The University Of California | Compositions and methods for producing sialyltransferases |
US5876980A (en) * | 1995-04-11 | 1999-03-02 | Cytel Corporation | Enzymatic synthesis of oligosaccharides |
US6010999A (en) * | 1990-05-04 | 2000-01-04 | American Cyanamid Company | Stabilization of fibroblast growth factors by modification of cysteine residues |
US6015555A (en) * | 1995-05-19 | 2000-01-18 | Alkermes, Inc. | Transferrin receptor specific antibody-neuropharmaceutical or diagnostic agent conjugates |
US6030815A (en) * | 1995-04-11 | 2000-02-29 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Enzymatic synthesis of oligosaccharides |
US6037452A (en) * | 1992-04-10 | 2000-03-14 | Alpha Therapeutic Corporation | Poly(alkylene oxide)-Factor VIII or Factor IX conjugate |
US6057292A (en) * | 1995-09-21 | 2000-05-02 | Genentech, Inc. | Method for inhibiting growth hormone action |
US6183738B1 (en) * | 1997-05-12 | 2001-02-06 | Phoenix Pharamacologics, Inc. | Modified arginine deiminase |
US20020016003A1 (en) * | 2000-03-16 | 2002-02-07 | Eliana Saxon | Chemoselective ligation |
US6348558B1 (en) * | 1999-12-10 | 2002-02-19 | Shearwater Corporation | Hydrolytically degradable polymers and hydrogels made therefrom |
US6362254B2 (en) * | 1998-03-12 | 2002-03-26 | Shearwater Corporation | Poly(ethylene glycol) derivatives with proximal reactive groups |
US20020037841A1 (en) * | 2000-05-15 | 2002-03-28 | Apollon Papadimitriou | Erythropoietin composition |
US6376604B2 (en) * | 1999-12-22 | 2002-04-23 | Shearwater Corporation | Method for the preparation of 1-benzotriazolylcarbonate esters of poly(ethylene glycol) |
US6399337B1 (en) * | 1997-06-06 | 2002-06-04 | The Governors Of The University Of Alberta | α1,3-fucosyltransferase |
US6399336B1 (en) * | 1997-01-16 | 2002-06-04 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Practical in vitro sialylation of recombinant glycoproteins |
US20030027257A1 (en) * | 1997-08-21 | 2003-02-06 | University Technologies International, Inc. | Sequences for improving the efficiency of secretion of non-secreted protein from mammalian and insect cells |
US20030040037A1 (en) * | 2000-05-12 | 2003-02-27 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | In vitro modification of glycosylation patterns of recombinant glycopeptides |
US6531121B2 (en) * | 2000-12-29 | 2003-03-11 | The Kenneth S. Warren Institute, Inc. | Protection and enhancement of erythropoietin-responsive cells, tissues and organs |
US6555346B1 (en) * | 1997-12-18 | 2003-04-29 | Stichting Instituut Voor Dierhouderij En Diergezondheid | Protein expression in baculovirus vector expression systems |
US6692931B1 (en) * | 1998-11-16 | 2004-02-17 | Werner Reutter | Recombinant glycoproteins, method for the production thereof, medicaments containing said glycoproteins and use thereof |
US20040043446A1 (en) * | 2001-10-19 | 2004-03-04 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Alpha galalctosidase a: remodeling and glycoconjugation of alpha galactosidase A |
US20040063911A1 (en) * | 2001-10-10 | 2004-04-01 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Protein remodeling methods and proteins/peptides produced by the methods |
US6716626B1 (en) * | 1999-11-18 | 2004-04-06 | Chiron Corporation | Human FGF-21 nucleic acids |
US20040077836A1 (en) * | 2001-10-10 | 2004-04-22 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Granulocyte colony stimulating factor: remodeling and glycoconjugation of G-CSF |
US20040082026A1 (en) * | 2001-10-10 | 2004-04-29 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Interferon alpha: remodeling and glycoconjugation of interferon alpha |
US20040102607A1 (en) * | 1998-03-25 | 2004-05-27 | Danishefsky Samuel J. | Trimeric antigenic O-linked glycopeptide conjugates, methods of preparation and uses thereof |
US20040115168A1 (en) * | 2001-10-10 | 2004-06-17 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Interferon beta: remodeling and glycoconjugation of interferon beta |
US20050026266A1 (en) * | 2002-11-08 | 2005-02-03 | Glycozym Aps | Methods to identify agents modulating functions of polypeptide galnac-transferases, pharmaceutical compositions comprising such agents and the use of such agents for preparing medicaments |
US20050031584A1 (en) * | 2001-10-10 | 2005-02-10 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Interleukin-2:remodeling and glycoconjugation of interleukin-2 |
US20050064540A1 (en) * | 2002-11-27 | 2005-03-24 | Defrees Shawn Ph.D | Glycoprotein remodeling using endoglycanases |
US20050100982A1 (en) * | 2001-10-10 | 2005-05-12 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Factor IX: remodeling and glycoconjugation of factor IX |
US20050106658A1 (en) * | 2001-10-10 | 2005-05-19 | Defrees Shawn | Remodeling and glycoconjugation of peptides |
US20060024286A1 (en) * | 2004-08-02 | 2006-02-02 | Paul Glidden | Variants of tRNA synthetase fragments and uses thereof |
US20060030521A1 (en) * | 2001-11-28 | 2006-02-09 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Remodeling and glycoconjugation of peptides |
US20060035224A1 (en) * | 2002-03-21 | 2006-02-16 | Johansen Jack T | Purification methods for oligonucleotides and their analogs |
US20060111279A1 (en) * | 2003-11-24 | 2006-05-25 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Glycopegylated erythropoietin |
US7157277B2 (en) * | 2001-11-28 | 2007-01-02 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Factor VIII remodeling and glycoconjugation of Factor VIII |
US20070027068A1 (en) * | 2001-10-10 | 2007-02-01 | Defrees Shawn | Erythropoietin: remodeling and glycoconjugation of erythropoietin |
US20070032405A1 (en) * | 2003-03-14 | 2007-02-08 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Branched water-soluble polymers and their conjugates |
US20070059275A1 (en) * | 2003-07-25 | 2007-03-15 | Defrees Shawn | Antibody toxin conjugates |
US7214660B2 (en) * | 2001-10-10 | 2007-05-08 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Erythropoietin: remodeling and glycoconjugation of erythropoietin |
US20070105755A1 (en) * | 2005-10-26 | 2007-05-10 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | One pot desialylation and glycopegylation of therapeutic peptides |
US20080015142A1 (en) * | 2003-12-03 | 2008-01-17 | Defrees Shawn | Glycopegylated Follicle Stimulating Hormone |
US7338933B2 (en) * | 2004-01-08 | 2008-03-04 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | O-linked glycosylation of peptides |
US20080102083A1 (en) * | 2003-05-09 | 2008-05-01 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Compositions and Methods for the Preparation of Human Growth Hormone Glycosylation Mutants |
US7368108B2 (en) * | 2001-11-28 | 2008-05-06 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Glycopeptide remodeling using amidases |
US20080108557A1 (en) * | 2004-09-29 | 2008-05-08 | Novo Nordisk Healthcare A/G | Modified Proteins |
US20090028822A1 (en) * | 2004-09-10 | 2009-01-29 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Glycopegylated Interferon Alpha |
US20090048440A1 (en) * | 2005-11-03 | 2009-02-19 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Nucleotide Sugar Purification Using Membranes |
US20090055942A1 (en) * | 2005-09-14 | 2009-02-26 | Novo Nordisk Healthcare A/G | Human Coagulation Factor VII Polypeptides |
US20090053167A1 (en) * | 2007-05-14 | 2009-02-26 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | C-, S- and N-glycosylation of peptides |
US20090054623A1 (en) * | 2004-12-17 | 2009-02-26 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Lipo-Conjugation of Peptides |
US20090093399A1 (en) * | 2001-10-10 | 2009-04-09 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Glycopegylation methods and proteins/peptides produced by the methods |
US20090124544A1 (en) * | 2005-04-08 | 2009-05-14 | Neose Technologies ,Inc. A Delaware Corporation | Compositions and methods for the preparation of protease resistant human growth hormone glycosylation mutants |
US20100009902A1 (en) * | 2005-01-06 | 2010-01-14 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Glycoconjugation Using Saccharyl Fragments |
US20100015684A1 (en) * | 2001-10-10 | 2010-01-21 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Factor vii: remodeling and glycoconjugation of factor vii |
US20100028939A1 (en) * | 2003-08-08 | 2010-02-04 | Novo Nordisk Healthcare A/G | Use of Galactose Oxidase for Selective Chemical Conjugation of Protractor Molecules to Proteins of Therapeutic Interest |
US20100035299A1 (en) * | 2006-10-03 | 2010-02-11 | Novo Nordisk A/S | Methods for the purification of polypeptide conjugates |
US20100041872A1 (en) * | 2006-10-04 | 2010-02-18 | Defrees Shawn | Glycerol linked pegylated sugars and glycopeptides |
US20100048456A1 (en) * | 2003-04-09 | 2010-02-25 | Novo Nordisk A/S | Glycopegylation methods and proteins/peptides produced by the methods |
US20100056428A1 (en) * | 2006-09-01 | 2010-03-04 | Novo Nordisk Health Care Ag | Modified proteins |
US20100081791A1 (en) * | 2005-05-25 | 2010-04-01 | Novo Nordisk A/S | Glycopegylated factor ix |
US7691603B2 (en) * | 2003-04-09 | 2010-04-06 | Novo Nordisk A/S | Intracellular formation of peptide conjugates |
Family Cites Families (308)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
GB1479268A (en) | 1973-07-05 | 1977-07-13 | Beecham Group Ltd | Pharmaceutical compositions |
US4179337A (en) | 1973-07-20 | 1979-12-18 | Davis Frank F | Non-immunogenic polypeptides |
GB1451798A (en) | 1973-08-02 | 1976-10-06 | Ici Ltd | Prostanoic acid derivatives |
US4414147A (en) | 1981-04-17 | 1983-11-08 | Massachusetts Institute Of Technology | Methods of decreasing the hydrophobicity of fibroblast and other interferons |
JPS57206622A (en) | 1981-06-10 | 1982-12-18 | Ajinomoto Co Inc | Blood substitute |
US4451566A (en) | 1981-12-04 | 1984-05-29 | Spencer Donald B | Methods and apparatus for enzymatically producing ethanol |
EP0263533A3 (en) | 1983-03-01 | 1990-05-30 | C.R.C. Compagnia di Ricerca Chimica S.p.A. | A method for preparing the cytidine monophosphate of 5-acetamido-3,5-dideoxy-d-glycero-d-galactononulosaminic acid |
DE3308806A1 (en) | 1983-03-12 | 1984-09-13 | Basf Ag, 6700 Ludwigshafen | FUNGICIDAL AGENTS, SUBSTITUTED GLUCOPYRANOSYLAMINE AND METHOD FOR CONTROLLING FUNGI |
JPS59172425A (en) | 1983-03-18 | 1984-09-29 | Nippon Chemiphar Co Ltd | Novel blood coagulation factor derivative, its preparation and blood coagulation promoting agent containing the same |
US4879236A (en) | 1984-05-16 | 1989-11-07 | The Texas A&M University System | Method for producing a recombinant baculovirus expression vector |
US4675414A (en) | 1985-03-08 | 1987-06-23 | The United States Of America As Represented By The Secretary Of The Navy | Maleimidomethyl-carbonate polyethers |
GR860984B (en) | 1985-04-17 | 1986-08-18 | Zymogenetics Inc | Expression of factor vii and ix activities in mammalian cells |
US5206344A (en) | 1985-06-26 | 1993-04-27 | Cetus Oncology Corporation | Interleukin-2 muteins and polymer conjugation thereof |
EP0229108B1 (en) | 1985-06-26 | 1990-12-27 | Cetus Corporation | Solubilization of proteins for pharmaceutical compositions using polymer conjugation |
SE451849B (en) | 1985-12-11 | 1987-11-02 | Svenska Sockerfabriks Ab | VIEW TO SYNTHETIZE GYCLOSIDIC BINDINGS AND USE OF THIS RECEIVED PRODUCTS |
IT1213029B (en) | 1986-01-30 | 1989-12-07 | Bracco Ind Chimica Spa | PARAMAGNETIC METAL ION CHELATES. |
US4767702A (en) | 1986-02-06 | 1988-08-30 | Cohenford Menashi A | Paper strip assay for neisseria species |
US5272066A (en) | 1986-03-07 | 1993-12-21 | Massachusetts Institute Of Technology | Synthetic method for enhancing glycoprotein stability |
WO1987005330A1 (en) | 1986-03-07 | 1987-09-11 | Michel Louis Eugene Bergh | Method for enhancing glycoprotein stability |
US4902505A (en) | 1986-07-30 | 1990-02-20 | Alkermes | Chimeric peptides for neuropeptide delivery through the blood-brain barrier |
US5153265A (en) | 1988-01-20 | 1992-10-06 | Cetus Corporation | Conjugation of polymer to colony stimulating factor-1 |
US4847325A (en) | 1988-01-20 | 1989-07-11 | Cetus Corporation | Conjugation of polymer to colony stimulating factor-1 |
GB8810808D0 (en) | 1988-05-06 | 1988-06-08 | Wellcome Found | Vectors |
US5169933A (en) | 1988-08-15 | 1992-12-08 | Neorx Corporation | Covalently-linked complexes and methods for enhanced cytotoxicity and imaging |
US5874261A (en) | 1988-09-02 | 1999-02-23 | The Trustees Of The University Of Pennsylvania | Method for the purification of glycosyltransferases |
US5218092A (en) | 1988-09-29 | 1993-06-08 | Kyowa Hakko Kogyo Co., Ltd. | Modified granulocyte-colony stimulating factor polypeptide with added carbohydrate chains |
US5104651A (en) | 1988-12-16 | 1992-04-14 | Amgen Inc. | Stabilized hydrophobic protein formulations of g-csf |
US5047335A (en) | 1988-12-21 | 1991-09-10 | The Regents Of The University Of Calif. | Process for controlling intracellular glycosylation of proteins |
ATE135370T1 (en) | 1988-12-22 | 1996-03-15 | Kirin Amgen Inc | CHEMICALLY MODIFIED GRANULOCYTE COLONY EXCITING FACTOR |
US6166183A (en) | 1992-11-30 | 2000-12-26 | Kirin-Amgen, Inc. | Chemically-modified G-CSF |
DE68929551T2 (en) | 1988-12-23 | 2008-03-06 | Genentech, Inc., South San Francisco | Human DNase |
EP0454730A1 (en) | 1989-01-19 | 1991-11-06 | The Upjohn Company | Somatotropin analogs |
WO1990008823A1 (en) | 1989-01-31 | 1990-08-09 | The Upjohn Company | Somatotropin analogs |
US5059535A (en) | 1989-04-12 | 1991-10-22 | Chembiomed, Ltd. | Process for the separation and purification of sialyl transferases |
ES2247656T3 (en) | 1989-04-19 | 2006-03-01 | Enzon, Inc. | A PROCESS TO FORM A MODIFIED POLYPEPTIDE THAT INCLUDES A POLYPEPTIDE AND A POLYCHYLENE OXIDE. |
US5166322A (en) | 1989-04-21 | 1992-11-24 | Genetics Institute | Cysteine added variants of interleukin-3 and chemical modifications thereof |
US5342940A (en) | 1989-05-27 | 1994-08-30 | Sumitomo Pharmaceuticals Company, Limited | Polyethylene glycol derivatives, process for preparing the same |
US5672683A (en) | 1989-09-07 | 1997-09-30 | Alkermes, Inc. | Transferrin neuropharmaceutical agent fusion protein |
US5977307A (en) | 1989-09-07 | 1999-11-02 | Alkermes, Inc. | Transferrin receptor specific ligand-neuropharmaceutical agent fusion proteins |
US5154924A (en) | 1989-09-07 | 1992-10-13 | Alkermes, Inc. | Transferrin receptor specific antibody-neuropharmaceutical agent conjugates |
US5032519A (en) | 1989-10-24 | 1991-07-16 | The Regents Of The Univ. Of California | Method for producing secretable glycosyltransferases and other Golgi processing enzymes |
US5312808A (en) | 1989-11-22 | 1994-05-17 | Enzon, Inc. | Fractionation of polyalkylene oxide-conjugated hemoglobin solutions |
IL96477A0 (en) | 1989-12-01 | 1991-08-16 | Amgen Inc | Megakaryocyte production |
SE465222C5 (en) | 1989-12-15 | 1998-02-10 | Pharmacia & Upjohn Ab | A recombinant human factor VIII derivative and process for its preparation |
US5324663A (en) | 1990-02-14 | 1994-06-28 | The Regents Of The University Of Michigan | Methods and products for the synthesis of oligosaccharide structures on glycoproteins, glycolipids, or as free molecules, and for the isolation of cloned genetic sequences that determine these structures |
US5595900A (en) | 1990-02-14 | 1997-01-21 | The Regents Of The University Of Michigan | Methods and products for the synthesis of oligosaccharide structures on glycoproteins, glycolipids, or as free molecules, and for the isolation of cloned genetic sequences that determine these structures |
US5583042A (en) | 1990-04-16 | 1996-12-10 | Neose Pharmaceuticals, Inc. | Apparatus for the synthesis of saccharide compositions |
US5180674A (en) | 1990-04-16 | 1993-01-19 | The Trustees Of The University Of Pennsylvania | Saccharide compositions, methods and apparatus for their synthesis |
GB9107846D0 (en) | 1990-04-30 | 1991-05-29 | Ici Plc | Polypeptides |
US5399345A (en) | 1990-05-08 | 1995-03-21 | Boehringer Mannheim, Gmbh | Muteins of the granulocyte colony stimulating factor |
CU22302A1 (en) | 1990-09-07 | 1995-01-31 | Cigb | Codifying nucleotidic sequence for a protein of the external membrane of neisseria meningitidis and the use of that protein in preparing vaccines. |
SK386392A3 (en) | 1990-07-10 | 1994-08-10 | Boehringer Ingelheim Int | Interferon alpha |
DE4028800A1 (en) | 1990-09-11 | 1992-03-12 | Behringwerke Ag | GENETIC SIALYLATION OF GLYCOPROTEINS |
US5492821A (en) | 1990-11-14 | 1996-02-20 | Cargill, Inc. | Stabilized polyacrylic saccharide protein conjugates |
US5164374A (en) | 1990-12-17 | 1992-11-17 | Monsanto Company | Use of oligosaccharides for treatment of arthritis |
US5833982A (en) | 1991-02-28 | 1998-11-10 | Zymogenetics, Inc. | Modified factor VII |
US5861374A (en) | 1991-02-28 | 1999-01-19 | Novo Nordisk A/S | Modified Factor VII |
US5788965A (en) | 1991-02-28 | 1998-08-04 | Novo Nordisk A/S | Modified factor VII |
DE69233398D1 (en) | 1991-02-28 | 2004-09-16 | Novo Nordisk As | MODIFIED FACTOR VII |
WO1992016555A1 (en) | 1991-03-18 | 1992-10-01 | Enzon, Inc. | Hydrazine containing conjugates of polypeptides and glycopolypeptides with polymers |
CA2106301C (en) | 1991-03-18 | 1999-04-06 | Chi-Huey Wong | Oligosaccharide enzyme substrates and inhibitors: method and compositions |
US5278299A (en) | 1991-03-18 | 1994-01-11 | Scripps Clinic And Research Foundation | Method and composition for synthesizing sialylated glycosyl compounds |
US5212075A (en) | 1991-04-15 | 1993-05-18 | The Regents Of The University Of California | Compositions and methods for introducing effectors to pathogens and cells |
DE69231467T2 (en) | 1991-05-10 | 2001-01-25 | Genentech, Inc. | SELECTION OF AGONISTS AND ANTAGONISTS OF LIGANDS |
GB2256197B (en) | 1991-05-31 | 1995-11-22 | Ciba Geigy Ag | Yeast as host for expression of heterologous glycosyl transferase enzymes |
SE9201544L (en) | 1991-05-31 | 1992-12-01 | Ciba Geigy Ag | MAKE SUBSTANTIAL GYCOSYL TRANSFER PHASES |
US5352670A (en) | 1991-06-10 | 1994-10-04 | Alberta Research Council | Methods for the enzymatic synthesis of alpha-sialylated oligosaccharide glycosides |
US5374655A (en) | 1991-06-10 | 1994-12-20 | Alberta Research Council | Methods for the synthesis of monofucosylated oligosaccharides terminating in di-N-acetyllactosaminyl structures |
KR950014915B1 (en) | 1991-06-19 | 1995-12-18 | 주식회사녹십자 | Asialoglycoprotein-conjugated compounds |
EP0863154A1 (en) | 1991-10-12 | 1998-09-09 | The Regents Of The University Of California | Use of thiol redox proteins for reducing protein intramolecular disulfide bonds, for improving the quality of cereal products, dough and baked goods |
US6319695B1 (en) | 1991-10-15 | 2001-11-20 | The Scripps Research Insitute | Production of fucosylated carbohydrates by enzymatic fucosylation synthesis of sugar nucleotides; and in situ regeneration of GDP-fucose |
JP3426599B2 (en) | 1991-11-08 | 2003-07-14 | ヘモゾル インコーポレイテッド | Hemoglobin as a drug carrier |
US5384249A (en) | 1991-12-17 | 1995-01-24 | Kyowa Hakko Kogyo Co., Ltd. | α2→3 sialyltransferase |
IT1260468B (en) | 1992-01-29 | 1996-04-09 | METHOD FOR MAINTAINING THE ACTIVITY OF PROTEOLYTIC ENZYMES MODIFIED WITH POLYETHYLENGLYCOL | |
NZ251096A (en) | 1992-03-09 | 1996-03-26 | Univ California | Sialyltransferases and compositions and methods for their identification and synthesis |
US5962294A (en) | 1992-03-09 | 1999-10-05 | The Regents Of The University Of California | Compositions and methods for the identification and synthesis of sialyltransferases |
EP0586687A4 (en) | 1992-03-25 | 1996-04-17 | Univ New York | Trans-sialidase and methods of use and making thereof |
JPH0686684A (en) | 1992-05-26 | 1994-03-29 | Monsanto Co | Synthesis of sialo conjugation |
JPH08503125A (en) | 1992-08-07 | 1996-04-09 | プロジェニクス・ファーマスーティカルス・インコーポレーテッド | CD4-gamma2 and CD4-IgG2 immunoconjugates complexed with non-peptidyl components and uses thereof |
WO1994004193A1 (en) | 1992-08-21 | 1994-03-03 | Enzon, Inc. | Novel attachment of polyalkylene oxides to bio-effecting substances |
JP3979678B2 (en) | 1992-08-24 | 2007-09-19 | サントリー株式会社 | Novel glycosyltransferase, gene encoding the same, and method for producing the enzyme |
WO1994005332A2 (en) | 1992-09-01 | 1994-03-17 | Berlex Laboratories, Inc. | Glycolation of glycosylated macromolecules |
US5308460A (en) | 1992-10-30 | 1994-05-03 | Glyko, Incorporated | Rapid synthesis and analysis of carbohydrates |
US6361977B1 (en) | 1992-11-24 | 2002-03-26 | S. Christopher Bauer | Methods of using multivariant IL-3 hematopoiesis fusion protein |
JP2845698B2 (en) | 1992-11-25 | 1999-01-13 | オルガノ株式会社 | Method and apparatus for measuring anions contained in condensate in condensate circulation system |
JP3202365B2 (en) | 1992-12-04 | 2001-08-27 | 株式会社紀文フードケミファ | Method for separating oligomannuronic acid by degree of polymerization |
NZ250375A (en) | 1992-12-09 | 1995-07-26 | Ortho Pharma Corp | Peg hydrazone and peg oxime linkage forming reagents and protein derivatives |
CA2110543A1 (en) | 1992-12-09 | 1994-06-10 | David E. Wright | Peg hydrazone and peg oxime linkage forming reagents and protein derivatives thereof |
FI935485A (en) | 1992-12-09 | 1994-06-10 | Ortho Pharma Corp | The PEG-hydrazone and PEG-oxime bonds form reagents and protein derivatives thereof |
AU6029594A (en) | 1993-01-15 | 1994-08-15 | Enzon, Inc. | Factor viii - polymeric conjugates |
US5349001A (en) | 1993-01-19 | 1994-09-20 | Enzon, Inc. | Cyclic imide thione activated polyalkylene oxides |
US5321095A (en) | 1993-02-02 | 1994-06-14 | Enzon, Inc. | Azlactone activated polyalkylene oxides |
US6180134B1 (en) | 1993-03-23 | 2001-01-30 | Sequus Pharmaceuticals, Inc. | Enhanced ciruclation effector composition and method |
SG49117A1 (en) | 1993-03-29 | 1998-05-18 | Kyowa Hakko Kogyo Kk | Alfa -1, 3-fucosyltransferase |
US5374541A (en) | 1993-05-04 | 1994-12-20 | The Scripps Research Institute | Combined use of β-galactosidase and sialyltransferase coupled with in situ regeneration of CMP-sialic acid for one pot synthesis of oligosaccharides |
US5409817A (en) | 1993-05-04 | 1995-04-25 | Cytel, Inc. | Use of trans-sialidase and sialyltransferase for synthesis of sialylα2→3βgalactosides |
EP0698031A4 (en) | 1993-05-14 | 1997-07-09 | Cytel Corp | SIALYL LE x ANALOGUES AS INHIBITORS OF CELLULAR ADHESION |
WO1994026906A2 (en) | 1993-05-14 | 1994-11-24 | The Upjohn Company | CLONED DNA ENCODING A UDP-GALNAc:POLYPEPTIDE,N-ACETYLGALACTOS AMINYLTRANSFERASE |
CA2162726A1 (en) | 1993-05-21 | 1994-12-08 | Kathleen L. Berkner | Modified factor vii |
WO1994028024A1 (en) | 1993-06-01 | 1994-12-08 | Enzon, Inc. | Carbohydrate-modified polymer conjugates with erythropoietic activity |
CN1129953A (en) | 1993-07-15 | 1996-08-28 | 尼奥斯药品公司 | Synthesis of saccharic composition |
DE4325317C2 (en) | 1993-07-29 | 1998-05-20 | Univ Dresden Tech | Process for the radioactive labeling of immunoglobulins |
IL110669A (en) | 1993-08-17 | 2008-11-26 | Kirin Amgen Inc | Erythropoietin analogs |
JPH0770195A (en) | 1993-08-23 | 1995-03-14 | Yutaka Mizushima | Sugar-modified interferon |
US6485930B1 (en) | 1993-09-15 | 2002-11-26 | The Scripps Research Institute | Mannosyl transfer with regeneration of GDP-mannose |
KR960704934A (en) | 1993-09-22 | 1996-10-09 | 이나모리 준스케 | Peptides having antithrombotic activity and process for producing the same |
US5874075A (en) | 1993-10-06 | 1999-02-23 | Amgen Inc. | Stable protein: phospholipid compositions and methods |
US5643575A (en) | 1993-10-27 | 1997-07-01 | Enzon, Inc. | Non-antigenic branched polymer conjugates |
US5919455A (en) | 1993-10-27 | 1999-07-06 | Enzon, Inc. | Non-antigenic branched polymer conjugates |
US5446090A (en) | 1993-11-12 | 1995-08-29 | Shearwater Polymers, Inc. | Isolatable, water soluble, and hydrolytically stable active sulfones of poly(ethylene glycol) and related polymers for modification of surfaces and molecules |
US5369017A (en) | 1994-02-04 | 1994-11-29 | The Scripps Research Institute | Process for solid phase glycopeptide synthesis |
JP3516272B2 (en) | 1994-02-10 | 2004-04-05 | 株式会社成和化成 | Cosmetic base material |
US5837458A (en) | 1994-02-17 | 1998-11-17 | Maxygen, Inc. | Methods and compositions for cellular and metabolic engineering |
ZA951877B (en) | 1994-03-07 | 1996-09-09 | Dow Chemical Co | Bioactive and/or targeted dendrimer conjugates |
IL113010A0 (en) | 1994-03-31 | 1995-10-31 | Pharmacia Ab | Pharmaceutical formulation comprising factor VIII or factor ix with an activity of at least 200 IU/ml and an enhancer for improved subcutaneous intramuscular or intradermal administration |
US5432059A (en) | 1994-04-01 | 1995-07-11 | Specialty Laboratories, Inc. | Assay for glycosylation deficiency disorders |
US5646113A (en) | 1994-04-07 | 1997-07-08 | Genentech, Inc. | Treatment of partial growth hormone insensitivity syndrome |
WO1996010089A1 (en) | 1994-09-29 | 1996-04-04 | Ajinomoto Co., Inc. | Modification of peptide and protein |
US5824784A (en) | 1994-10-12 | 1998-10-20 | Amgen Inc. | N-terminally chemically modified protein compositions and methods |
US5834251A (en) | 1994-12-30 | 1998-11-10 | Alko Group Ltd. | Methods of modifying carbohydrate moieties |
US5932462A (en) | 1995-01-10 | 1999-08-03 | Shearwater Polymers, Inc. | Multiarmed, monofunctional, polymer for coupling to molecules and surfaces |
IL116730A0 (en) | 1995-01-13 | 1996-05-14 | Amgen Inc | Chemically modified interferon |
SE9501285L (en) | 1995-04-06 | 1996-10-07 | Johanna Ljung | Process for producing biologically active proteins |
US5922577A (en) | 1995-04-11 | 1999-07-13 | Cytel Corporation | Enzymatic synthesis of glycosidic linkages |
DK0820520T3 (en) | 1995-04-11 | 2002-12-02 | Neose Technologies Inc | Enhanced enzymatic synthesis of oliogosaccharides |
US5695760A (en) | 1995-04-24 | 1997-12-09 | Boehringer Inglehiem Pharmaceuticals, Inc. | Modified anti-ICAM-1 antibodies and their use in the treatment of inflammation |
CA2227326A1 (en) | 1995-05-15 | 1996-11-21 | Philip Dehazya | Carbohydrate-mediated coupling of peptides to immunoglobulins |
US5824864A (en) | 1995-05-25 | 1998-10-20 | Pioneer Hi-Bred International, Inc. | Maize gene and protein for insect control |
US5858752A (en) | 1995-06-07 | 1999-01-12 | The General Hospital Corporation | Fucosyltransferase genes and uses thereof |
WO1996040731A1 (en) | 1995-06-07 | 1996-12-19 | Mount Sinai School Of Medicine Of The City University Of New York | Pegylated modified proteins |
US6127153A (en) | 1995-06-07 | 2000-10-03 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Method of transferring at least two saccharide units with a polyglycosyltransferase, a polyglycosyltransferase and gene encoding a polyglycosyltransferase |
US6251864B1 (en) | 1995-06-07 | 2001-06-26 | Glaxo Group Limited | Peptides and compounds that bind to a receptor |
US5672662A (en) | 1995-07-07 | 1997-09-30 | Shearwater Polymers, Inc. | Poly(ethylene glycol) and related polymers monosubstituted with propionic or butanoic acids and functional derivatives thereof for biotechnical applications |
CO4560502A1 (en) | 1995-07-27 | 1998-02-10 | Cytec Tech Corp | A SIZE EMULSION TO IMPROVE THE EFFECTIVENESS OF SIZE AND METHOD FOR USE IN PAPER MANUFACTURE |
SE9503380D0 (en) | 1995-09-29 | 1995-09-29 | Pharmacia Ab | Protein derivatives |
CA2165041C (en) | 1995-12-12 | 2005-07-05 | The University Of British Columbia | Methods and compositions for synthesis of oligosaccharides, and the products formed thereby |
WO1997021822A2 (en) | 1995-12-12 | 1997-06-19 | The University Of British Columbia | Methods and compositions for synthesis of oligosaccharides using mutant glycosidase enzymes |
JP3065925B2 (en) | 1996-01-30 | 2000-07-17 | 日清製油株式会社 | Active oxygen species scavenger and anti-fading agent |
WO1997032889A1 (en) | 1996-03-08 | 1997-09-12 | The Regents Of The University Of Michigan | MURINE α(1,3)FUCOSYLTRANSFERASE Fuc-TVII, DNA ENCODING THE SAME, METHOD FOR PREPARING THE SAME, ANTIBODIES RECOGNIZING THE SAME, IMMUNOASSAYS FOR DETECTING THE SAME, PLASMIDS CONTAINING SUCH DNA, AND CELLS CONTAINING SUCH A PLASMID |
SI0964702T1 (en) | 1996-08-02 | 2007-02-28 | Ortho Mcneil Pharm Inc | Polypeptides having a single covalently bound n-terminal water-soluble polymer |
EP0953354A4 (en) | 1996-08-13 | 2002-10-23 | Fujisawa Pharmaceutical Co | Hematopoietic stem cell proliferating agents |
US20020064546A1 (en) | 1996-09-13 | 2002-05-30 | J. Milton Harris | Degradable poly(ethylene glycol) hydrogels with controlled half-life and precursors therefor |
JP2001502005A (en) | 1996-10-10 | 2001-02-13 | サイテル コーポレイション | Purification of carbohydrates using ultrafiltration, reverse osmosis and nanofiltration |
WO1998016240A1 (en) | 1996-10-15 | 1998-04-23 | The Liposome Company, Inc. | Peptide-lipid conjugates, liposomes and liposomal drug delivery |
US6117651A (en) | 1996-11-08 | 2000-09-12 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Expression vectors |
JP2001508783A (en) | 1997-01-29 | 2001-07-03 | ポリマスク・ファーマシューティカルズ・パブリック・リミテッド・カンパニー | PEGylation method |
DE19709787A1 (en) | 1997-03-11 | 1998-09-17 | Bayer Ag | Oligosaccaride and their derivatives as well as a chemo-enzymatic process for their production |
US5945314A (en) | 1997-03-31 | 1999-08-31 | Abbott Laboratories | Process for synthesizing oligosaccharides |
EP0979102A4 (en) | 1997-04-30 | 2005-11-23 | Enzon Inc | Polyalkylene oxide-modified single chain polypeptides |
JPH10307356A (en) | 1997-05-08 | 1998-11-17 | Konica Corp | Silver halide emulsion and silver halide photographic sensitive material using the same |
US6075134A (en) | 1997-05-15 | 2000-06-13 | The Regents Of The University Of California | Glycoconjugates and methods |
AU757627B2 (en) | 1997-06-24 | 2003-02-27 | Genentech Inc. | Methods and compositions for galactosylated glycoproteins |
AU8269898A (en) | 1997-06-27 | 1999-01-19 | Regents Of The University Of California, The | Drug targeting of a peptide radiopharmaceutical through the primate blood-brain barrier in vivo with a monoclonal antibody to the human insulin receptor |
WO1999013063A1 (en) | 1997-09-09 | 1999-03-18 | Nycomed Imaging As | Factor vii fragments and analogs thereof and their use in the treatment of blood clottng disorders |
ATE419009T1 (en) | 1997-10-31 | 2009-01-15 | Genentech Inc | METHODS AND COMPOSITIONS CONSISTING OF GLYCOPROTEIN GLYCOFORMS |
AU744303B2 (en) | 1997-12-01 | 2002-02-21 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Enzymatic synthesis of gangliosides |
CA2316834C (en) | 1998-01-07 | 2006-01-03 | Shearwater Polymers, Inc. | Degradable heterobifunctional poly(ethylene glycol) acrylates and gels and conjugates derived therefrom |
WO1999037779A1 (en) | 1998-01-22 | 1999-07-29 | Genentech, Inc. | Antibody fragment-polymer conjugates and humanized anti-il-8 monoclonal antibodies and uses of same |
DK2180007T4 (en) | 1998-04-20 | 2017-11-27 | Roche Glycart Ag | Glycosylation technique for antibodies to enhance antibody-dependent cell cytotoxicity |
ATE399567T1 (en) | 1998-04-28 | 2008-07-15 | Serono Lab | PEG CONJUGATES OF LHRH ANALOGUE |
US20030166525A1 (en) | 1998-07-23 | 2003-09-04 | Hoffmann James Arthur | FSH Formulation |
EP2599503B1 (en) | 1998-10-16 | 2017-05-17 | Biogen MA Inc. | Polymer conjugates of interferon beta-1A and uses thereof |
US7304150B1 (en) | 1998-10-23 | 2007-12-04 | Amgen Inc. | Methods and compositions for the prevention and treatment of anemia |
CN1325443A (en) | 1998-10-30 | 2001-12-05 | 诺沃奇梅兹有限公司 | Glycosylated proteins having reduced allergenicity |
JP2002530071A (en) | 1998-11-13 | 2002-09-17 | クラウセン、ヘンリク | UDP galactose: β-N-acetyl-glucosamine β1,3 galactosyltransferase, β3Gal-T5 |
CA2351022A1 (en) | 1998-11-18 | 2000-05-25 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Low cost manufacture of oligosaccharides |
US6465220B1 (en) | 1998-12-21 | 2002-10-15 | Glycozym Aps | Glycosylation using GalNac-T4 transferase |
HU228488B1 (en) | 1999-01-29 | 2013-03-28 | Amgen Inc | Gcsf conjugates |
US6503744B1 (en) | 1999-02-01 | 2003-01-07 | National Research Council Of Canada | Campylobacter glycosyltransferases for biosynthesis of gangliosides and ganglioside mimics |
US6949372B2 (en) | 1999-03-02 | 2005-09-27 | The Johns Hopkins University | Engineering intracellular sialylation pathways |
CA2370469A1 (en) | 1999-04-22 | 2000-11-02 | Astrazeneca Ab | Assay for detecting phospho-n-acetylmuramyl-pentapeptide translocase activity |
JO2291B1 (en) | 1999-07-02 | 2005-09-12 | اف . هوفمان لاروش ايه جي | Erythopintin derivatives |
US6261805B1 (en) | 1999-07-15 | 2001-07-17 | Boyce Thompson Institute For Plant Research, Inc. | Sialyiation of N-linked glycoproteins in the baculovirus expression vector system |
AU6357900A (en) | 1999-07-20 | 2001-02-05 | Amgen, Inc. | Hyaluronic acid-protein conjugates, pharmaceutical compositions and related methods |
US6537785B1 (en) | 1999-09-14 | 2003-03-25 | Genzyme Glycobiology Research Institute, Inc. | Methods of treating lysosomal storage diseases |
EP1234033B1 (en) | 1999-12-02 | 2011-12-28 | ZymoGenetics, Inc. | Methods for targeting cells that express fibroblast growth factor receptor-3 or-2 |
JP4593048B2 (en) | 1999-12-24 | 2010-12-08 | 協和発酵キリン株式会社 | Branched polyalkylene glycols |
AU2352201A (en) | 1999-12-30 | 2001-07-16 | Maxygen Aps | Improved lysosomal enzymes and lysosomal enzyme activators |
US6555660B2 (en) | 2000-01-10 | 2003-04-29 | Maxygen Holdings Ltd. | G-CSF conjugates |
AR027509A1 (en) | 2000-01-10 | 2003-04-02 | Maxygen Aps | G-CSF CONJUGATES |
US6646110B2 (en) | 2000-01-10 | 2003-11-11 | Maxygen Holdings Ltd. | G-CSF polypeptides and conjugates |
AU783512B2 (en) | 2000-02-11 | 2005-11-03 | Bayer Healthcare Llc | Factor VII or VIIa-like molecules |
WO2001058493A1 (en) | 2000-02-11 | 2001-08-16 | Maxygen Aps | Conjugates of follicle stimulating hormones |
AU2001232337A1 (en) | 2000-02-18 | 2001-08-27 | Kanagawa Academy Of Science And Technology | Pharmaceutical composition, reagent and method for intracerebral delivery of pharmaceutically active ingredient or labeling substance |
US20010041683A1 (en) | 2000-03-09 | 2001-11-15 | Schmitz Harold H. | Cocoa sphingolipids, cocoa extracts containing sphingolipids and methods of making and using same |
US6586398B1 (en) | 2000-04-07 | 2003-07-01 | Amgen, Inc. | Chemically modified novel erythropoietin stimulating protein compositions and methods |
US6905683B2 (en) | 2000-05-03 | 2005-06-14 | Novo Nordisk Healthcare A/G | Human coagulation factor VII variants |
DE60143292D1 (en) | 2000-05-03 | 2010-12-02 | Novo Nordisk Healthcare Ag | Variants of human coagulation factor VII |
US7338932B2 (en) | 2000-05-11 | 2008-03-04 | Glycozym Aps | Methods of modulating functions of polypeptide GalNAc-transferases and of screening test substances to find agents herefor, pharmaceutical compositions comprising such agents and the use of such agents for preparing medicaments |
IL152804A0 (en) | 2000-05-16 | 2003-06-24 | Bolder Biotechnology Inc | Methods for refolding proteins containing free cysteine residues |
WO2002000879A2 (en) | 2000-06-28 | 2002-01-03 | Glycofi, Inc. | Methods for producing modified glycoproteins |
WO2002002597A2 (en) | 2000-06-30 | 2002-01-10 | Maxygen Aps | Peptide extended glycosylated polypeptides |
US6423826B1 (en) | 2000-06-30 | 2002-07-23 | Regents Of The University Of Minnesota | High molecular weight derivatives of vitamin K-dependent polypeptides |
KR100396983B1 (en) | 2000-07-29 | 2003-09-02 | 이강춘 | Highly reactive branched polymer and proteins or peptides conjugated with the polymer |
AU2001285020A1 (en) | 2000-08-17 | 2002-02-25 | Synapse Technologies, Inc. | P97-active agent conjugates and their methods of use |
AU2001283740A1 (en) | 2000-08-17 | 2002-02-25 | University Of British Columbia | Chemotherapeutic agents conjugated to p97 and their methods of use in treating neurological tumours |
KR100880624B1 (en) | 2000-10-02 | 2009-01-30 | 노보 노르디스크 헬스 케어 악티엔게젤샤프트 | Method for the production of vitamin k-dependent proteins |
US20020142964A1 (en) | 2000-11-02 | 2002-10-03 | Nissen Torben Lauesgaard | Single-chain polypeptides |
NZ523679A (en) | 2000-11-27 | 2005-10-28 | Rmf Dictagene S | Process for folding chemically synthesized polypeptides containing derivatised cysteine |
WO2002044196A1 (en) | 2000-11-28 | 2002-06-06 | University Of Massachusetts | Methods and reagents for introducing a sulfhydryl group into the 5'-terminus of rna |
WO2002049673A2 (en) | 2000-12-20 | 2002-06-27 | F. Hoffmann-La Roche Ag | Conjugates of erythropoietin (pep) with polyethylene glycol (peg) |
AU3323002A (en) | 2000-12-20 | 2002-07-01 | Hoffmann La Roche | Erythropoietin conjugates |
US7892730B2 (en) | 2000-12-22 | 2011-02-22 | Sagres Discovery, Inc. | Compositions and methods for cancer |
PA8536201A1 (en) | 2000-12-29 | 2002-08-29 | Kenneth S Warren Inst Inc | PROTECTION AND IMPROVEMENT OF CELLS, FABRICS AND ORGANS RESPONDING TO Erythropoietin |
SE0004932D0 (en) | 2000-12-31 | 2000-12-31 | Apbiotech Ab | A method for mixed mode adsorption and mixed mode adsorbents |
MXPA03007619A (en) | 2001-02-27 | 2003-12-04 | Maxygen Aps | New interferon beta-like molecules. |
KR100399357B1 (en) * | 2001-03-19 | 2003-09-26 | 삼성전자주식회사 | Semiconductor device using cobalt silicide and method of forming the same |
IL157842A0 (en) | 2001-03-22 | 2004-03-28 | Novo Nordisk Healthcare Ag | Coagulation factor vii derivatives |
US7235638B2 (en) | 2001-03-22 | 2007-06-26 | Novo Nordisk Healthcare A/G | Coagulation factor VII derivatives |
AU2002308562B2 (en) | 2001-05-03 | 2008-01-24 | Merck Patent Gmbh | Recombinant tumor specific antibody and use thereof |
EP1392350A2 (en) | 2001-05-11 | 2004-03-03 | Aradigm Corporation | Optimization of the molecular properties and formulation of proteins delivered by inhalation |
US7271150B2 (en) | 2001-05-14 | 2007-09-18 | United States Of America, Represented By The Secretary, Department Of Health And Human Services | Modified growth hormone |
JP4444652B2 (en) | 2001-07-11 | 2010-03-31 | マキシゲン・ホールディングズ・リミテッド | G-CSF conjugate |
KR100453877B1 (en) | 2001-07-26 | 2004-10-20 | 메덱스젠 주식회사 | METHOD OF MANUFACTURING Ig-FUSION PROTEINS BY CONCATAMERIZATION, TNFR/Fc FUSION PROTEINS MANUFACTURED BY THE METHOD, DNA CODING THE PROTEINS, VECTORS INCLUDING THE DNA, AND CELLS TRANSFORMED BY THE VECTOR |
US20050245735A1 (en) | 2001-08-01 | 2005-11-03 | Shawn Defrees | Neutral glycosphingolipids and glycosyl-sphingosines and methods for isolating the same |
AU2002326805B2 (en) | 2001-08-29 | 2009-01-22 | Seneb Biosciences, Inc. | Novel synthetic ganglioside derivatives and compositions thereof |
US6930086B2 (en) | 2001-09-25 | 2005-08-16 | Hoffmann-La Roche Inc. | Diglycosylated erythropoietin |
US7052868B2 (en) | 2001-09-27 | 2006-05-30 | Novo Nordisk Healthcare A/G | Human coagulation factor VII polypeptides |
US7439043B2 (en) | 2001-10-10 | 2008-10-21 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Galactosyl nucleotide sugars |
US7265085B2 (en) | 2001-10-10 | 2007-09-04 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Glycoconjugation methods and proteins/peptides produced by the methods |
US6784154B2 (en) | 2001-11-01 | 2004-08-31 | University Of Utah Research Foundation | Method of use of erythropoietin to treat ischemic acute renal failure |
WO2003046150A2 (en) | 2001-11-28 | 2003-06-05 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Glycoprotein remodeling using endoglycanases |
AU2003239365A1 (en) | 2002-05-03 | 2003-11-17 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Recombinant glycosyltransferase fusion proteins |
MXPA04012496A (en) | 2002-06-21 | 2005-09-12 | Novo Nordisk Healthcare Ag | Pegylated factor vii glycoforms. |
JP4634145B2 (en) | 2002-06-21 | 2011-02-16 | ノボ ノルディスク ヘルス ケア アクチェンゲゼルシャフト | Pegylated Factor VII glycoform |
DE10232916B4 (en) | 2002-07-19 | 2008-08-07 | Fraunhofer-Gesellschaft zur Förderung der angewandten Forschung e.V. | Apparatus and method for characterizing an information signal |
AU2003254139A1 (en) | 2002-07-23 | 2004-02-09 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | H. Pylori FUCOSYLTRANSFERASES |
WO2004013151A2 (en) | 2002-08-01 | 2004-02-12 | National Research Council Of Canada | Campylobacter glycans and glycopeptides |
WO2004015099A2 (en) | 2002-08-02 | 2004-02-19 | Glaxosmithkline Biologicals Sa | Vaccine composition comprising lipooligosaccharide with reduced phase variability |
MXPA05002476A (en) | 2002-09-05 | 2005-10-19 | Gi Company Inc | Modified asialo-interferons and uses thereof. |
EP1539210A4 (en) | 2002-09-06 | 2006-06-07 | Bayer Pharmaceuticals Corp | Modified glp-1 receptor agonists and their pharmacological methods of use |
ZA200502320B (en) | 2002-09-20 | 2006-10-25 | Pharmacia Corp | Process for decreasing aggregate levels of pegylated protein |
EP1546202B1 (en) | 2002-09-25 | 2007-08-22 | Novo Nordisk Health Care AG | Human coagulation factor vii polypeptides |
US20040062748A1 (en) | 2002-09-30 | 2004-04-01 | Mountain View Pharmaceuticals, Inc. | Polymer conjugates with decreased antigenicity, methods of preparation and uses thereof |
CA2502162C (en) | 2002-09-30 | 2014-04-15 | Maxygen Holdings Ltd. | Fvii or fviia variants having increased clotting activity |
NZ539415A (en) | 2002-10-09 | 2008-12-24 | Neose Technologies Inc | Remodelling and glycoconjugation of erythropoietin |
JP4412461B2 (en) | 2002-11-20 | 2010-02-10 | 日油株式会社 | Modified bio-related substance, production method thereof and intermediate |
US7459436B2 (en) | 2002-11-22 | 2008-12-02 | Hoffmann-La Roche Inc. | Treatment of disturbances of iron distribution |
EP1424344A1 (en) | 2002-11-29 | 2004-06-02 | Aventis Behring Gesellschaft mit beschränkter Haftung | Modified cDNA factor VIII and its derivates |
SI1428878T1 (en) * | 2002-12-13 | 2009-02-28 | Bioceuticals Arzneimittel Ag | Process for the production and purification of erythropoietin |
GEP20084486B (en) | 2002-12-26 | 2008-09-25 | Mountain View Pharmaceuticals | Polymer conjugates of interferon-beta with enhanced biological potency |
US7041635B2 (en) | 2003-01-28 | 2006-05-09 | In2Gen Co., Ltd. | Factor VIII polypeptide |
LT1596887T (en) | 2003-02-26 | 2022-04-25 | Nektar Therapeutics | Polymer-factor viii moiety conjugates |
EP1603954A4 (en) | 2003-03-18 | 2006-04-12 | Neose Technologies Inc | Activated forms of water-soluble polymers |
MXPA05009940A (en) | 2003-03-19 | 2005-12-05 | Lilly Co Eli | Polyethelene glycol link glp-1 compounds. |
US8791070B2 (en) | 2003-04-09 | 2014-07-29 | Novo Nordisk A/S | Glycopegylated factor IX |
US7718363B2 (en) | 2003-04-25 | 2010-05-18 | The Kenneth S. Warren Institute, Inc. | Tissue protective cytokine receptor complex and assays for identifying tissue protective compounds |
TWI353991B (en) | 2003-05-06 | 2011-12-11 | Syntonix Pharmaceuticals Inc | Immunoglobulin chimeric monomer-dimer hybrids |
ES2333598T5 (en) | 2003-05-06 | 2013-09-04 | Biogen Idec Hemophilia Inc | CHEMICAL PROTEINS OF FC COAGULATION FACTOR TO TREAT HEMOPHILIA. |
WO2004101597A2 (en) | 2003-05-13 | 2004-11-25 | Frutarom Ltd. | Methods for the reduction of disulfide bonds |
US7074755B2 (en) | 2003-05-17 | 2006-07-11 | Centocor, Inc. | Erythropoietin conjugate compounds with extended half-lives |
EP1481985A1 (en) | 2003-05-28 | 2004-12-01 | Innogenetics N.V. | Modified hepatitis C virus (HCV) NS3 for medical treatment |
GB0315457D0 (en) | 2003-07-01 | 2003-08-06 | Celltech R&D Ltd | Biological products |
BRPI0412671A (en) | 2003-08-08 | 2006-10-03 | Fresenius Kabi De Gmbh | conjugates of a polymer and a protein linked by an oxime linking group |
JP2007501811A (en) | 2003-08-08 | 2007-02-01 | ノボ ノルディスク ヘルス ケア アクチェンゲゼルシャフト | Use of galactose oxidase for selective chemical conjugation of a retarder molecule to a protein of therapeutic interest. |
BRPI0409650A (en) | 2003-09-09 | 2006-04-25 | Warren Pharmaceuticals Inc | methods for regulating hematocrit and human levels, artificial erythropoietin products, methods for preparing an erythropoietin product and for treating anemia in patients at risk of tissue damage, and, pharmaceutical composition |
US7524813B2 (en) | 2003-10-10 | 2009-04-28 | Novo Nordisk Health Care Ag | Selectively conjugated peptides and methods of making the same |
US20080305992A1 (en) | 2003-11-24 | 2008-12-11 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Glycopegylated erythropoietin |
US7405198B2 (en) | 2003-11-24 | 2008-07-29 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Glycopegylated erythropoietin |
WO2005072371A2 (en) | 2004-01-26 | 2005-08-11 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Branched polymeric sugars and nucleotides thereof |
KR101237884B1 (en) | 2003-12-03 | 2013-02-27 | 바이오제너릭스 에이지 | Glycopegylated granulocyte colony stimulating factor |
US20060040856A1 (en) | 2003-12-03 | 2006-02-23 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Glycopegylated factor IX |
EP1694315A4 (en) | 2003-12-03 | 2009-10-28 | Novo Nordisk As | Glycopegylated factor ix |
US7956032B2 (en) | 2003-12-03 | 2011-06-07 | Novo Nordisk A/S | Glycopegylated granulocyte colony stimulating factor |
US20080318850A1 (en) | 2003-12-03 | 2008-12-25 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Glycopegylated Factor Ix |
WO2005067601A2 (en) | 2004-01-09 | 2005-07-28 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Vectors for recombinant protein expression in e.coli |
US20070105770A1 (en) | 2004-01-21 | 2007-05-10 | Novo Nordisk A/S | Transglutaminase mediated conjugation of peptides |
HUE050481T2 (en) | 2004-02-12 | 2020-12-28 | Archemix Llc | Aptamer therapeutics useful in the treatment of complement-related disorders |
WO2005091944A2 (en) | 2004-03-17 | 2005-10-06 | Eli Lilly And Company | Glycol linked fgf-21 compounds |
WO2005111225A1 (en) | 2004-05-04 | 2005-11-24 | Novo Nordisk Health Care Ag | O-linked glycoforms of polypeptides and method to manufacture them |
US20070037966A1 (en) | 2004-05-04 | 2007-02-15 | Novo Nordisk A/S | Hydrophobic interaction chromatography purification of factor VII polypeptides |
JP4251399B2 (en) | 2004-05-21 | 2009-04-08 | 独立行政法人産業技術総合研究所 | Screening method for peptides to which O-linked sugar chains are added |
JP2008512085A (en) | 2004-06-03 | 2008-04-24 | ネオス テクノロジーズ インコーポレイティッド | Cleaved GalNAcT2 polypeptides and nucleic acids |
EP1765993A4 (en) | 2004-06-03 | 2008-08-20 | Neose Technologies Inc | Truncated st6galnaci polypeptides and nucleic acids |
CA2572751A1 (en) | 2004-06-30 | 2006-01-12 | Egen Corporation | Pegylated interferon alpha-1b |
KR101146160B1 (en) | 2004-06-30 | 2012-07-16 | 넥타르 테라퓨틱스 | Polymer-factor ix moiety conjugates |
EP1771190A4 (en) | 2004-07-02 | 2009-07-22 | Kenneth S Warren Inst Inc | Method of producing fully carbamylated erythropoietin |
WO2006014466A2 (en) | 2004-07-02 | 2006-02-09 | The Kenneth S. Warren Institute, Inc. | Novel carbamylated epo and method for its production |
US20080300173A1 (en) | 2004-07-13 | 2008-12-04 | Defrees Shawn | Branched Peg Remodeling and Glycosylation of Glucagon-Like Peptides-1 [Glp-1] |
WO2006020372A2 (en) | 2004-07-23 | 2006-02-23 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Enzymatic modification of glycopeptides |
SE0401951D0 (en) | 2004-07-29 | 2004-07-29 | Amersham Biosciences Ab | Chromatography method |
US20090176967A1 (en) | 2004-08-02 | 2009-07-09 | Novo Nordisk Healthcare A/G | Conjugation of FVII |
DE602005021509D1 (en) | 2004-08-17 | 2010-07-08 | Csl Behring Gmbh | MODIFIED VITAMIN K-DEPENDENT POLYPEPTIDE |
DK2586456T3 (en) | 2004-10-29 | 2016-03-21 | Ratiopharm Gmbh | Conversion and glycopegylation of fibroblast growth factor (FGF) |
MX350293B (en) | 2004-11-12 | 2017-09-04 | Bayer Healthcare Llc | Site-directed modification of fviii. |
MX2007007591A (en) * | 2004-12-22 | 2007-07-25 | Ambrx Inc | Methods for expression and purification of recombinant human growth hormone. |
EP1858543B1 (en) | 2005-01-10 | 2013-11-27 | BioGeneriX AG | Glycopegylated granulocyte colony stimulating factor |
WO2006078645A2 (en) | 2005-01-19 | 2006-07-27 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Heterologous polypeptide expression using low multiplicity of infection of viruses |
PA8660701A1 (en) | 2005-02-04 | 2006-09-22 | Pfizer Prod Inc | SMALL AGONISTS AND THEIR USES |
MX2007011801A (en) | 2005-03-24 | 2008-02-19 | Neose Technologies Inc | Expression of soluble, active eukaryotic glycosyltransferases in prokaryotic organisms. |
US20060246544A1 (en) | 2005-03-30 | 2006-11-02 | Neose Technologies,Inc. | Manufacturing process for the production of peptides grown in insect cell lines |
WO2006103298A2 (en) | 2005-04-01 | 2006-10-05 | Novo Nordisk Health Care Ag | Blood coagulation fviii analogues |
ES2353814T3 (en) | 2005-05-11 | 2011-03-07 | Eth Zuerich | RECOMBINANT N-GLYCOSILATED PROTEINS OF PROCEDURAL CELLS. |
US20110003744A1 (en) | 2005-05-25 | 2011-01-06 | Novo Nordisk A/S | Glycopegylated Erythropoietin Formulations |
EP1888098A2 (en) | 2005-05-25 | 2008-02-20 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Glycopegylated erythropoietin formulations |
EP1893632B1 (en) | 2005-06-17 | 2015-08-12 | Novo Nordisk Health Care AG | Selective reduction and derivatization of engineered factor vii proteins comprising at least one non-native cysteine |
CN102719508A (en) | 2005-08-19 | 2012-10-10 | 诺和诺德公司 | Glycopegylated factor VII and factor VIIA |
DE202006020194U1 (en) | 2006-03-01 | 2007-12-06 | Bioceuticals Arzneimittel Ag | G-CSF liquid formulation |
US7645860B2 (en) | 2006-03-31 | 2010-01-12 | Baxter Healthcare S.A. | Factor VIII polymer conjugates |
MX2008014685A (en) | 2006-05-24 | 2008-11-27 | Novo Nordisk Healthcare Ag | Factor ix analogues having prolonged in vivo half life. |
EP2049144B8 (en) | 2006-07-21 | 2015-02-18 | ratiopharm GmbH | Glycosylation of peptides via o-linked glycosylation sequences |
ITMI20061624A1 (en) | 2006-08-11 | 2008-02-12 | Bioker Srl | SINGLE-CONJUGATE SITE-SPECIFIC OF G-CSF |
WO2008073620A2 (en) | 2006-11-02 | 2008-06-19 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Manufacturing process for the production of polypeptides expressed in insect cell-lines |
CN101796063B (en) | 2007-04-03 | 2017-03-22 | 拉蒂奥法姆有限责任公司 | methods of treatment using glycopegylated G-CSF |
EP2162535A4 (en) | 2007-06-04 | 2011-02-23 | Novo Nordisk As | O-linked glycosylation using n-acetylglucosaminyl transferases |
ES2551123T3 (en) | 2007-06-12 | 2015-11-16 | Ratiopharm Gmbh | Improved process for the production of nucleotide sugars |
US8207112B2 (en) | 2007-08-29 | 2012-06-26 | Biogenerix Ag | Liquid formulation of G-CSF conjugate |
CA2711503A1 (en) | 2008-01-08 | 2009-07-16 | Biogenerix Ag | Glycoconjugation of polypeptides using oligosaccharyltransferases |
-
2007
- 2007-10-03 US US12/444,380 patent/US20100075375A1/en not_active Abandoned
- 2007-10-03 JP JP2009531593A patent/JP2010505874A/en active Pending
- 2007-10-03 US US11/866,969 patent/US8969532B2/en not_active Expired - Fee Related
- 2007-10-03 EP EP07868365A patent/EP2054521A4/en not_active Withdrawn
- 2007-10-03 WO PCT/US2007/080353 patent/WO2008057683A2/en active Application Filing
-
2009
- 2009-03-23 IL IL197765A patent/IL197765A0/en unknown
- 2009-04-03 US US12/418,530 patent/US20100035299A1/en not_active Abandoned
Patent Citations (98)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
US4088538A (en) * | 1975-05-30 | 1978-05-09 | Battelle Memorial Institute | Reversibly precipitable immobilized enzyme complex and a method for its use |
US4385260A (en) * | 1975-09-09 | 1983-05-24 | Beckman Instruments, Inc. | Bargraph display |
US4438253A (en) * | 1982-11-12 | 1984-03-20 | American Cyanamid Company | Poly(glycolic acid)/poly(alkylene glycol) block copolymers and method of manufacturing the same |
US4496689A (en) * | 1983-12-27 | 1985-01-29 | Miles Laboratories, Inc. | Covalently attached complex of alpha-1-proteinase inhibitor with a water soluble polymer |
US4565653A (en) * | 1984-03-30 | 1986-01-21 | Pfizer Inc. | Acyltripeptide immunostimulants |
US4806595A (en) * | 1985-08-12 | 1989-02-21 | Koken Co., Ltd. | Method of preparing antithrombogenic medical materials |
US4925796A (en) * | 1986-03-07 | 1990-05-15 | Massachusetts Institute Of Technology | Method for enhancing glycoprotein stability |
US4826945A (en) * | 1987-06-09 | 1989-05-02 | Yissum Research Development Company | Biodegradable polymeric materials based on polyether glycols, processes for the preparation thereof and surgical articles made therefrom |
US5194376A (en) * | 1989-02-28 | 1993-03-16 | University Of Ottawa | Baculovirus expression system capable of producing foreign gene proteins at high levels |
US5324844A (en) * | 1989-04-19 | 1994-06-28 | Enzon, Inc. | Active carbonates of polyalkylene oxides for modification of polypeptides |
US5122614A (en) * | 1989-04-19 | 1992-06-16 | Enzon, Inc. | Active carbonates of polyalkylene oxides for modification of polypeptides |
US5527527A (en) * | 1989-09-07 | 1996-06-18 | Alkermes, Inc. | Transferrin receptor specific antibody-neuropharmaceutical agent conjugates |
US5182107A (en) * | 1989-09-07 | 1993-01-26 | Alkermes, Inc. | Transferrin receptor specific antibody-neuropharmaceutical or diagnostic agent conjugates |
US5405753A (en) * | 1990-03-26 | 1995-04-11 | Brossmer; Reinhard | CMP-activated, fluorescing sialic acids, as well as processes for their preparation |
US6010999A (en) * | 1990-05-04 | 2000-01-04 | American Cyanamid Company | Stabilization of fibroblast growth factors by modification of cysteine residues |
US5219564A (en) * | 1990-07-06 | 1993-06-15 | Enzon, Inc. | Poly(alkylene oxide) amino acid copolymers and drug carriers and charged copolymers based thereon |
US5410016A (en) * | 1990-10-15 | 1995-04-25 | Board Of Regents, The University Of Texas System | Photopolymerizable biodegradable hydrogels as tissue contacting materials and controlled-release carriers |
US5529914A (en) * | 1990-10-15 | 1996-06-25 | The Board Of Regents The Univeristy Of Texas System | Gels for encapsulation of biological materials |
US5281698A (en) * | 1991-07-23 | 1994-01-25 | Cetus Oncology Corporation | Preparation of an activated polymer ester for protein conjugation |
US5858751A (en) * | 1992-03-09 | 1999-01-12 | The Regents Of The University Of California | Compositions and methods for producing sialyltransferases |
US6037452A (en) * | 1992-04-10 | 2000-03-14 | Alpha Therapeutic Corporation | Poly(alkylene oxide)-Factor VIII or Factor IX conjugate |
US5614184A (en) * | 1992-07-28 | 1997-03-25 | New England Deaconess Hospital | Recombinant human erythropoietin mutants and therapeutic methods employing them |
US5202413A (en) * | 1993-02-16 | 1993-04-13 | E. I. Du Pont De Nemours And Company | Alternating (ABA)N polylactide block copolymers |
US5621039A (en) * | 1993-06-08 | 1997-04-15 | Hallahan; Terrence W. | Factor IX- polymeric conjugates |
US5635603A (en) * | 1993-12-08 | 1997-06-03 | Immunomedics, Inc. | Preparation and use of immunoconjugates |
US5605793A (en) * | 1994-02-17 | 1997-02-25 | Affymax Technologies N.V. | Methods for in vitro recombination |
US5492841A (en) * | 1994-02-18 | 1996-02-20 | E. I. Du Pont De Nemours And Company | Quaternary ammonium immunogenic conjugates and immunoassay reagents |
US5629384A (en) * | 1994-05-17 | 1997-05-13 | Consiglio Nazionale Delle Ricerche | Polymers of N-acryloylmorpholine activated at one end and conjugates with bioactive materials and surfaces |
US5705367A (en) * | 1994-09-26 | 1998-01-06 | The Rockefeller University | Glycosyltransferases for biosynthesis of oligosaccharides, and genes encoding them |
US6342382B1 (en) * | 1994-09-26 | 2002-01-29 | The Rockefeller University | Glycosyltransferases for biosynthesis of oligosaccharides, and genes encoding them |
US5728554A (en) * | 1995-04-11 | 1998-03-17 | Cytel Corporation | Enzymatic synthesis of glycosidic linkages |
US5876980A (en) * | 1995-04-11 | 1999-03-02 | Cytel Corporation | Enzymatic synthesis of oligosaccharides |
US6030815A (en) * | 1995-04-11 | 2000-02-29 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Enzymatic synthesis of oligosaccharides |
US6015555A (en) * | 1995-05-19 | 2000-01-18 | Alkermes, Inc. | Transferrin receptor specific antibody-neuropharmaceutical or diagnostic agent conjugates |
US5770420A (en) * | 1995-09-08 | 1998-06-23 | The Regents Of The University Of Michigan | Methods and products for the synthesis of oligosaccharide structures on glycoproteins, glycolipids, or as free molecules, and for the isolation of cloned genetic sequences that determine these structures |
US6057292A (en) * | 1995-09-21 | 2000-05-02 | Genentech, Inc. | Method for inhibiting growth hormone action |
US5716812A (en) * | 1995-12-12 | 1998-02-10 | The University Of British Columbia | Methods and compositions for synthesis of oligosaccharides, and the products formed thereby |
US6399336B1 (en) * | 1997-01-16 | 2002-06-04 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Practical in vitro sialylation of recombinant glycoproteins |
US6183738B1 (en) * | 1997-05-12 | 2001-02-06 | Phoenix Pharamacologics, Inc. | Modified arginine deiminase |
US6399337B1 (en) * | 1997-06-06 | 2002-06-04 | The Governors Of The University Of Alberta | α1,3-fucosyltransferase |
US20030027257A1 (en) * | 1997-08-21 | 2003-02-06 | University Technologies International, Inc. | Sequences for improving the efficiency of secretion of non-secreted protein from mammalian and insect cells |
US6555346B1 (en) * | 1997-12-18 | 2003-04-29 | Stichting Instituut Voor Dierhouderij En Diergezondheid | Protein expression in baculovirus vector expression systems |
US6362254B2 (en) * | 1998-03-12 | 2002-03-26 | Shearwater Corporation | Poly(ethylene glycol) derivatives with proximal reactive groups |
US20040102607A1 (en) * | 1998-03-25 | 2004-05-27 | Danishefsky Samuel J. | Trimeric antigenic O-linked glycopeptide conjugates, methods of preparation and uses thereof |
US6692931B1 (en) * | 1998-11-16 | 2004-02-17 | Werner Reutter | Recombinant glycoproteins, method for the production thereof, medicaments containing said glycoproteins and use thereof |
US6716626B1 (en) * | 1999-11-18 | 2004-04-06 | Chiron Corporation | Human FGF-21 nucleic acids |
US6348558B1 (en) * | 1999-12-10 | 2002-02-19 | Shearwater Corporation | Hydrolytically degradable polymers and hydrogels made therefrom |
US6376604B2 (en) * | 1999-12-22 | 2002-04-23 | Shearwater Corporation | Method for the preparation of 1-benzotriazolylcarbonate esters of poly(ethylene glycol) |
US20020016003A1 (en) * | 2000-03-16 | 2002-02-07 | Eliana Saxon | Chemoselective ligation |
US20030040037A1 (en) * | 2000-05-12 | 2003-02-27 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | In vitro modification of glycosylation patterns of recombinant glycopeptides |
US20020037841A1 (en) * | 2000-05-15 | 2002-03-28 | Apollon Papadimitriou | Erythropoietin composition |
US7202208B2 (en) * | 2000-05-15 | 2007-04-10 | Hoffman-La Roche Inc. | Erythropoietin composition |
US6531121B2 (en) * | 2000-12-29 | 2003-03-11 | The Kenneth S. Warren Institute, Inc. | Protection and enhancement of erythropoietin-responsive cells, tissues and organs |
US7696163B2 (en) * | 2001-10-10 | 2010-04-13 | Novo Nordisk A/S | Erythropoietin: remodeling and glycoconjugation of erythropoietin |
US20100015684A1 (en) * | 2001-10-10 | 2010-01-21 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Factor vii: remodeling and glycoconjugation of factor vii |
US20040077836A1 (en) * | 2001-10-10 | 2004-04-22 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Granulocyte colony stimulating factor: remodeling and glycoconjugation of G-CSF |
US20040115168A1 (en) * | 2001-10-10 | 2004-06-17 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Interferon beta: remodeling and glycoconjugation of interferon beta |
US20040063911A1 (en) * | 2001-10-10 | 2004-04-01 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Protein remodeling methods and proteins/peptides produced by the methods |
US20050031584A1 (en) * | 2001-10-10 | 2005-02-10 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Interleukin-2:remodeling and glycoconjugation of interleukin-2 |
US20080050772A1 (en) * | 2001-10-10 | 2008-02-28 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Granulocyte colony stimulating factor: remodeling and glycoconjugation of G-CSF |
US20050100982A1 (en) * | 2001-10-10 | 2005-05-12 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Factor IX: remodeling and glycoconjugation of factor IX |
US20050106658A1 (en) * | 2001-10-10 | 2005-05-19 | Defrees Shawn | Remodeling and glycoconjugation of peptides |
US20040082026A1 (en) * | 2001-10-10 | 2004-04-29 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Interferon alpha: remodeling and glycoconjugation of interferon alpha |
US7214660B2 (en) * | 2001-10-10 | 2007-05-08 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Erythropoietin: remodeling and glycoconjugation of erythropoietin |
US7179617B2 (en) * | 2001-10-10 | 2007-02-20 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Factor IX: remolding and glycoconjugation of Factor IX |
US20090137763A1 (en) * | 2001-10-10 | 2009-05-28 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Glucosamine nucleotide sugars |
US20090093399A1 (en) * | 2001-10-10 | 2009-04-09 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Glycopegylation methods and proteins/peptides produced by the methods |
US20070027068A1 (en) * | 2001-10-10 | 2007-02-01 | Defrees Shawn | Erythropoietin: remodeling and glycoconjugation of erythropoietin |
US20040043446A1 (en) * | 2001-10-19 | 2004-03-04 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Alpha galalctosidase a: remodeling and glycoconjugation of alpha galactosidase A |
US7157277B2 (en) * | 2001-11-28 | 2007-01-02 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Factor VIII remodeling and glycoconjugation of Factor VIII |
US7368108B2 (en) * | 2001-11-28 | 2008-05-06 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Glycopeptide remodeling using amidases |
US20060030521A1 (en) * | 2001-11-28 | 2006-02-09 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Remodeling and glycoconjugation of peptides |
US20060035224A1 (en) * | 2002-03-21 | 2006-02-16 | Johansen Jack T | Purification methods for oligonucleotides and their analogs |
US20050026266A1 (en) * | 2002-11-08 | 2005-02-03 | Glycozym Aps | Methods to identify agents modulating functions of polypeptide galnac-transferases, pharmaceutical compositions comprising such agents and the use of such agents for preparing medicaments |
US20050064540A1 (en) * | 2002-11-27 | 2005-03-24 | Defrees Shawn Ph.D | Glycoprotein remodeling using endoglycanases |
US20070032405A1 (en) * | 2003-03-14 | 2007-02-08 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Branched water-soluble polymers and their conjugates |
US7691603B2 (en) * | 2003-04-09 | 2010-04-06 | Novo Nordisk A/S | Intracellular formation of peptide conjugates |
US20100048456A1 (en) * | 2003-04-09 | 2010-02-25 | Novo Nordisk A/S | Glycopegylation methods and proteins/peptides produced by the methods |
US20080102083A1 (en) * | 2003-05-09 | 2008-05-01 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Compositions and Methods for the Preparation of Human Growth Hormone Glycosylation Mutants |
US20070059275A1 (en) * | 2003-07-25 | 2007-03-15 | Defrees Shawn | Antibody toxin conjugates |
US20100028939A1 (en) * | 2003-08-08 | 2010-02-04 | Novo Nordisk Healthcare A/G | Use of Galactose Oxidase for Selective Chemical Conjugation of Protractor Molecules to Proteins of Therapeutic Interest |
US20060111279A1 (en) * | 2003-11-24 | 2006-05-25 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Glycopegylated erythropoietin |
US20080015142A1 (en) * | 2003-12-03 | 2008-01-17 | Defrees Shawn | Glycopegylated Follicle Stimulating Hormone |
US7338933B2 (en) * | 2004-01-08 | 2008-03-04 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | O-linked glycosylation of peptides |
US20060024286A1 (en) * | 2004-08-02 | 2006-02-02 | Paul Glidden | Variants of tRNA synthetase fragments and uses thereof |
US20090028822A1 (en) * | 2004-09-10 | 2009-01-29 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Glycopegylated Interferon Alpha |
US20080108557A1 (en) * | 2004-09-29 | 2008-05-08 | Novo Nordisk Healthcare A/G | Modified Proteins |
US20090054623A1 (en) * | 2004-12-17 | 2009-02-26 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Lipo-Conjugation of Peptides |
US20100009902A1 (en) * | 2005-01-06 | 2010-01-14 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Glycoconjugation Using Saccharyl Fragments |
US20090124544A1 (en) * | 2005-04-08 | 2009-05-14 | Neose Technologies ,Inc. A Delaware Corporation | Compositions and methods for the preparation of protease resistant human growth hormone glycosylation mutants |
US20100081791A1 (en) * | 2005-05-25 | 2010-04-01 | Novo Nordisk A/S | Glycopegylated factor ix |
US20090055942A1 (en) * | 2005-09-14 | 2009-02-26 | Novo Nordisk Healthcare A/G | Human Coagulation Factor VII Polypeptides |
US20070105755A1 (en) * | 2005-10-26 | 2007-05-10 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | One pot desialylation and glycopegylation of therapeutic peptides |
US20090048440A1 (en) * | 2005-11-03 | 2009-02-19 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Nucleotide Sugar Purification Using Membranes |
US20100056428A1 (en) * | 2006-09-01 | 2010-03-04 | Novo Nordisk Health Care Ag | Modified proteins |
US20100035299A1 (en) * | 2006-10-03 | 2010-02-11 | Novo Nordisk A/S | Methods for the purification of polypeptide conjugates |
US20100041872A1 (en) * | 2006-10-04 | 2010-02-18 | Defrees Shawn | Glycerol linked pegylated sugars and glycopeptides |
US20090053167A1 (en) * | 2007-05-14 | 2009-02-26 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | C-, S- and N-glycosylation of peptides |
Cited By (67)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
US8716239B2 (en) | 2001-10-10 | 2014-05-06 | Novo Nordisk A/S | Granulocyte colony stimulating factor: remodeling and glycoconjugation G-CSF |
US20100261872A1 (en) * | 2001-10-10 | 2010-10-14 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Factor VIII: remodeling and glycoconjugation of factor VIII |
US8076292B2 (en) | 2001-10-10 | 2011-12-13 | Novo Nordisk A/S | Factor VIII: remodeling and glycoconjugation of factor VIII |
US8716240B2 (en) | 2001-10-10 | 2014-05-06 | Novo Nordisk A/S | Erythropoietin: remodeling and glycoconjugation of erythropoietin |
US7795210B2 (en) | 2001-10-10 | 2010-09-14 | Novo Nordisk A/S | Protein remodeling methods and proteins/peptides produced by the methods |
US20080050772A1 (en) * | 2001-10-10 | 2008-02-28 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Granulocyte colony stimulating factor: remodeling and glycoconjugation of G-CSF |
US8008252B2 (en) | 2001-10-10 | 2011-08-30 | Novo Nordisk A/S | Factor VII: remodeling and glycoconjugation of Factor VII |
US20040063911A1 (en) * | 2001-10-10 | 2004-04-01 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Protein remodeling methods and proteins/peptides produced by the methods |
US20090227504A1 (en) * | 2002-06-21 | 2009-09-10 | Novo Nordisk A/S | Pegylated Factor VII Glycoforms |
US8053410B2 (en) | 2002-06-21 | 2011-11-08 | Novo Nordisk Health Care A/G | Pegylated factor VII glycoforms |
US20100331489A1 (en) * | 2003-03-14 | 2010-12-30 | Biogenerix Ag | Branched water-soluble polymers and their conjugates |
US7803777B2 (en) | 2003-03-14 | 2010-09-28 | Biogenerix Ag | Branched water-soluble polymers and their conjugates |
US8247381B2 (en) | 2003-03-14 | 2012-08-21 | Biogenerix Ag | Branched water-soluble polymers and their conjugates |
US20070032405A1 (en) * | 2003-03-14 | 2007-02-08 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Branched water-soluble polymers and their conjugates |
US8791070B2 (en) | 2003-04-09 | 2014-07-29 | Novo Nordisk A/S | Glycopegylated factor IX |
US8853161B2 (en) | 2003-04-09 | 2014-10-07 | Novo Nordisk A/S | Glycopegylation methods and proteins/peptides produced by the methods |
US8063015B2 (en) | 2003-04-09 | 2011-11-22 | Novo Nordisk A/S | Glycopegylation methods and proteins/peptides produced by the methods |
US20080102083A1 (en) * | 2003-05-09 | 2008-05-01 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Compositions and Methods for the Preparation of Human Growth Hormone Glycosylation Mutants |
US7932364B2 (en) | 2003-05-09 | 2011-04-26 | Novo Nordisk A/S | Compositions and methods for the preparation of human growth hormone glycosylation mutants |
US9005625B2 (en) | 2003-07-25 | 2015-04-14 | Novo Nordisk A/S | Antibody toxin conjugates |
US20070059275A1 (en) * | 2003-07-25 | 2007-03-15 | Defrees Shawn | Antibody toxin conjugates |
US8633157B2 (en) | 2003-11-24 | 2014-01-21 | Novo Nordisk A/S | Glycopegylated erythropoietin |
US20080305992A1 (en) * | 2003-11-24 | 2008-12-11 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Glycopegylated erythropoietin |
US20080300175A1 (en) * | 2003-11-24 | 2008-12-04 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Glycopegylated erythropoietin |
US8916360B2 (en) | 2003-11-24 | 2014-12-23 | Novo Nordisk A/S | Glycopegylated erythropoietin |
US7842661B2 (en) | 2003-11-24 | 2010-11-30 | Novo Nordisk A/S | Glycopegylated erythropoietin formulations |
US20060287224A1 (en) * | 2003-11-24 | 2006-12-21 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Glycopegylated erythropoietin formulations |
US7956032B2 (en) | 2003-12-03 | 2011-06-07 | Novo Nordisk A/S | Glycopegylated granulocyte colony stimulating factor |
US8632770B2 (en) | 2003-12-03 | 2014-01-21 | Novo Nordisk A/S | Glycopegylated factor IX |
US20070254836A1 (en) * | 2003-12-03 | 2007-11-01 | Defrees Shawn | Glycopegylated Granulocyte Colony Stimulating Factor |
US20090169509A1 (en) * | 2004-01-08 | 2009-07-02 | Defrees Shawn | O-linked glycosylation of peptides |
US20080242846A1 (en) * | 2004-01-08 | 2008-10-02 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | O-linked glycosylation of peptides |
US8361961B2 (en) | 2004-01-08 | 2013-01-29 | Biogenerix Ag | O-linked glycosylation of peptides |
US8791066B2 (en) | 2004-07-13 | 2014-07-29 | Novo Nordisk A/S | Branched PEG remodeling and glycosylation of glucagon-like peptide-1 [GLP-1] |
US20090292110A1 (en) * | 2004-07-23 | 2009-11-26 | Defrees Shawn | Enzymatic modification of glycopeptides |
US8268967B2 (en) | 2004-09-10 | 2012-09-18 | Novo Nordisk A/S | Glycopegylated interferon α |
US20090028822A1 (en) * | 2004-09-10 | 2009-01-29 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Glycopegylated Interferon Alpha |
US20080176790A1 (en) * | 2004-10-29 | 2008-07-24 | Defrees Shawn | Remodeling and Glycopegylation of Fibroblast Growth Factor (Fgf) |
US10874714B2 (en) | 2004-10-29 | 2020-12-29 | 89Bio Ltd. | Method of treating fibroblast growth factor 21 (FGF-21) deficiency |
US9200049B2 (en) | 2004-10-29 | 2015-12-01 | Novo Nordisk A/S | Remodeling and glycopegylation of fibroblast growth factor (FGF) |
US20100009902A1 (en) * | 2005-01-06 | 2010-01-14 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Glycoconjugation Using Saccharyl Fragments |
US20090203579A1 (en) * | 2005-01-10 | 2009-08-13 | Defrees Shawn | Glycopegylated Granulocyte Colony Stimulating Factor |
US9029331B2 (en) | 2005-01-10 | 2015-05-12 | Novo Nordisk A/S | Glycopegylated granulocyte colony stimulating factor |
US9187546B2 (en) | 2005-04-08 | 2015-11-17 | Novo Nordisk A/S | Compositions and methods for the preparation of protease resistant human growth hormone glycosylation mutants |
US8404809B2 (en) | 2005-05-25 | 2013-03-26 | Novo Nordisk A/S | Glycopegylated factor IX |
US20110003744A1 (en) * | 2005-05-25 | 2011-01-06 | Novo Nordisk A/S | Glycopegylated Erythropoietin Formulations |
US8911967B2 (en) | 2005-08-19 | 2014-12-16 | Novo Nordisk A/S | One pot desialylation and glycopegylation of therapeutic peptides |
US20090048440A1 (en) * | 2005-11-03 | 2009-02-19 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Nucleotide Sugar Purification Using Membranes |
US8841439B2 (en) | 2005-11-03 | 2014-09-23 | Novo Nordisk A/S | Nucleotide sugar purification using membranes |
US20080255040A1 (en) * | 2006-07-21 | 2008-10-16 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Glycosylation of peptides via o-linked glycosylation sequences |
US9187532B2 (en) | 2006-07-21 | 2015-11-17 | Novo Nordisk A/S | Glycosylation of peptides via O-linked glycosylation sequences |
US8969532B2 (en) | 2006-10-03 | 2015-03-03 | Novo Nordisk A/S | Methods for the purification of polypeptide conjugates comprising polyalkylene oxide using hydrophobic interaction chromatography |
US20100041872A1 (en) * | 2006-10-04 | 2010-02-18 | Defrees Shawn | Glycerol linked pegylated sugars and glycopeptides |
US20080146782A1 (en) * | 2006-10-04 | 2008-06-19 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Glycerol linked pegylated sugars and glycopeptides |
US9050304B2 (en) | 2007-04-03 | 2015-06-09 | Ratiopharm Gmbh | Methods of treatment using glycopegylated G-CSF |
US20100120666A1 (en) * | 2007-04-03 | 2010-05-13 | Biogenerix Ag | Methods of treatment using glycopegylated g-csf |
US20110177029A1 (en) * | 2007-06-04 | 2011-07-21 | Novo Nordisk A/S | O-linked glycosylation using n-acetylglucosaminyl transferases |
US9493499B2 (en) | 2007-06-12 | 2016-11-15 | Novo Nordisk A/S | Process for the production of purified cytidinemonophosphate-sialic acid-polyalkylene oxide (CMP-SA-PEG) as modified nucleotide sugars via anion exchange chromatography |
US20090000924A1 (en) * | 2007-06-29 | 2009-01-01 | Harley-Davidson Motor Company Group, Inc. | Integrated ignition and key switch |
US8207112B2 (en) | 2007-08-29 | 2012-06-26 | Biogenerix Ag | Liquid formulation of G-CSF conjugate |
US20090143292A1 (en) * | 2007-08-29 | 2009-06-04 | Neose Technologies, Inc. | Liquid Formulation of G-CSF Conjugate |
US20100286067A1 (en) * | 2008-01-08 | 2010-11-11 | Biogenerix Ag | Glycoconjugation of polypeptides using oligosaccharyltransferases |
US9150848B2 (en) | 2008-02-27 | 2015-10-06 | Novo Nordisk A/S | Conjugated factor VIII molecules |
US20110166332A1 (en) * | 2008-09-12 | 2011-07-07 | Ge Healthcare Bio-Sciences Ab | Enhanced antibody aggregate removal with capto adhere in the presence of protein-excluded zwitterions |
US9488625B2 (en) | 2010-12-15 | 2016-11-08 | Baxalta GmbH | Purification of factor VIII using a conductivity gradient |
US9169331B2 (en) | 2012-12-21 | 2015-10-27 | Dionex Corporation | Separation of glycans by mixed-mode liquid chromatography |
US9310344B2 (en) | 2013-06-14 | 2016-04-12 | Dionex Corporation | HILIC/anion-exchange/cation-exchange multimodal media |
Also Published As
Publication number | Publication date |
---|---|
JP2010505874A (en) | 2010-02-25 |
WO2008057683A3 (en) | 2009-01-15 |
WO2008057683A2 (en) | 2008-05-15 |
US20080253992A1 (en) | 2008-10-16 |
EP2054521A4 (en) | 2012-12-19 |
EP2054521A2 (en) | 2009-05-06 |
US8969532B2 (en) | 2015-03-03 |
IL197765A0 (en) | 2009-12-24 |
US20100035299A1 (en) | 2010-02-11 |
Similar Documents
Publication | Publication Date | Title |
---|---|---|
US8969532B2 (en) | Methods for the purification of polypeptide conjugates comprising polyalkylene oxide using hydrophobic interaction chromatography | |
US20080207487A1 (en) | Manufacturing process for the production of polypeptides expressed in insect cell-lines | |
KR101556248B1 (en) | Glycerol linked pegylated sugars and glycopeptides | |
US7368108B2 (en) | Glycopeptide remodeling using amidases | |
EP1461445B1 (en) | Glycoprotein remodeling using endoglycanases | |
EP1694274B1 (en) | Glycopegylated granulocyte colony stimulating factor | |
EP1428878B1 (en) | Process for the production and purification of erythropoietin | |
US9029331B2 (en) | Glycopegylated granulocyte colony stimulating factor | |
US20060246544A1 (en) | Manufacturing process for the production of peptides grown in insect cell lines | |
US20050064540A1 (en) | Glycoprotein remodeling using endoglycanases | |
US20070105755A1 (en) | One pot desialylation and glycopegylation of therapeutic peptides | |
CA2607844C (en) | Pegylated g-csf polypeptides and methods of producing same | |
JP2009544327A (en) | Glycosylation of peptides with O-linked glycosylation sequences | |
JP6151640B2 (en) | Protein purification method | |
JP2010531135A (en) | O-linked glycosylation using N-acetylglucosaminyltransferase | |
KR20090016596A (en) | Erythropoietin compositions | |
KR101847169B1 (en) | Composition comprising long-acting Erythropoietin | |
WO2023040792A1 (en) | Preparation method for erythropoietin | |
KR20180026688A (en) | Composition comprising long-acting Erythropoietin |
Legal Events
Date | Code | Title | Description |
---|---|---|---|
AS | Assignment |
Owner name: NOVO NORDISK A/S,DENMARK Free format text: ASSIGNMENT OF ASSIGNORS INTEREST;ASSIGNOR:NEOSE TECHNOLOGIES, INC.;REEL/FRAME:022441/0937 Effective date: 20090127 Owner name: NOVO NORDISK A/S, DENMARK Free format text: ASSIGNMENT OF ASSIGNORS INTEREST;ASSIGNOR:NEOSE TECHNOLOGIES, INC.;REEL/FRAME:022441/0937 Effective date: 20090127 |
|
AS | Assignment |
Owner name: NOVO NORDISK A/S,DENMARK Free format text: ASSIGNMENT OF ASSIGNORS INTEREST;ASSIGNORS:DEFREES, SHAWN;KINEALY, KYLE;SIGNING DATES FROM 20090420 TO 20090422;REEL/FRAME:023013/0551 |
|
STCB | Information on status: application discontinuation |
Free format text: ABANDONED -- FAILURE TO RESPOND TO AN OFFICE ACTION |